1 //===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading -------------------------------===// 2 // 3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions. 4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information. 5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception 6 // 7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 8 // 9 // This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading. 10 // 11 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 12 13 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 14 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h" 15 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 16 #include "clang/AST/DependenceFlags.h" 17 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h" 18 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 19 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h" 21 #include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h" 22 #include "clang/Basic/DiagnosticOptions.h" 23 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" 24 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h" 25 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h" 26 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h" 27 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h" 28 #include "clang/Sema/Overload.h" 29 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h" 30 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h" 31 #include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h" 32 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h" 33 #include "llvm/ADT/Optional.h" 34 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h" 35 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h" 36 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h" 37 #include <algorithm> 38 #include <cstdlib> 39 40 using namespace clang; 41 using namespace sema; 42 43 using AllowedExplicit = Sema::AllowedExplicit; 44 45 static bool functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 46 return llvm::any_of(FD->parameters(), [](const ParmVarDecl *P) { 47 return P->hasAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 48 }); 49 } 50 51 /// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a function. 52 static ExprResult 53 CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, NamedDecl *FoundDecl, 54 const Expr *Base, bool HadMultipleCandidates, 55 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(), 56 const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){ 57 if (S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FoundDecl, Loc)) 58 return ExprError(); 59 // If FoundDecl is different from Fn (such as if one is a template 60 // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is 61 // called on both. 62 // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying 63 // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl 64 // being used. 65 if (FoundDecl != Fn && S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Fn, Loc)) 66 return ExprError(); 67 DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) 68 DeclRefExpr(S.Context, Fn, false, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo); 69 if (HadMultipleCandidates) 70 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true); 71 72 S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE, Base); 73 if (auto *FPT = DRE->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 74 if (isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType())) { 75 S.ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT); 76 DRE->setType(Fn->getType()); 77 } 78 } 79 return S.ImpCastExprToType(DRE, S.Context.getPointerType(DRE->getType()), 80 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay); 81 } 82 83 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType, 84 bool InOverloadResolution, 85 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 86 bool CStyle, 87 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 88 89 static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, 90 QualType &ToType, 91 bool InOverloadResolution, 92 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 93 bool CStyle); 94 static OverloadingResult 95 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 96 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User, 97 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions, 98 AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit, 99 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 100 101 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 102 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 103 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 104 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 105 106 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 107 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S, 108 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 109 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 110 111 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 112 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 113 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 114 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 115 116 /// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank 117 /// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind. 118 ImplicitConversionRank clang::GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) { 119 static const ImplicitConversionRank 120 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = { 121 ICR_Exact_Match, 122 ICR_Exact_Match, 123 ICR_Exact_Match, 124 ICR_Exact_Match, 125 ICR_Exact_Match, 126 ICR_Exact_Match, 127 ICR_Promotion, 128 ICR_Promotion, 129 ICR_Promotion, 130 ICR_Conversion, 131 ICR_Conversion, 132 ICR_Conversion, 133 ICR_Conversion, 134 ICR_Conversion, 135 ICR_Conversion, 136 ICR_Conversion, 137 ICR_Conversion, 138 ICR_Conversion, 139 ICR_Conversion, 140 ICR_Conversion, 141 ICR_OCL_Scalar_Widening, 142 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion, 143 ICR_Conversion, 144 ICR_Conversion, 145 ICR_Writeback_Conversion, 146 ICR_Exact_Match, // NOTE(gbiv): This may not be completely right -- 147 // it was omitted by the patch that added 148 // ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion 149 ICR_C_Conversion, 150 ICR_C_Conversion_Extension 151 }; 152 return Rank[(int)Kind]; 153 } 154 155 /// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of 156 /// implicit conversion. 157 static const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) { 158 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = { 159 "No conversion", 160 "Lvalue-to-rvalue", 161 "Array-to-pointer", 162 "Function-to-pointer", 163 "Function pointer conversion", 164 "Qualification", 165 "Integral promotion", 166 "Floating point promotion", 167 "Complex promotion", 168 "Integral conversion", 169 "Floating conversion", 170 "Complex conversion", 171 "Floating-integral conversion", 172 "Pointer conversion", 173 "Pointer-to-member conversion", 174 "Boolean conversion", 175 "Compatible-types conversion", 176 "Derived-to-base conversion", 177 "Vector conversion", 178 "SVE Vector conversion", 179 "Vector splat", 180 "Complex-real conversion", 181 "Block Pointer conversion", 182 "Transparent Union Conversion", 183 "Writeback conversion", 184 "OpenCL Zero Event Conversion", 185 "C specific type conversion", 186 "Incompatible pointer conversion" 187 }; 188 return Name[Kind]; 189 } 190 191 /// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion 192 /// sequence to the identity conversion. 193 void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() { 194 First = ICK_Identity; 195 Second = ICK_Identity; 196 Third = ICK_Identity; 197 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false; 198 QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false; 199 ReferenceBinding = false; 200 DirectBinding = false; 201 IsLvalueReference = true; 202 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 203 BindsToRvalue = false; 204 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 205 ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 206 CopyConstructor = nullptr; 207 } 208 209 /// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence 210 /// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the 211 /// implicit conversions. 212 ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const { 213 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match; 214 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank) 215 Rank = GetConversionRank(First); 216 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank) 217 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second); 218 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank) 219 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third); 220 return Rank; 221 } 222 223 /// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is 224 /// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is 225 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences 226 /// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4). 227 bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const { 228 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the 229 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so 230 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is 231 // a pointer. 232 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() && 233 (getFromType()->isPointerType() || 234 getFromType()->isMemberPointerType() || 235 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 236 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() || 237 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer)) 238 return true; 239 240 return false; 241 } 242 243 /// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this 244 /// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is 245 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++ 246 /// 13.3.3.2p4). 247 bool 248 StandardConversionSequence:: 249 isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const { 250 QualType FromType = getFromType(); 251 QualType ToType = getToType(1); 252 253 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the 254 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence 255 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer. 256 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 257 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType); 258 259 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType()) 260 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 261 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType(); 262 263 return false; 264 } 265 266 /// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion 267 /// or after one in an implicit conversion. 268 static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(ASTContext &Ctx, 269 const Expr *Converted) { 270 // We can have cleanups wrapping the converted expression; these need to be 271 // preserved so that destructors run if necessary. 272 if (auto *EWC = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Converted)) { 273 Expr *Inner = 274 const_cast<Expr *>(IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, EWC->getSubExpr())); 275 return ExprWithCleanups::Create(Ctx, Inner, EWC->cleanupsHaveSideEffects(), 276 EWC->getObjects()); 277 } 278 279 while (auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) { 280 switch (ICE->getCastKind()) { 281 case CK_NoOp: 282 case CK_IntegralCast: 283 case CK_IntegralToBoolean: 284 case CK_IntegralToFloating: 285 case CK_BooleanToSignedIntegral: 286 case CK_FloatingToIntegral: 287 case CK_FloatingToBoolean: 288 case CK_FloatingCast: 289 Converted = ICE->getSubExpr(); 290 continue; 291 292 default: 293 return Converted; 294 } 295 } 296 297 return Converted; 298 } 299 300 /// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing 301 /// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7. 302 /// 303 /// \param Ctx The AST context. 304 /// \param Converted The result of applying this standard conversion sequence. 305 /// \param ConstantValue If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the 306 /// value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion. 307 /// \param ConstantType If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the 308 /// type of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion. 309 /// \param IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion If true type-narrowing conversions 310 /// from floating point types to integral types should be ignored. 311 NarrowingKind StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind( 312 ASTContext &Ctx, const Expr *Converted, APValue &ConstantValue, 313 QualType &ConstantType, bool IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion) const { 314 assert(Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++"); 315 316 // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7: 317 // A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ... 318 QualType FromType = getToType(0); 319 QualType ToType = getToType(1); 320 321 // A conversion to an enumeration type is narrowing if the conversion to 322 // the underlying type is narrowing. This only arises for expressions of 323 // the form 'Enum{init}'. 324 if (auto *ET = ToType->getAs<EnumType>()) 325 ToType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 326 327 switch (Second) { 328 // 'bool' is an integral type; dispatch to the right place to handle it. 329 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: 330 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType()) 331 goto FloatingIntegralConversion; 332 if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) 333 goto IntegralConversion; 334 // -- from a pointer type or pointer-to-member type to bool, or 335 return NK_Type_Narrowing; 336 337 // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or 338 // 339 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point 340 // type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual 341 // value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce 342 // the original value when converted back to the original type, or 343 case ICK_Floating_Integral: 344 FloatingIntegralConversion: 345 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) { 346 return NK_Type_Narrowing; 347 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 348 ToType->isRealFloatingType()) { 349 if (IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion) 350 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 351 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted); 352 assert(Initializer && "Unknown conversion expression"); 353 354 // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing. 355 if (Initializer->isValueDependent()) 356 return NK_Dependent_Narrowing; 357 358 if (Optional<llvm::APSInt> IntConstantValue = 359 Initializer->getIntegerConstantExpr(Ctx)) { 360 // Convert the integer to the floating type. 361 llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType)); 362 Result.convertFromAPInt(*IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue->isSigned(), 363 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven); 364 // And back. 365 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = *IntConstantValue; 366 bool ignored; 367 Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue, 368 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored); 369 // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion. 370 if (*IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) { 371 ConstantValue = APValue(*IntConstantValue); 372 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 373 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 374 } 375 } else { 376 // Variables are always narrowings. 377 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 378 } 379 } 380 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 381 382 // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except 383 // where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after 384 // conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even 385 // if it cannot be represented exactly), or 386 case ICK_Floating_Conversion: 387 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() && 388 Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) { 389 // FromType is larger than ToType. 390 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted); 391 392 // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing. 393 if (Initializer->isValueDependent()) 394 return NK_Dependent_Narrowing; 395 396 if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) { 397 // Constant! 398 assert(ConstantValue.isFloat()); 399 llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat(); 400 // Convert the source value into the target type. 401 bool ignored; 402 llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert( 403 Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType), 404 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored); 405 // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of 406 // values that can be represented. 407 if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) { 408 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 409 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 410 } 411 } else { 412 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 413 } 414 } 415 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 416 417 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type 418 // that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where 419 // the source is a constant expression and the actual value after 420 // conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original 421 // value when converted back to the original type. 422 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: 423 IntegralConversion: { 424 assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()); 425 assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()); 426 const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 427 const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType); 428 const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 429 const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType); 430 431 if (FromWidth > ToWidth || 432 (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned) || 433 (FromSigned && !ToSigned)) { 434 // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType. 435 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted); 436 437 // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing. 438 if (Initializer->isValueDependent()) 439 return NK_Dependent_Narrowing; 440 441 Optional<llvm::APSInt> OptInitializerValue; 442 if (!(OptInitializerValue = Initializer->getIntegerConstantExpr(Ctx))) { 443 // Such conversions on variables are always narrowing. 444 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 445 } 446 llvm::APSInt &InitializerValue = *OptInitializerValue; 447 bool Narrowing = false; 448 if (FromWidth < ToWidth) { 449 // Negative -> unsigned is narrowing. Otherwise, more bits is never 450 // narrowing. 451 if (InitializerValue.isSigned() && InitializerValue.isNegative()) 452 Narrowing = true; 453 } else { 454 // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about 455 // signed vs. unsigned comparisons. 456 InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend( 457 InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1); 458 // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness. 459 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue; 460 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth); 461 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned); 462 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth()); 463 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned()); 464 // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion. 465 if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue) 466 Narrowing = true; 467 } 468 if (Narrowing) { 469 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 470 ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue); 471 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 472 } 473 } 474 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 475 } 476 477 default: 478 // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings. 479 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 480 } 481 } 482 483 /// dump - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard 484 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 485 LLVM_DUMP_METHOD void StandardConversionSequence::dump() const { 486 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 487 bool PrintedSomething = false; 488 if (First != ICK_Identity) { 489 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First); 490 PrintedSomething = true; 491 } 492 493 if (Second != ICK_Identity) { 494 if (PrintedSomething) { 495 OS << " -> "; 496 } 497 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second); 498 499 if (CopyConstructor) { 500 OS << " (by copy constructor)"; 501 } else if (DirectBinding) { 502 OS << " (direct reference binding)"; 503 } else if (ReferenceBinding) { 504 OS << " (reference binding)"; 505 } 506 PrintedSomething = true; 507 } 508 509 if (Third != ICK_Identity) { 510 if (PrintedSomething) { 511 OS << " -> "; 512 } 513 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third); 514 PrintedSomething = true; 515 } 516 517 if (!PrintedSomething) { 518 OS << "No conversions required"; 519 } 520 } 521 522 /// dump - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard 523 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 524 void UserDefinedConversionSequence::dump() const { 525 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 526 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) { 527 Before.dump(); 528 OS << " -> "; 529 } 530 if (ConversionFunction) 531 OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\''; 532 else 533 OS << "aggregate initialization"; 534 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) { 535 OS << " -> "; 536 After.dump(); 537 } 538 } 539 540 /// dump - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard 541 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 542 void ImplicitConversionSequence::dump() const { 543 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 544 if (isStdInitializerListElement()) 545 OS << "Worst std::initializer_list element conversion: "; 546 switch (ConversionKind) { 547 case StandardConversion: 548 OS << "Standard conversion: "; 549 Standard.dump(); 550 break; 551 case UserDefinedConversion: 552 OS << "User-defined conversion: "; 553 UserDefined.dump(); 554 break; 555 case EllipsisConversion: 556 OS << "Ellipsis conversion"; 557 break; 558 case AmbiguousConversion: 559 OS << "Ambiguous conversion"; 560 break; 561 case BadConversion: 562 OS << "Bad conversion"; 563 break; 564 } 565 566 OS << "\n"; 567 } 568 569 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() { 570 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(); 571 } 572 573 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() { 574 conversions().~ConversionSet(); 575 } 576 577 void 578 AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) { 579 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr; 580 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr; 581 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions()); 582 } 583 584 namespace { 585 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store 586 // template argument information. 587 struct DFIArguments { 588 TemplateArgument FirstArg; 589 TemplateArgument SecondArg; 590 }; 591 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store 592 // template parameter and template argument information. 593 struct DFIParamWithArguments : DFIArguments { 594 TemplateParameter Param; 595 }; 596 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store template argument 597 // information and the index of the problematic call argument. 598 struct DFIDeducedMismatchArgs : DFIArguments { 599 TemplateArgumentList *TemplateArgs; 600 unsigned CallArgIndex; 601 }; 602 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store information about 603 // unsatisfied constraints. 604 struct CNSInfo { 605 TemplateArgumentList *TemplateArgs; 606 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 607 }; 608 } 609 610 /// Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information 611 /// to the form used in overload-candidate information. 612 DeductionFailureInfo 613 clang::MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context, 614 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK, 615 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) { 616 DeductionFailureInfo Result; 617 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK); 618 Result.HasDiagnostic = false; 619 switch (TDK) { 620 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 621 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 622 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 623 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 624 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 625 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 626 Result.Data = nullptr; 627 break; 628 629 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 630 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 631 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue(); 632 break; 633 634 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 635 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: { 636 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 637 auto *Saved = new (Context) DFIDeducedMismatchArgs; 638 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 639 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 640 Saved->TemplateArgs = Info.take(); 641 Saved->CallArgIndex = Info.CallArgIndex; 642 Result.Data = Saved; 643 break; 644 } 645 646 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: { 647 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 648 DFIArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIArguments; 649 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 650 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 651 Result.Data = Saved; 652 break; 653 } 654 655 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 656 // FIXME: It's slightly wasteful to allocate two TemplateArguments for this. 657 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 658 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: { 659 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 660 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments; 661 Saved->Param = Info.Param; 662 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 663 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 664 Result.Data = Saved; 665 break; 666 } 667 668 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 669 Result.Data = Info.take(); 670 if (Info.hasSFINAEDiagnostic()) { 671 PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = new (Result.Diagnostic) PartialDiagnosticAt( 672 SourceLocation(), PartialDiagnostic::NullDiagnostic()); 673 Info.takeSFINAEDiagnostic(*Diag); 674 Result.HasDiagnostic = true; 675 } 676 break; 677 678 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: { 679 CNSInfo *Saved = new (Context) CNSInfo; 680 Saved->TemplateArgs = Info.take(); 681 Saved->Satisfaction = Info.AssociatedConstraintsSatisfaction; 682 Result.Data = Saved; 683 break; 684 } 685 686 case Sema::TDK_Success: 687 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 688 llvm_unreachable("not a deduction failure"); 689 } 690 691 return Result; 692 } 693 694 void DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() { 695 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 696 case Sema::TDK_Success: 697 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 698 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 699 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 700 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 701 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 702 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 703 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 704 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 705 break; 706 707 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 708 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 709 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 710 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 711 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 712 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 713 // FIXME: Destroy the data? 714 Data = nullptr; 715 break; 716 717 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 718 // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list? 719 Data = nullptr; 720 if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) { 721 Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt(); 722 HasDiagnostic = false; 723 } 724 break; 725 726 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 727 // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list? 728 Data = nullptr; 729 if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) { 730 Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt(); 731 HasDiagnostic = false; 732 } 733 break; 734 735 // Unhandled 736 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 737 break; 738 } 739 } 740 741 PartialDiagnosticAt *DeductionFailureInfo::getSFINAEDiagnostic() { 742 if (HasDiagnostic) 743 return static_cast<PartialDiagnosticAt*>(static_cast<void*>(Diagnostic)); 744 return nullptr; 745 } 746 747 TemplateParameter DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() { 748 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 749 case Sema::TDK_Success: 750 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 751 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 752 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 753 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 754 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 755 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 756 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 757 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 758 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 759 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 760 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 761 return TemplateParameter(); 762 763 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 764 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 765 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data); 766 767 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 768 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 769 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 770 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param; 771 772 // Unhandled 773 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 774 break; 775 } 776 777 return TemplateParameter(); 778 } 779 780 TemplateArgumentList *DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() { 781 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 782 case Sema::TDK_Success: 783 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 784 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 785 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 786 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 787 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 788 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 789 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 790 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 791 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 792 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 793 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 794 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 795 return nullptr; 796 797 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 798 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 799 return static_cast<DFIDeducedMismatchArgs*>(Data)->TemplateArgs; 800 801 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 802 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data); 803 804 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 805 return static_cast<CNSInfo*>(Data)->TemplateArgs; 806 807 // Unhandled 808 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 809 break; 810 } 811 812 return nullptr; 813 } 814 815 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() { 816 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 817 case Sema::TDK_Success: 818 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 819 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 820 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 821 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 822 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 823 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 824 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 825 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 826 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 827 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 828 return nullptr; 829 830 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 831 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 832 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 833 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 834 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 835 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 836 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg; 837 838 // Unhandled 839 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 840 break; 841 } 842 843 return nullptr; 844 } 845 846 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() { 847 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 848 case Sema::TDK_Success: 849 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 850 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 851 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 852 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 853 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 854 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 855 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 856 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 857 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 858 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 859 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 860 return nullptr; 861 862 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 863 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 864 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 865 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 866 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 867 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg; 868 869 // Unhandled 870 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 871 break; 872 } 873 874 return nullptr; 875 } 876 877 llvm::Optional<unsigned> DeductionFailureInfo::getCallArgIndex() { 878 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 879 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 880 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 881 return static_cast<DFIDeducedMismatchArgs*>(Data)->CallArgIndex; 882 883 default: 884 return llvm::None; 885 } 886 } 887 888 bool OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo::shouldAddReversed( 889 OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 890 if (!AllowRewrittenCandidates) 891 return false; 892 return Op == OO_EqualEqual || Op == OO_Spaceship; 893 } 894 895 bool OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo::shouldAddReversed( 896 ASTContext &Ctx, const FunctionDecl *FD) { 897 if (!shouldAddReversed(FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator())) 898 return false; 899 // Don't bother adding a reversed candidate that can never be a better 900 // match than the non-reversed version. 901 return FD->getNumParams() != 2 || 902 !Ctx.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FD->getParamDecl(0)->getType(), 903 FD->getParamDecl(1)->getType()) || 904 FD->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>(); 905 } 906 907 void OverloadCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() { 908 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) { 909 for (auto &C : i->Conversions) 910 C.~ImplicitConversionSequence(); 911 if (!i->Viable && i->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 912 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy(); 913 } 914 } 915 916 void OverloadCandidateSet::clear(CandidateSetKind CSK) { 917 destroyCandidates(); 918 SlabAllocator.Reset(); 919 NumInlineBytesUsed = 0; 920 Candidates.clear(); 921 Functions.clear(); 922 Kind = CSK; 923 } 924 925 namespace { 926 class UnbridgedCastsSet { 927 struct Entry { 928 Expr **Addr; 929 Expr *Saved; 930 }; 931 SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries; 932 933 public: 934 void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) { 935 assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast)); 936 Entry entry = { &E, E }; 937 Entries.push_back(entry); 938 E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E); 939 } 940 941 void restore() { 942 for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator 943 i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i) 944 *i->Addr = i->Saved; 945 } 946 }; 947 } 948 949 /// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like 950 /// preprocessing on the given expression. 951 /// 952 /// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts; 953 /// without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors 954 /// 955 /// Return true on unrecoverable error. 956 static bool 957 checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E, 958 UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = nullptr) { 959 if (const BuiltinType *placeholder = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 960 // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload 961 // resolution might reasonably tweak them. 962 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false; 963 964 // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip 965 // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration. 966 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast && 967 unbridgedCasts) { 968 unbridgedCasts->save(S, E); 969 return false; 970 } 971 972 // Go ahead and check everything else. 973 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 974 if (result.isInvalid()) 975 return true; 976 977 E = result.get(); 978 return false; 979 } 980 981 // Nothing to do. 982 return false; 983 } 984 985 /// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for 986 /// placeholders. 987 static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S, 988 MultiExprArg Args, 989 UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) { 990 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) 991 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, Args[i], &unbridged)) 992 return true; 993 994 return false; 995 } 996 997 /// Determine whether the given New declaration is an overload of the 998 /// declarations in Old. This routine returns Ovl_Match or Ovl_NonFunction if 999 /// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same signature as 1000 /// some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old declarations aren't 1001 /// functions (or function templates) at all. When it does return Ovl_Match or 1002 /// Ovl_NonFunction, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New cannot be 1003 /// overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on top of the underlying 1004 /// declaration. 1005 /// 1006 /// Example: Given the following input: 1007 /// 1008 /// void f(int, float); // #1 1009 /// void f(int, int); // #2 1010 /// int f(int, int); // #3 1011 /// 1012 /// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f", so IsOverload 1013 /// will not be used. 1014 /// 1015 /// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By comparing 1016 /// the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded (since they have 1017 /// different signatures), so this routine returns Ovl_Overload; MatchedDecl is 1018 /// unchanged. 1019 /// 1020 /// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We compare 1021 /// the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do nothing) and then 1022 /// #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are identical (return types of 1023 /// functions are not part of the signature), IsOverload returns Ovl_Match and 1024 /// MatchedDecl will be set to point to the FunctionDecl for #2. 1025 /// 1026 /// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced into a class 1027 /// by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide shadow declarations 1028 /// ignore some properties which otherwise figure into a function template's 1029 /// signature. 1030 Sema::OverloadKind 1031 Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old, 1032 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) { 1033 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end(); 1034 I != E; ++I) { 1035 NamedDecl *OldD = *I; 1036 1037 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false; 1038 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) { 1039 OldIsUsingDecl = true; 1040 1041 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same 1042 // context, even if they have identical signatures. 1043 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue; 1044 1045 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl(); 1046 } 1047 1048 // A using-declaration does not conflict with another declaration 1049 // if one of them is hidden. 1050 if ((OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && !isVisible(*I)) 1051 continue; 1052 1053 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration, 1054 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching. 1055 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that 1056 // function templates hide function templates with different 1057 // return types or template parameter lists. 1058 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules = 1059 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord() && 1060 !New->getFriendObjectKind(); 1061 1062 if (FunctionDecl *OldF = OldD->getAsFunction()) { 1063 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) { 1064 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) { 1065 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I)); 1066 continue; 1067 } 1068 1069 if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD) && 1070 !shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(*I, New)) 1071 continue; 1072 1073 Match = *I; 1074 return Ovl_Match; 1075 } 1076 1077 // Builtins that have custom typechecking or have a reference should 1078 // not be overloadable or redeclarable. 1079 if (!getASTContext().canBuiltinBeRedeclared(OldF)) { 1080 Match = *I; 1081 return Ovl_NonFunction; 1082 } 1083 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD) || isa<UsingPackDecl>(OldD)) { 1084 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing 1085 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls. 1086 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName); 1087 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) { 1088 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them. 1089 } else if (auto *UUD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) { 1090 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will 1091 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during 1092 // template instantiation. 1093 // 1094 // Exception: if the scope is dependent and this is not a class 1095 // member, the using declaration can only introduce an enumerator. 1096 if (UUD->getQualifier()->isDependent() && !UUD->isCXXClassMember()) { 1097 Match = *I; 1098 return Ovl_NonFunction; 1099 } 1100 } else { 1101 // (C++ 13p1): 1102 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type 1103 // declarations cannot be overloaded. 1104 Match = *I; 1105 return Ovl_NonFunction; 1106 } 1107 } 1108 1109 // C++ [temp.friend]p1: 1110 // For a friend function declaration that is not a template declaration: 1111 // -- if the name of the friend is a qualified or unqualified template-id, 1112 // [...], otherwise 1113 // -- if the name of the friend is a qualified-id and a matching 1114 // non-template function is found in the specified class or namespace, 1115 // the friend declaration refers to that function, otherwise, 1116 // -- if the name of the friend is a qualified-id and a matching function 1117 // template is found in the specified class or namespace, the friend 1118 // declaration refers to the deduced specialization of that function 1119 // template, otherwise 1120 // -- the name shall be an unqualified-id [...] 1121 // If we get here for a qualified friend declaration, we've just reached the 1122 // third bullet. If the type of the friend is dependent, skip this lookup 1123 // until instantiation. 1124 if (New->getFriendObjectKind() && New->getQualifier() && 1125 !New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 1126 !New->getDependentSpecializationInfo() && 1127 !New->getType()->isDependentType()) { 1128 LookupResult TemplateSpecResult(LookupResult::Temporary, Old); 1129 TemplateSpecResult.addAllDecls(Old); 1130 if (CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization(New, nullptr, TemplateSpecResult, 1131 /*QualifiedFriend*/true)) { 1132 New->setInvalidDecl(); 1133 return Ovl_Overload; 1134 } 1135 1136 Match = TemplateSpecResult.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>(); 1137 return Ovl_Match; 1138 } 1139 1140 return Ovl_Overload; 1141 } 1142 1143 bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old, 1144 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules, bool ConsiderCudaAttrs, 1145 bool ConsiderRequiresClauses) { 1146 // C++ [basic.start.main]p2: This function shall not be overloaded. 1147 if (New->isMain()) 1148 return false; 1149 1150 // MSVCRT user defined entry points cannot be overloaded. 1151 if (New->isMSVCRTEntryPoint()) 1152 return false; 1153 1154 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 1155 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 1156 1157 // C++ [temp.fct]p2: 1158 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates 1159 // and with normal (non-template) functions. 1160 if ((OldTemplate == nullptr) != (NewTemplate == nullptr)) 1161 return true; 1162 1163 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old? 1164 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType()); 1165 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 1166 1167 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to 1168 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch 1169 // in the signature, they are overloads. 1170 1171 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no 1172 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures. 1173 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) || 1174 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr())) 1175 return false; 1176 1177 const FunctionProtoType *OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType); 1178 const FunctionProtoType *NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType); 1179 1180 // The signature of a function includes the types of its 1181 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence 1182 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357). 1183 if (OldQType != NewQType && 1184 (OldType->getNumParams() != NewType->getNumParams() || 1185 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() || 1186 !FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType))) 1187 return true; 1188 1189 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4: 1190 // The signature of a function template consists of its function 1191 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names 1192 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the 1193 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the 1194 // signature. 1195 // 1196 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function 1197 // templates first; the remaining checks follow. 1198 // 1199 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether 1200 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden. 1201 if (!UseMemberUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate && 1202 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 1203 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 1204 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) || 1205 !Context.hasSameType(Old->getDeclaredReturnType(), 1206 New->getDeclaredReturnType()))) 1207 return true; 1208 1209 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the 1210 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself. 1211 // 1212 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions 1213 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++ 1214 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature, 1215 // this check is important to determine whether these functions 1216 // can be overloaded. 1217 CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old); 1218 CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New); 1219 if (OldMethod && NewMethod && 1220 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic()) { 1221 if (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier()) { 1222 if (!UseMemberUsingDeclRules && 1223 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None || 1224 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) { 1225 // C++0x [over.load]p2: 1226 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same 1227 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template 1228 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and 1229 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of 1230 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5). 1231 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload) 1232 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier(); 1233 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 1234 } 1235 return true; 1236 } 1237 1238 // We may not have applied the implicit const for a constexpr member 1239 // function yet (because we haven't yet resolved whether this is a static 1240 // or non-static member function). Add it now, on the assumption that this 1241 // is a redeclaration of OldMethod. 1242 auto OldQuals = OldMethod->getMethodQualifiers(); 1243 auto NewQuals = NewMethod->getMethodQualifiers(); 1244 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && NewMethod->isConstexpr() && 1245 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewMethod)) 1246 NewQuals.addConst(); 1247 // We do not allow overloading based off of '__restrict'. 1248 OldQuals.removeRestrict(); 1249 NewQuals.removeRestrict(); 1250 if (OldQuals != NewQuals) 1251 return true; 1252 } 1253 1254 // Though pass_object_size is placed on parameters and takes an argument, we 1255 // consider it to be a function-level modifier for the sake of function 1256 // identity. Either the function has one or more parameters with 1257 // pass_object_size or it doesn't. 1258 if (functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(New) != 1259 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Old)) 1260 return true; 1261 1262 // enable_if attributes are an order-sensitive part of the signature. 1263 for (specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr> 1264 NewI = New->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(), 1265 NewE = New->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>(), 1266 OldI = Old->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(), 1267 OldE = Old->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>(); 1268 NewI != NewE || OldI != OldE; ++NewI, ++OldI) { 1269 if (NewI == NewE || OldI == OldE) 1270 return true; 1271 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID; 1272 NewI->getCond()->Profile(NewID, Context, true); 1273 OldI->getCond()->Profile(OldID, Context, true); 1274 if (NewID != OldID) 1275 return true; 1276 } 1277 1278 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && ConsiderCudaAttrs) { 1279 // Don't allow overloading of destructors. (In theory we could, but it 1280 // would be a giant change to clang.) 1281 if (!isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(New)) { 1282 CUDAFunctionTarget NewTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(New), 1283 OldTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(Old); 1284 if (NewTarget != CFT_InvalidTarget) { 1285 assert((OldTarget != CFT_InvalidTarget) && 1286 "Unexpected invalid target."); 1287 1288 // Allow overloading of functions with same signature and different CUDA 1289 // target attributes. 1290 if (NewTarget != OldTarget) 1291 return true; 1292 } 1293 } 1294 } 1295 1296 if (ConsiderRequiresClauses) { 1297 Expr *NewRC = New->getTrailingRequiresClause(), 1298 *OldRC = Old->getTrailingRequiresClause(); 1299 if ((NewRC != nullptr) != (OldRC != nullptr)) 1300 // RC are most certainly different - these are overloads. 1301 return true; 1302 1303 if (NewRC) { 1304 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID; 1305 NewRC->Profile(NewID, Context, /*Canonical=*/true); 1306 OldRC->Profile(OldID, Context, /*Canonical=*/true); 1307 if (NewID != OldID) 1308 // RCs are not equivalent - these are overloads. 1309 return true; 1310 } 1311 } 1312 1313 // The signatures match; this is not an overload. 1314 return false; 1315 } 1316 1317 /// Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType. 1318 /// 1319 /// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion 1320 /// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information. 1321 static ImplicitConversionSequence 1322 TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1323 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1324 AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit, 1325 bool InOverloadResolution, 1326 bool CStyle, 1327 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1328 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 1329 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 1330 1331 if (SuppressUserConversions) { 1332 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that 1333 // we can perform. 1334 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1335 return ICS; 1336 } 1337 1338 // Attempt user-defined conversion. 1339 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc(), 1340 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 1341 switch (IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, 1342 Conversions, AllowExplicit, 1343 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit)) { 1344 case OR_Success: 1345 case OR_Deleted: 1346 ICS.setUserDefined(); 1347 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4: 1348 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class 1349 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an 1350 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is 1351 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy 1352 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is 1353 // called for those cases. 1354 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor 1355 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) { 1356 QualType FromCanon 1357 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType()); 1358 QualType ToCanon 1359 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType(); 1360 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() && 1361 (FromCanon == ToCanon || 1362 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromCanon, ToCanon))) { 1363 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it 1364 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences. 1365 DeclAccessPair Found = ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction; 1366 ICS.setStandard(); 1367 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1368 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType()); 1369 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 1370 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor; 1371 ICS.Standard.FoundCopyConstructor = Found; 1372 if (ToCanon != FromCanon) 1373 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 1374 } 1375 } 1376 break; 1377 1378 case OR_Ambiguous: 1379 ICS.setAmbiguous(); 1380 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType()); 1381 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType); 1382 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin(); 1383 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand) 1384 if (Cand->Best) 1385 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function); 1386 break; 1387 1388 // Fall through. 1389 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 1390 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1391 break; 1392 } 1393 1394 return ICS; 1395 } 1396 1397 /// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion 1398 /// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This 1399 /// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used 1400 /// to perform the initialization. Given 1401 /// 1402 /// void f(float f); 1403 /// void g(int i) { f(i); } 1404 /// 1405 /// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to 1406 /// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard 1407 /// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++ 1408 /// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9). 1409 // 1410 /// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be 1411 /// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such, 1412 /// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available, 1413 /// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind 1414 /// "BadConversion". 1415 /// 1416 /// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are 1417 /// not permitted. 1418 /// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are 1419 /// permitted. 1420 /// 1421 /// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C 1422 /// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to 1423 /// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments. 1424 static ImplicitConversionSequence 1425 TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1426 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1427 AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit, 1428 bool InOverloadResolution, 1429 bool CStyle, 1430 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1431 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 1432 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 1433 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, 1434 ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){ 1435 ICS.setStandard(); 1436 return ICS; 1437 } 1438 1439 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 1440 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1441 return ICS; 1442 } 1443 1444 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4: 1445 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class 1446 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an 1447 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is 1448 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move 1449 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is 1450 // called for those cases. 1451 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 1452 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() && 1453 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) || 1454 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromType, ToType))) { 1455 ICS.setStandard(); 1456 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1457 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType); 1458 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 1459 1460 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid 1461 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it 1462 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the 1463 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed. 1464 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 1465 1466 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion. 1467 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1468 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 1469 1470 return ICS; 1471 } 1472 1473 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 1474 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle, 1475 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1476 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 1477 } 1478 1479 ImplicitConversionSequence 1480 Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1481 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1482 AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit, 1483 bool InOverloadResolution, 1484 bool CStyle, 1485 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 1486 return ::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 1487 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle, 1488 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1489 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 1490 } 1491 1492 /// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the 1493 /// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the 1494 /// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're 1495 /// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit, 1496 /// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted. 1497 ExprResult Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1498 AssignmentAction Action, 1499 bool AllowExplicit) { 1500 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 1501 return ExprError(); 1502 1503 // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion. 1504 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion 1505 = getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 1506 (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending); 1507 if (getLangOpts().ObjC) 1508 CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType, 1509 From->getType(), From); 1510 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = ::TryImplicitConversion( 1511 *this, From, ToType, 1512 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 1513 AllowExplicit ? AllowedExplicit::All : AllowedExplicit::None, 1514 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 1515 /*CStyle=*/false, AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1516 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 1517 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action); 1518 } 1519 1520 /// Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid 1521 /// conversion that strips "noexcept" or "noreturn" off the nested function 1522 /// type. 1523 bool Sema::IsFunctionConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 1524 QualType &ResultTy) { 1525 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1526 return false; 1527 1528 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t) 1529 // or F(t noexcept) -> F(t) 1530 // where F adds one of the following at most once: 1531 // - a pointer 1532 // - a member pointer 1533 // - a block pointer 1534 // Changes here need matching changes in FindCompositePointerType. 1535 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 1536 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 1537 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass(); 1538 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false; 1539 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) { 1540 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) { 1541 CanTo = CanTo.castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1542 CanFrom = CanFrom.castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1543 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) { 1544 CanTo = CanTo.castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1545 CanFrom = CanFrom.castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1546 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) { 1547 auto ToMPT = CanTo.castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 1548 auto FromMPT = CanFrom.castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 1549 // A function pointer conversion cannot change the class of the function. 1550 if (ToMPT->getClass() != FromMPT->getClass()) 1551 return false; 1552 CanTo = ToMPT->getPointeeType(); 1553 CanFrom = FromMPT->getPointeeType(); 1554 } else { 1555 return false; 1556 } 1557 1558 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass(); 1559 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false; 1560 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) 1561 return false; 1562 } 1563 1564 const auto *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom); 1565 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo(); 1566 1567 const auto *ToFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanTo); 1568 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFn->getExtInfo(); 1569 1570 bool Changed = false; 1571 1572 // Drop 'noreturn' if not present in target type. 1573 if (FromEInfo.getNoReturn() && !ToEInfo.getNoReturn()) { 1574 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, FromEInfo.withNoReturn(false)); 1575 Changed = true; 1576 } 1577 1578 // Drop 'noexcept' if not present in target type. 1579 if (const auto *FromFPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FromFn)) { 1580 const auto *ToFPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(ToFn); 1581 if (FromFPT->isNothrow() && !ToFPT->isNothrow()) { 1582 FromFn = cast<FunctionType>( 1583 Context.getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(QualType(FromFPT, 0), 1584 EST_None) 1585 .getTypePtr()); 1586 Changed = true; 1587 } 1588 1589 // Convert FromFPT's ExtParameterInfo if necessary. The conversion is valid 1590 // only if the ExtParameterInfo lists of the two function prototypes can be 1591 // merged and the merged list is identical to ToFPT's ExtParameterInfo list. 1592 SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> NewParamInfos; 1593 bool CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT; 1594 if (Context.mergeExtParameterInfo(ToFPT, FromFPT, CanUseToFPT, 1595 CanUseFromFPT, NewParamInfos) && 1596 CanUseToFPT && !CanUseFromFPT) { 1597 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ExtInfo = FromFPT->getExtProtoInfo(); 1598 ExtInfo.ExtParameterInfos = 1599 NewParamInfos.empty() ? nullptr : NewParamInfos.data(); 1600 QualType QT = Context.getFunctionType(FromFPT->getReturnType(), 1601 FromFPT->getParamTypes(), ExtInfo); 1602 FromFn = QT->getAs<FunctionType>(); 1603 Changed = true; 1604 } 1605 } 1606 1607 if (!Changed) 1608 return false; 1609 1610 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical()); 1611 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false; 1612 1613 ResultTy = ToType; 1614 return true; 1615 } 1616 1617 /// Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid 1618 /// vector conversion. 1619 /// 1620 /// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector 1621 /// conversion. 1622 static bool IsVectorConversion(Sema &S, QualType FromType, 1623 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) { 1624 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector 1625 // conversion. 1626 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType()) 1627 return false; 1628 1629 // Identical types require no conversions. 1630 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1631 return false; 1632 1633 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity. 1634 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) { 1635 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the 1636 // identity conversion. 1637 if (FromType->isExtVectorType()) 1638 return false; 1639 1640 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector. 1641 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) { 1642 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat; 1643 return true; 1644 } 1645 } 1646 1647 if (ToType->isSizelessBuiltinType() || FromType->isSizelessBuiltinType()) 1648 if (S.Context.areCompatibleSveTypes(FromType, ToType) || 1649 S.Context.areLaxCompatibleSveTypes(FromType, ToType)) { 1650 ICK = ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion; 1651 return true; 1652 } 1653 1654 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases: 1655 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types 1656 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the 1657 // same size 1658 // 3)the destination type does not have the ARM MVE strict-polymorphism 1659 // attribute, which inhibits lax vector conversion for overload resolution 1660 // only 1661 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) { 1662 if (S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) || 1663 (S.isLaxVectorConversion(FromType, ToType) && 1664 !ToType->hasAttr(attr::ArmMveStrictPolymorphism))) { 1665 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion; 1666 return true; 1667 } 1668 } 1669 1670 return false; 1671 } 1672 1673 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1674 bool InOverloadResolution, 1675 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 1676 bool CStyle); 1677 1678 /// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard 1679 /// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the 1680 /// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences 1681 /// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class 1682 /// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will 1683 /// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this 1684 /// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this 1685 /// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified. 1686 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType, 1687 bool InOverloadResolution, 1688 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 1689 bool CStyle, 1690 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 1691 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 1692 1693 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv]) 1694 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1695 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false; 1696 SCS.setFromType(FromType); 1697 SCS.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 1698 1699 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so 1700 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit them. 1701 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 1702 (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType())) 1703 return false; 1704 1705 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, 1706 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion 1707 // (C++ 4p1). 1708 1709 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 1710 DeclAccessPair AccessPair; 1711 if (FunctionDecl *Fn 1712 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false, 1713 AccessPair)) { 1714 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function, 1715 // so we can convert to the type of that function. 1716 FromType = Fn->getType(); 1717 SCS.setFromType(FromType); 1718 1719 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check 1720 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool 1721 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType( 1722 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) { 1723 QualType resultTy; 1724 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok 1725 if (!S.IsFunctionConversion(FromType, 1726 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy)) 1727 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard 1728 if (!ToType->isBooleanType()) 1729 return false; 1730 } 1731 1732 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded 1733 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the 1734 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of 1735 // expression. 1736 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn); 1737 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) { 1738 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) && 1739 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address"); 1740 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() 1741 == UO_AddrOf && 1742 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address"); 1743 const Type *ClassType 1744 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr(); 1745 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType); 1746 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) { 1747 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() == 1748 UO_AddrOf && 1749 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression"); 1750 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType); 1751 } 1752 1753 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution. 1754 // FIXME: FixOverloadedFunctionReference has side-effects; we shouldn't 1755 // be calling it from within an NDEBUG block. 1756 assert(S.Context.hasSameType( 1757 FromType, 1758 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType())); 1759 } else { 1760 return false; 1761 } 1762 } 1763 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1): 1764 // A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can 1765 // be converted to a prvalue. 1766 bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue(); 1767 if (argIsLValue && 1768 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() && 1769 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) { 1770 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue; 1771 1772 // C11 6.3.2.1p2: 1773 // ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version 1774 // of the type of the lvalue ... 1775 if (const AtomicType *Atomic = FromType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 1776 FromType = Atomic->getValueType(); 1777 1778 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the 1779 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue 1780 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we 1781 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter. 1782 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1783 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) { 1784 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2) 1785 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer; 1786 1787 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown 1788 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to 1789 // T" (C++ 4.2p1). 1790 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType); 1791 1792 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) { 1793 // This conversion is deprecated in C++03 (D.4) 1794 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true; 1795 1796 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution 1797 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an 1798 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification 1799 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2) 1800 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1801 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification; 1802 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false; 1803 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType); 1804 return true; 1805 } 1806 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) { 1807 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3). 1808 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer; 1809 1810 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(From->IgnoreParenCasts())) 1811 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl())) 1812 if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD)) 1813 return false; 1814 1815 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of 1816 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the 1817 // function. (C++ 4.3p1). 1818 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType); 1819 } else { 1820 // We don't require any conversions for the first step. 1821 SCS.First = ICK_Identity; 1822 } 1823 SCS.setToType(0, FromType); 1824 1825 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating 1826 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion, 1827 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion, 1828 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1). 1829 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type" 1830 // conversion. 1831 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 1832 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity; 1833 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) { 1834 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no 1835 // conversion to do. 1836 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1837 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) { 1838 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5). 1839 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion; 1840 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1841 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) { 1842 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). 1843 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion; 1844 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1845 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) { 1846 // Complex promotion (Clang extension) 1847 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion; 1848 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1849 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() && 1850 (FromType->isArithmeticType() || 1851 FromType->isAnyPointerType() || 1852 FromType->isBlockPointerType() || 1853 FromType->isMemberPointerType())) { 1854 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12). 1855 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion; 1856 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy; 1857 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 1858 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) { 1859 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7). 1860 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion; 1861 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1862 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isAnyComplexType()) { 1863 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6) 1864 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion; 1865 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1866 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) || 1867 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) { 1868 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7) 1869 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real; 1870 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1871 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) { 1872 // FIXME: disable conversions between long double and __float128 if 1873 // their representation is different until there is back end support 1874 // We of course allow this conversion if long double is really double. 1875 1876 // Conversions between bfloat and other floats are not permitted. 1877 if (FromType == S.Context.BFloat16Ty || ToType == S.Context.BFloat16Ty) 1878 return false; 1879 if (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(FromType) != 1880 &S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType)) { 1881 bool Float128AndLongDouble = ((FromType == S.Context.Float128Ty && 1882 ToType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy) || 1883 (FromType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy && 1884 ToType == S.Context.Float128Ty)); 1885 if (Float128AndLongDouble && 1886 (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(S.Context.LongDoubleTy) == 1887 &llvm::APFloat::PPCDoubleDouble())) 1888 return false; 1889 } 1890 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8). 1891 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion; 1892 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1893 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() && 1894 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) || 1895 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 1896 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) { 1897 // Conversions between bfloat and int are not permitted. 1898 if (FromType->isBFloat16Type() || ToType->isBFloat16Type()) 1899 return false; 1900 1901 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9). 1902 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral; 1903 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1904 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1905 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion; 1906 } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion && 1907 S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1908 SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion; 1909 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution, 1910 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 1911 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10). 1912 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion; 1913 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC; 1914 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1915 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, 1916 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) { 1917 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11). 1918 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member; 1919 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) { 1920 SCS.Second = SecondICK; 1921 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1922 } else if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 1923 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) { 1924 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading) 1925 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion; 1926 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1927 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, 1928 InOverloadResolution, 1929 SCS, CStyle)) { 1930 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion; 1931 FromType = ToType; 1932 } else if (tryAtomicConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, SCS, 1933 CStyle)) { 1934 // tryAtomicConversion has updated the standard conversion sequence 1935 // appropriately. 1936 return true; 1937 } else if (ToType->isEventT() && 1938 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) && 1939 From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0) { 1940 SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion; 1941 FromType = ToType; 1942 } else if (ToType->isQueueT() && 1943 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) && 1944 (From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0)) { 1945 SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Queue_Conversion; 1946 FromType = ToType; 1947 } else if (ToType->isSamplerT() && 1948 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext())) { 1949 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion; 1950 FromType = ToType; 1951 } else { 1952 // No second conversion required. 1953 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1954 } 1955 SCS.setToType(1, FromType); 1956 1957 // The third conversion can be a function pointer conversion or a 1958 // qualification conversion (C++ [conv.fctptr], [conv.qual]). 1959 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion; 1960 if (S.IsFunctionConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1961 // Function pointer conversions (removing 'noexcept') including removal of 1962 // 'noreturn' (Clang extension). 1963 SCS.Third = ICK_Function_Conversion; 1964 } else if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle, 1965 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) { 1966 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification; 1967 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion; 1968 FromType = ToType; 1969 } else { 1970 // No conversion required 1971 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 1972 } 1973 1974 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6: 1975 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is 1976 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute 1977 // a conversion. [...] 1978 QualType CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 1979 QualType CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 1980 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType() 1981 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() && 1982 CanonFrom.getLocalQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalQualifiers()) { 1983 FromType = ToType; 1984 CanonFrom = CanonTo; 1985 } 1986 1987 SCS.setToType(2, FromType); 1988 1989 if (CanonFrom == CanonTo) 1990 return true; 1991 1992 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type, 1993 // this is a bad conversion sequence, unless we're resolving an overload in C. 1994 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !InOverloadResolution) 1995 return false; 1996 1997 ExprResult ER = ExprResult{From}; 1998 Sema::AssignConvertType Conv = 1999 S.CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(ToType, ER, 2000 /*Diagnose=*/false, 2001 /*DiagnoseCFAudited=*/false, 2002 /*ConvertRHS=*/false); 2003 ImplicitConversionKind SecondConv; 2004 switch (Conv) { 2005 case Sema::Compatible: 2006 SecondConv = ICK_C_Only_Conversion; 2007 break; 2008 // For our purposes, discarding qualifiers is just as bad as using an 2009 // incompatible pointer. Note that an IncompatiblePointer conversion can drop 2010 // qualifiers, as well. 2011 case Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers: 2012 case Sema::IncompatiblePointer: 2013 case Sema::IncompatiblePointerSign: 2014 SecondConv = ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion; 2015 break; 2016 default: 2017 return false; 2018 } 2019 2020 // First can only be an lvalue conversion, so we pretend that this was the 2021 // second conversion. First should already be valid from earlier in the 2022 // function. 2023 SCS.Second = SecondConv; 2024 SCS.setToType(1, ToType); 2025 2026 // Third is Identity, because Second should rank us worse than any other 2027 // conversion. This could also be ICK_Qualification, but it's simpler to just 2028 // lump everything in with the second conversion, and we don't gain anything 2029 // from making this ICK_Qualification. 2030 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 2031 SCS.setToType(2, ToType); 2032 return true; 2033 } 2034 2035 static bool 2036 IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, 2037 QualType &ToType, 2038 bool InOverloadResolution, 2039 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 2040 bool CStyle) { 2041 2042 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType(); 2043 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) 2044 return false; 2045 // The field to initialize within the transparent union. 2046 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl(); 2047 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields. 2048 for (const auto *it : UD->fields()) { 2049 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS, 2050 CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) { 2051 ToType = it->getType(); 2052 return true; 2053 } 2054 } 2055 return false; 2056 } 2057 2058 /// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the 2059 /// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to 2060 /// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and 2061 /// sets PromotedType to the promoted type. 2062 bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2063 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 2064 // All integers are built-in. 2065 if (!To) { 2066 return false; 2067 } 2068 2069 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or 2070 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if 2071 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise, 2072 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned 2073 // int (C++ 4.5p1). 2074 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() && 2075 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) { 2076 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int 2077 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() || 2078 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is 2079 // less than int to an int. 2080 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType))) { 2081 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int; 2082 } 2083 2084 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt; 2085 } 2086 2087 // C++11 [conv.prom]p3: 2088 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not 2089 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the 2090 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration 2091 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int, 2092 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned 2093 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the 2094 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration 2095 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type 2096 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long 2097 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If 2098 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen. 2099 // C++11 [conv.prom]p4: 2100 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed 2101 // can be converted to a prvalue of its underlying type. Moreover, if 2102 // integral promotion can be applied to its underlying type, a prvalue of an 2103 // unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed can also be 2104 // converted to a prvalue of the promoted underlying type. 2105 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) { 2106 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not 2107 // provided for a scoped enumeration. 2108 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped()) 2109 return false; 2110 2111 // We can perform an integral promotion to the underlying type of the enum, 2112 // even if that's not the promoted type. Note that the check for promoting 2113 // the underlying type is based on the type alone, and does not consider 2114 // the bitfield-ness of the actual source expression. 2115 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isFixed()) { 2116 QualType Underlying = FromEnumType->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 2117 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Underlying, ToType) || 2118 IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, Underlying, ToType); 2119 } 2120 2121 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial. 2122 if (ToType->isIntegerType() && 2123 isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), FromType)) 2124 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType( 2125 ToType, FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType()); 2126 2127 // C++ [conv.prom]p5: 2128 // If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any other 2129 // value of that type for promotion purposes. 2130 // 2131 // ... so do not fall through into the bit-field checks below in C++. 2132 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 2133 return false; 2134 } 2135 2136 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2: 2137 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted 2138 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can 2139 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int, 2140 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int. 2141 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its 2142 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, 2143 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying 2144 // type. 2145 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() && 2146 ToType->isIntegerType()) { 2147 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or 2148 // unsigned. 2149 bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType(); 2150 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType); 2151 2152 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate 2153 // order. Try each of these types. 2154 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = { 2155 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy, 2156 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy , 2157 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy 2158 }; 2159 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) { 2160 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]); 2161 if (FromSize < ToSize || 2162 (FromSize == ToSize && 2163 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) { 2164 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the 2165 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no 2166 // promotion. 2167 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]); 2168 } 2169 } 2170 } 2171 2172 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an 2173 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the 2174 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if 2175 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If 2176 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to 2177 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any 2178 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3). 2179 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the 2180 // conversion. 2181 // 2182 // FIXME: In C, only bit-fields of types _Bool, int, or unsigned int may be 2183 // promoted, per C11 6.3.1.1/2. We promote all bit-fields (including enum 2184 // bit-fields and those whose underlying type is larger than int) for GCC 2185 // compatibility. 2186 if (From) { 2187 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getSourceBitField()) { 2188 Optional<llvm::APSInt> BitWidth; 2189 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) && 2190 (BitWidth = 2191 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->getIntegerConstantExpr(Context))) { 2192 llvm::APSInt ToSize(BitWidth->getBitWidth(), BitWidth->isUnsigned()); 2193 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType); 2194 2195 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int? 2196 if (*BitWidth < ToSize || 2197 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && *BitWidth <= ToSize)) { 2198 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int; 2199 } 2200 2201 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield 2202 // that fits into an unsigned int? 2203 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && *BitWidth <= ToSize) { 2204 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt; 2205 } 2206 2207 return false; 2208 } 2209 } 2210 } 2211 2212 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int, 2213 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4). 2214 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) { 2215 return true; 2216 } 2217 2218 return false; 2219 } 2220 2221 /// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from 2222 /// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so, 2223 /// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type. 2224 bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2225 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 2226 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 2227 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type 2228 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1). 2229 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float && 2230 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) 2231 return true; 2232 2233 // C99 6.3.1.5p1: 2234 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a 2235 // double is promoted to long double [...]. 2236 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2237 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float || 2238 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) && 2239 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble || 2240 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float128)) 2241 return true; 2242 2243 // Half can be promoted to float. 2244 if (!getLangOpts().NativeHalfType && 2245 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half && 2246 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float) 2247 return true; 2248 } 2249 2250 return false; 2251 } 2252 2253 /// Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion. 2254 /// 2255 /// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion 2256 /// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a 2257 /// floating-point or integral promotion. 2258 bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2259 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 2260 if (!FromComplex) 2261 return false; 2262 2263 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 2264 if (!ToComplex) 2265 return false; 2266 2267 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(), 2268 ToComplex->getElementType()) || 2269 IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, FromComplex->getElementType(), 2270 ToComplex->getElementType()); 2271 } 2272 2273 /// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from 2274 /// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the 2275 /// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType, 2276 /// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have 2277 /// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee. 2278 /// 2279 static QualType 2280 BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr, 2281 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType, 2282 ASTContext &Context, 2283 bool StripObjCLifetime = false) { 2284 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer || 2285 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) && 2286 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type"); 2287 2288 /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions. 2289 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 2290 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 2291 2292 QualType CanonFromPointee 2293 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType()); 2294 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee); 2295 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers(); 2296 2297 if (StripObjCLifetime) 2298 Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 2299 2300 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to. 2301 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) { 2302 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it. 2303 if (!ToType.isNull()) 2304 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 2305 2306 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers 2307 // already. 2308 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType)) 2309 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee); 2310 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee); 2311 } 2312 2313 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers. 2314 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee 2315 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals); 2316 2317 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType)) 2318 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee); 2319 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee); 2320 } 2321 2322 static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr, 2323 bool InOverloadResolution, 2324 ASTContext &Context) { 2325 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly. 2326 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903 2327 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() && 2328 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType()) 2329 return !InOverloadResolution; 2330 2331 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 2332 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull 2333 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull); 2334 } 2335 2336 /// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the 2337 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, 2338 /// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++ 2339 /// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that 2340 /// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into 2341 /// ConvertedType. 2342 /// 2343 /// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers 2344 /// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and 2345 /// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the 2346 /// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to 2347 /// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however, 2348 /// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer 2349 /// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be 2350 /// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that 2351 /// should result in a warning. 2352 bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2353 bool InOverloadResolution, 2354 QualType& ConvertedType, 2355 bool &IncompatibleObjC) { 2356 IncompatibleObjC = false; 2357 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType, 2358 IncompatibleObjC)) 2359 return true; 2360 2361 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type. 2362 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 2363 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2364 ConvertedType = ToType; 2365 return true; 2366 } 2367 2368 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*. 2369 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() && 2370 ToType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 2371 ConvertedType = ToType; 2372 return true; 2373 } 2374 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block 2375 // pointer type. 2376 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() && 2377 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2378 ConvertedType = ToType; 2379 return true; 2380 } 2381 2382 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null 2383 // pointer constant. 2384 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() && 2385 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2386 ConvertedType = ToType; 2387 return true; 2388 } 2389 2390 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>(); 2391 if (!ToTypePtr) 2392 return false; 2393 2394 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1). 2395 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2396 ConvertedType = ToType; 2397 return true; 2398 } 2399 2400 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers 2401 // , including objective-c pointers. 2402 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 2403 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() && 2404 !getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 2405 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType( 2406 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(), 2407 ToPointeeType, 2408 ToType, Context); 2409 return true; 2410 } 2411 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>(); 2412 if (!FromTypePtr) 2413 return false; 2414 2415 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 2416 2417 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a 2418 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below. 2419 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) 2420 return false; 2421 2422 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type, 2423 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++ 2424 // 4.10p2). 2425 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() && 2426 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 2427 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2428 ToPointeeType, 2429 ToType, Context, 2430 /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true); 2431 return true; 2432 } 2433 2434 // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion. 2435 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() && 2436 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 2437 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2438 ToPointeeType, 2439 ToType, Context); 2440 return true; 2441 } 2442 2443 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer 2444 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types. 2445 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2446 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2447 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2448 ToPointeeType, 2449 ToType, Context); 2450 return true; 2451 } 2452 2453 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3: 2454 // 2455 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type, 2456 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where 2457 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible 2458 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that 2459 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the 2460 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the 2461 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to 2462 // the null pointer value of the destination type. 2463 // 2464 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility 2465 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion. 2466 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && 2467 ToPointeeType->isRecordType() && 2468 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) && 2469 IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2470 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2471 ToPointeeType, 2472 ToType, Context); 2473 return true; 2474 } 2475 2476 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() && 2477 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2478 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2479 ToPointeeType, 2480 ToType, Context); 2481 return true; 2482 } 2483 2484 return false; 2485 } 2486 2487 /// Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type. 2488 static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){ 2489 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers(); 2490 2491 // Check whether qualifiers already match. 2492 if (TQs == Qs) 2493 return T; 2494 2495 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs)) 2496 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs); 2497 2498 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs); 2499 } 2500 2501 /// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an 2502 /// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion, 2503 /// with the same arguments and return values. 2504 bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2505 QualType& ConvertedType, 2506 bool &IncompatibleObjC) { 2507 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC) 2508 return false; 2509 2510 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from. 2511 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers(); 2512 2513 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types. 2514 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr = 2515 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 2516 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr = 2517 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 2518 2519 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) { 2520 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications), 2521 // then this is not a pointer conversion. 2522 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2523 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType())) 2524 return false; 2525 2526 // Conversion between Objective-C pointers. 2527 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) { 2528 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType(); 2529 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType(); 2530 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS && 2531 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 2532 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType())) 2533 return false; 2534 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr, 2535 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2536 ToType, Context); 2537 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2538 return true; 2539 } 2540 2541 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) { 2542 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C 2543 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to 2544 // complain about it. 2545 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2546 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr, 2547 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2548 ToType, Context); 2549 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2550 return true; 2551 } 2552 } 2553 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers. 2554 QualType ToPointeeType; 2555 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2556 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType(); 2557 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr = 2558 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 2559 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object 2560 // to a block pointer type. 2561 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 2562 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2563 return true; 2564 } 2565 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2566 } 2567 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() && 2568 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 2569 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a 2570 // pointer to any object. 2571 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2572 return true; 2573 } 2574 else 2575 return false; 2576 2577 QualType FromPointeeType; 2578 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2579 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType(); 2580 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr = 2581 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2582 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2583 else 2584 return false; 2585 2586 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this 2587 // is an Objective-C conversion. 2588 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() && 2589 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType, 2590 IncompatibleObjC)) { 2591 // We always complain about this conversion. 2592 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2593 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType); 2594 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2595 return true; 2596 } 2597 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one; 2598 // as in I* to id. 2599 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() && 2600 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() && 2601 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType, 2602 IncompatibleObjC)) { 2603 2604 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType); 2605 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2606 return true; 2607 } 2608 2609 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only 2610 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C 2611 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but 2612 // complain about it). 2613 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType 2614 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2615 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType 2616 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2617 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) { 2618 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an 2619 // Objective-C pointer conversion. 2620 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType) 2621 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType)) 2622 return false; 2623 2624 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these 2625 // function types are obviously different. 2626 if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() || 2627 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() || 2628 FromFunctionType->getMethodQuals() != ToFunctionType->getMethodQuals()) 2629 return false; 2630 2631 bool HasObjCConversion = false; 2632 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType()) == 2633 Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) { 2634 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2635 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(), 2636 ToFunctionType->getReturnType(), 2637 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2638 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2639 HasObjCConversion = true; 2640 } else { 2641 // Function types are too different. Abort. 2642 return false; 2643 } 2644 2645 // Check argument types. 2646 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); 2647 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 2648 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2649 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2650 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType) 2651 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) { 2652 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2653 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType, 2654 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2655 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2656 HasObjCConversion = true; 2657 } else { 2658 // Argument types are too different. Abort. 2659 return false; 2660 } 2661 } 2662 2663 if (HasObjCConversion) { 2664 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer 2665 // conversion, but complain about it. 2666 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2667 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2668 return true; 2669 } 2670 } 2671 2672 return false; 2673 } 2674 2675 /// Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion, 2676 /// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting. 2677 /// 2678 /// \param FromType The type we're converting form. 2679 /// 2680 /// \param ToType The type we're converting to. 2681 /// 2682 /// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying 2683 /// this conversion. 2684 bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2685 QualType &ConvertedType) { 2686 if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount || 2687 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 2688 return false; 2689 2690 // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers). 2691 QualType ToPointee; 2692 if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2693 ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType(); 2694 else 2695 return false; 2696 2697 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers(); 2698 if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() || 2699 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing || 2700 !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty()) 2701 return false; 2702 2703 // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak. 2704 QualType FromPointee; 2705 if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2706 FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType(); 2707 else 2708 return false; 2709 2710 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers(); 2711 if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() || 2712 (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong && 2713 FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak)) 2714 return false; 2715 2716 // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers. 2717 FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing); 2718 if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals)) 2719 return false; 2720 2721 // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they 2722 // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back 2723 // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds. 2724 FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 2725 2726 // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible. 2727 ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 2728 bool IncompatibleObjC; 2729 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee)) 2730 FromPointee = ToPointee; 2731 else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee, 2732 IncompatibleObjC)) 2733 return false; 2734 2735 /// Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to 2736 /// __autoreleasing pointee. 2737 FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals); 2738 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee); 2739 return true; 2740 } 2741 2742 bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2743 QualType& ConvertedType) { 2744 QualType ToPointeeType; 2745 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr = 2746 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2747 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2748 else 2749 return false; 2750 2751 QualType FromPointeeType; 2752 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr = 2753 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2754 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2755 else 2756 return false; 2757 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only 2758 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C 2759 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion. 2760 2761 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType 2762 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2763 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType 2764 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2765 2766 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType) 2767 return false; 2768 2769 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) 2770 return true; 2771 2772 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these 2773 // function types are obviously different. 2774 if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() || 2775 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic()) 2776 return false; 2777 2778 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo(); 2779 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo(); 2780 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo) 2781 return false; 2782 2783 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 2784 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(), 2785 ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) { 2786 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2787 } else { 2788 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getReturnType(); 2789 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getReturnType(); 2790 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) && 2791 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers()) 2792 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType(); 2793 2794 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) { 2795 // OK exact match. 2796 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS, 2797 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2798 if (IncompatibleObjC) 2799 return false; 2800 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2801 } 2802 else 2803 return false; 2804 } 2805 2806 // Check argument types. 2807 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); 2808 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 2809 IncompatibleObjC = false; 2810 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2811 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2812 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) { 2813 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2814 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType, 2815 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2816 if (IncompatibleObjC) 2817 return false; 2818 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2819 } else 2820 // Argument types are too different. Abort. 2821 return false; 2822 } 2823 2824 SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> NewParamInfos; 2825 bool CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT; 2826 if (!Context.mergeExtParameterInfo(ToFunctionType, FromFunctionType, 2827 CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT, 2828 NewParamInfos)) 2829 return false; 2830 2831 ConvertedType = ToType; 2832 return true; 2833 } 2834 2835 enum { 2836 ft_default, 2837 ft_different_class, 2838 ft_parameter_arity, 2839 ft_parameter_mismatch, 2840 ft_return_type, 2841 ft_qualifer_mismatch, 2842 ft_noexcept 2843 }; 2844 2845 /// Attempts to get the FunctionProtoType from a Type. Handles 2846 /// MemberFunctionPointers properly. 2847 static const FunctionProtoType *tryGetFunctionProtoType(QualType FromType) { 2848 if (auto *FPT = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 2849 return FPT; 2850 2851 if (auto *MPT = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 2852 return MPT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2853 2854 return nullptr; 2855 } 2856 2857 /// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing 2858 /// function types. Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in 2859 /// parameter types, and different return types. 2860 void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag, 2861 QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2862 // If either type is not valid, include no extra info. 2863 if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) { 2864 PDiag << ft_default; 2865 return; 2866 } 2867 2868 // Get the function type from the pointers. 2869 if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) { 2870 const auto *FromMember = FromType->castAs<MemberPointerType>(), 2871 *ToMember = ToType->castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2872 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromMember->getClass(), ToMember->getClass())) { 2873 PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0) 2874 << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0); 2875 return; 2876 } 2877 FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType(); 2878 ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType(); 2879 } 2880 2881 if (FromType->isPointerType()) 2882 FromType = FromType->getPointeeType(); 2883 if (ToType->isPointerType()) 2884 ToType = ToType->getPointeeType(); 2885 2886 // Remove references. 2887 FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType(); 2888 ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType(); 2889 2890 // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions. 2891 if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() && 2892 !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) { 2893 PDiag << ft_default; 2894 return; 2895 } 2896 2897 // No extra info for same types. 2898 if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) { 2899 PDiag << ft_default; 2900 return; 2901 } 2902 2903 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = tryGetFunctionProtoType(FromType), 2904 *ToFunction = tryGetFunctionProtoType(ToType); 2905 2906 // Both types need to be function types. 2907 if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) { 2908 PDiag << ft_default; 2909 return; 2910 } 2911 2912 if (FromFunction->getNumParams() != ToFunction->getNumParams()) { 2913 PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumParams() 2914 << FromFunction->getNumParams(); 2915 return; 2916 } 2917 2918 // Handle different parameter types. 2919 unsigned ArgPos; 2920 if (!FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) { 2921 PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1 2922 << ToFunction->getParamType(ArgPos) 2923 << FromFunction->getParamType(ArgPos); 2924 return; 2925 } 2926 2927 // Handle different return type. 2928 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getReturnType(), 2929 ToFunction->getReturnType())) { 2930 PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getReturnType() 2931 << FromFunction->getReturnType(); 2932 return; 2933 } 2934 2935 if (FromFunction->getMethodQuals() != ToFunction->getMethodQuals()) { 2936 PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToFunction->getMethodQuals() 2937 << FromFunction->getMethodQuals(); 2938 return; 2939 } 2940 2941 // Handle exception specification differences on canonical type (in C++17 2942 // onwards). 2943 if (cast<FunctionProtoType>(FromFunction->getCanonicalTypeUnqualified()) 2944 ->isNothrow() != 2945 cast<FunctionProtoType>(ToFunction->getCanonicalTypeUnqualified()) 2946 ->isNothrow()) { 2947 PDiag << ft_noexcept; 2948 return; 2949 } 2950 2951 // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info. 2952 PDiag << ft_default; 2953 } 2954 2955 /// FunctionParamTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types 2956 /// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that 2957 /// they have same number of arguments. If the parameters are different, 2958 /// ArgPos will have the parameter index of the first different parameter. 2959 bool Sema::FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType, 2960 const FunctionProtoType *NewType, 2961 unsigned *ArgPos) { 2962 for (FunctionProtoType::param_type_iterator O = OldType->param_type_begin(), 2963 N = NewType->param_type_begin(), 2964 E = OldType->param_type_end(); 2965 O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) { 2966 // Ignore address spaces in pointee type. This is to disallow overloading 2967 // on __ptr32/__ptr64 address spaces. 2968 QualType Old = Context.removePtrSizeAddrSpace(O->getUnqualifiedType()); 2969 QualType New = Context.removePtrSizeAddrSpace(N->getUnqualifiedType()); 2970 2971 if (!Context.hasSameType(Old, New)) { 2972 if (ArgPos) 2973 *ArgPos = O - OldType->param_type_begin(); 2974 return false; 2975 } 2976 } 2977 return true; 2978 } 2979 2980 /// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the 2981 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for 2982 /// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer 2983 /// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned 2984 /// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an 2985 /// error, or returns false otherwise. 2986 bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 2987 CastKind &Kind, 2988 CXXCastPath& BasePath, 2989 bool IgnoreBaseAccess, 2990 bool Diagnose) { 2991 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 2992 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess; 2993 2994 Kind = CK_BitCast; 2995 2996 if (Diagnose && !IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && !FromType->isAnyPointerType() && 2997 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) == 2998 Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) { 2999 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy)) 3000 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From, 3001 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer) 3002 << ToType << From->getSourceRange()); 3003 else if (!isUnevaluatedContext()) 3004 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_non_literal_null_pointer) 3005 << ToType << From->getSourceRange(); 3006 } 3007 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 3008 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 3009 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(), 3010 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType(); 3011 3012 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() && 3013 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 3014 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an 3015 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion. 3016 unsigned InaccessibleID = 0; 3017 unsigned AmbiguousID = 0; 3018 if (Diagnose) { 3019 InaccessibleID = diag::err_upcast_to_inaccessible_base; 3020 AmbiguousID = diag::err_ambiguous_derived_to_base_conv; 3021 } 3022 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion( 3023 FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, InaccessibleID, AmbiguousID, 3024 From->getExprLoc(), From->getSourceRange(), DeclarationName(), 3025 &BasePath, IgnoreBaseAccess)) 3026 return true; 3027 3028 // The conversion was successful. 3029 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase; 3030 } 3031 3032 if (Diagnose && !IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && 3033 FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 3034 assert(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && 3035 "this should only be possible with MSVCCompat!"); 3036 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_ms_impcast_fn_obj) 3037 << From->getSourceRange(); 3038 } 3039 } 3040 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType = 3041 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 3042 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType = 3043 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 3044 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay. 3045 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the 3046 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions. 3047 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType()) 3048 return false; 3049 } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) { 3050 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 3051 } else { 3052 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 3053 } 3054 } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) { 3055 if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType()) 3056 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast; 3057 } 3058 3059 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other 3060 // reasons. 3061 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) 3062 Kind = CK_NullToPointer; 3063 3064 return false; 3065 } 3066 3067 /// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the 3068 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be 3069 /// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11). 3070 /// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from 3071 /// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType. 3072 bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, 3073 QualType ToType, 3074 bool InOverloadResolution, 3075 QualType &ConvertedType) { 3076 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3077 if (!ToTypePtr) 3078 return false; 3079 3080 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1) 3081 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 3082 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull 3083 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 3084 ConvertedType = ToType; 3085 return true; 3086 } 3087 3088 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers. 3089 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3090 if (!FromTypePtr) 3091 return false; 3092 3093 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D, 3094 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2). 3095 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0); 3096 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0); 3097 3098 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) && 3099 IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), ToClass, FromClass)) { 3100 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(), 3101 ToClass.getTypePtr()); 3102 return true; 3103 } 3104 3105 return false; 3106 } 3107 3108 /// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the 3109 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or 3110 /// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions 3111 /// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns 3112 /// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false 3113 /// otherwise. 3114 bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3115 CastKind &Kind, 3116 CXXCastPath &BasePath, 3117 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) { 3118 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 3119 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3120 if (!FromPtrType) { 3121 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion 3122 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 3123 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) && 3124 "Expr must be null pointer constant!"); 3125 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer; 3126 return false; 3127 } 3128 3129 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3130 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type " 3131 "that is not a member pointer."); 3132 3133 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0); 3134 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0); 3135 3136 // FIXME: What about dependent types? 3137 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class."); 3138 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class."); 3139 3140 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true, 3141 /*DetectVirtual=*/true); 3142 bool DerivationOkay = 3143 IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), ToClass, FromClass, Paths); 3144 assert(DerivationOkay && 3145 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK."); 3146 (void)DerivationOkay; 3147 3148 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass). 3149 getUnqualifiedType())) { 3150 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths); 3151 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv) 3152 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange(); 3153 return true; 3154 } 3155 3156 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) { 3157 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual) 3158 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0) 3159 << From->getSourceRange(); 3160 return true; 3161 } 3162 3163 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess) 3164 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass, 3165 Paths.front(), 3166 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base); 3167 3168 // Must be a base to derived member conversion. 3169 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath); 3170 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer; 3171 return false; 3172 } 3173 3174 /// Determine whether the lifetime conversion between the two given 3175 /// qualifiers sets is nontrivial. 3176 static bool isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(Qualifiers FromQuals, 3177 Qualifiers ToQuals) { 3178 // Converting anything to const __unsafe_unretained is trivial. 3179 if (ToQuals.hasConst() && 3180 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone) 3181 return false; 3182 3183 return true; 3184 } 3185 3186 /// Perform a single iteration of the loop for checking if a qualification 3187 /// conversion is valid. 3188 /// 3189 /// Specifically, check whether any change between the qualifiers of \p 3190 /// FromType and \p ToType is permissible, given knowledge about whether every 3191 /// outer layer is const-qualified. 3192 static bool isQualificationConversionStep(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 3193 bool CStyle, bool IsTopLevel, 3194 bool &PreviousToQualsIncludeConst, 3195 bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) { 3196 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers(); 3197 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers(); 3198 3199 // Ignore __unaligned qualifier if this type is void. 3200 if (ToType.getUnqualifiedType()->isVoidType()) 3201 FromQuals.removeUnaligned(); 3202 3203 // Objective-C ARC: 3204 // Check Objective-C lifetime conversions. 3205 if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime()) { 3206 if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) { 3207 if (isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(FromQuals, ToQuals)) 3208 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true; 3209 FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime(); 3210 ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime(); 3211 } else { 3212 // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different 3213 // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers. 3214 return false; 3215 } 3216 } 3217 3218 // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes. 3219 if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() && 3220 (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) { 3221 FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 3222 ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 3223 } 3224 3225 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv 3226 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile. 3227 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals)) 3228 return false; 3229 3230 // If address spaces mismatch: 3231 // - in top level it is only valid to convert to addr space that is a 3232 // superset in all cases apart from C-style casts where we allow 3233 // conversions between overlapping address spaces. 3234 // - in non-top levels it is not a valid conversion. 3235 if (ToQuals.getAddressSpace() != FromQuals.getAddressSpace() && 3236 (!IsTopLevel || 3237 !(ToQuals.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(FromQuals) || 3238 (CStyle && FromQuals.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(ToQuals))))) 3239 return false; 3240 3241 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in 3242 // every cv for 0 < k < j. 3243 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers() && 3244 !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst) 3245 return false; 3246 3247 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type 3248 // include const. 3249 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = 3250 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst(); 3251 return true; 3252 } 3253 3254 /// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from 3255 /// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion 3256 /// (C++ 4.4). 3257 /// 3258 /// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate 3259 /// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C 3260 /// object lifetime. 3261 bool 3262 Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 3263 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) { 3264 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 3265 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 3266 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 3267 3268 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a 3269 // qualification conversion. 3270 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType()) 3271 return false; 3272 3273 // (C++ 4.4p4): 3274 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first 3275 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...] 3276 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true; 3277 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false; 3278 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(FromType, ToType)) { 3279 if (!isQualificationConversionStep( 3280 FromType, ToType, CStyle, !UnwrappedAnyPointer, 3281 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst, ObjCLifetimeConversion)) 3282 return false; 3283 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true; 3284 } 3285 3286 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types 3287 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number 3288 // of times. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and 3289 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked 3290 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion. 3291 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType); 3292 } 3293 3294 /// - Determine whether this is a conversion from a scalar type to an 3295 /// atomic type. 3296 /// 3297 /// If successful, updates \c SCS's second and third steps in the conversion 3298 /// sequence to finish the conversion. 3299 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3300 bool InOverloadResolution, 3301 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 3302 bool CStyle) { 3303 const AtomicType *ToAtomic = ToType->getAs<AtomicType>(); 3304 if (!ToAtomic) 3305 return false; 3306 3307 StandardConversionSequence InnerSCS; 3308 if (!IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToAtomic->getValueType(), 3309 InOverloadResolution, InnerSCS, 3310 CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) 3311 return false; 3312 3313 SCS.Second = InnerSCS.Second; 3314 SCS.setToType(1, InnerSCS.getToType(1)); 3315 SCS.Third = InnerSCS.Third; 3316 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime 3317 = InnerSCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime; 3318 SCS.setToType(2, InnerSCS.getToType(2)); 3319 return true; 3320 } 3321 3322 static bool isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(ASTContext &Context, 3323 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor, 3324 QualType Type) { 3325 const auto *CtorType = Constructor->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 3326 if (CtorType->getNumParams() > 0) { 3327 QualType FirstArg = CtorType->getParamType(0); 3328 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, FirstArg.getNonReferenceType())) 3329 return true; 3330 } 3331 return false; 3332 } 3333 3334 static OverloadingResult 3335 IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3336 CXXRecordDecl *To, 3337 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User, 3338 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 3339 bool AllowExplicit) { 3340 CandidateSet.clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion); 3341 for (auto *D : S.LookupConstructors(To)) { 3342 auto Info = getConstructorInfo(D); 3343 if (!Info) 3344 continue; 3345 3346 bool Usable = !Info.Constructor->isInvalidDecl() && 3347 S.isInitListConstructor(Info.Constructor); 3348 if (Usable) { 3349 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type, 3350 // suppress conversions. 3351 bool SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType( 3352 S.Context, Info.Constructor, ToType); 3353 if (Info.ConstructorTmpl) 3354 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(Info.ConstructorTmpl, Info.FoundDecl, 3355 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, From, 3356 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 3357 /*PartialOverloading*/ false, 3358 AllowExplicit); 3359 else 3360 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Info.Constructor, Info.FoundDecl, From, 3361 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 3362 /*PartialOverloading*/ false, AllowExplicit); 3363 } 3364 } 3365 3366 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 3367 3368 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 3369 switch (auto Result = 3370 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getBeginLoc(), Best)) { 3371 case OR_Deleted: 3372 case OR_Success: { 3373 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function. 3374 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function); 3375 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(); 3376 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such. 3377 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3378 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 3379 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor; 3380 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 3381 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3382 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()); 3383 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 3384 return Result; 3385 } 3386 3387 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 3388 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 3389 case OR_Ambiguous: 3390 return OR_Ambiguous; 3391 } 3392 3393 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 3394 } 3395 3396 /// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence 3397 /// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type 3398 /// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the 3399 /// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion 3400 /// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns 3401 /// false and User is unspecified. 3402 /// 3403 /// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x 3404 /// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion 3405 /// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2). 3406 /// 3407 /// \param AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit true if the conversion should 3408 /// allow an extra Objective-C pointer conversion on uses of explicit 3409 /// constructors. Requires \c AllowExplicit to also be set. 3410 static OverloadingResult 3411 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3412 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User, 3413 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 3414 AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit, 3415 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 3416 assert(AllowExplicit != AllowedExplicit::None || 3417 !AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 3418 CandidateSet.clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion); 3419 3420 // Whether we will only visit constructors. 3421 bool ConstructorsOnly = false; 3422 3423 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its 3424 // constructors. 3425 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) { 3426 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1: 3427 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or 3428 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a 3429 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the 3430 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate 3431 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of 3432 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within 3433 // the parentheses of the initializer. 3434 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) || 3435 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() && 3436 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType(), ToType))) 3437 ConstructorsOnly = true; 3438 3439 if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getExprLoc(), ToType)) { 3440 // We're not going to find any constructors. 3441 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl 3442 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) { 3443 3444 Expr **Args = &From; 3445 unsigned NumArgs = 1; 3446 bool ListInitializing = false; 3447 if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) { 3448 // But first, see if there is an init-list-constructor that will work. 3449 OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion( 3450 S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet, 3451 AllowExplicit == AllowedExplicit::All); 3452 if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function) 3453 return Result; 3454 // Never mind. 3455 CandidateSet.clear( 3456 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion); 3457 3458 // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as 3459 // arguments, not the entire list. 3460 Args = InitList->getInits(); 3461 NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits(); 3462 ListInitializing = true; 3463 } 3464 3465 for (auto *D : S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl)) { 3466 auto Info = getConstructorInfo(D); 3467 if (!Info) 3468 continue; 3469 3470 bool Usable = !Info.Constructor->isInvalidDecl(); 3471 if (!ListInitializing) 3472 Usable = Usable && Info.Constructor->isConvertingConstructor( 3473 /*AllowExplicit*/ true); 3474 if (Usable) { 3475 bool SuppressUserConversions = !ConstructorsOnly; 3476 if (SuppressUserConversions && ListInitializing) { 3477 SuppressUserConversions = false; 3478 if (NumArgs == 1) { 3479 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type, 3480 // suppress conversions. 3481 SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType( 3482 S.Context, Info.Constructor, ToType); 3483 } 3484 } 3485 if (Info.ConstructorTmpl) 3486 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 3487 Info.ConstructorTmpl, Info.FoundDecl, 3488 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 3489 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 3490 /*PartialOverloading*/ false, 3491 AllowExplicit == AllowedExplicit::All); 3492 else 3493 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a 3494 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc). 3495 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Info.Constructor, Info.FoundDecl, 3496 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 3497 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 3498 /*PartialOverloading*/ false, 3499 AllowExplicit == AllowedExplicit::All); 3500 } 3501 } 3502 } 3503 } 3504 3505 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to. 3506 if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) { 3507 } else if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType())) { 3508 // No conversion functions from incomplete types. 3509 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType = 3510 From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) { 3511 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl 3512 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) { 3513 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates. 3514 const auto &Conversions = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 3515 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 3516 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair(); 3517 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 3518 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 3519 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 3520 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 3521 3522 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 3523 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate; 3524 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))) 3525 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 3526 else 3527 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 3528 3529 if (ConvTemplate) 3530 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate( 3531 ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, 3532 CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 3533 AllowExplicit != AllowedExplicit::None); 3534 else 3535 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, 3536 CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 3537 AllowExplicit != AllowedExplicit::None); 3538 } 3539 } 3540 } 3541 3542 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 3543 3544 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 3545 switch (auto Result = 3546 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getBeginLoc(), Best)) { 3547 case OR_Success: 3548 case OR_Deleted: 3549 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function. 3550 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor 3551 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) { 3552 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1: 3553 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a 3554 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion 3555 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by 3556 // the argument of the constructor. 3557 // 3558 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(); 3559 if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) { 3560 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such. 3561 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3562 } else { 3563 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis()) 3564 User.EllipsisConversion = true; 3565 else { 3566 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 3567 User.EllipsisConversion = false; 3568 } 3569 } 3570 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 3571 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor; 3572 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 3573 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3574 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()); 3575 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 3576 return Result; 3577 } 3578 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion 3579 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) { 3580 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1: 3581 // 3582 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a 3583 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard 3584 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the 3585 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function. 3586 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 3587 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 3588 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion; 3589 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 3590 User.EllipsisConversion = false; 3591 3592 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2: 3593 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the 3594 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type 3595 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence 3596 // is an initialization, the special rules for 3597 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when 3598 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a 3599 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and 3600 // 13.3.3.1). 3601 User.After = Best->FinalConversion; 3602 return Result; 3603 } 3604 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?"); 3605 3606 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 3607 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 3608 3609 case OR_Ambiguous: 3610 return OR_Ambiguous; 3611 } 3612 3613 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 3614 } 3615 3616 bool 3617 Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) { 3618 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 3619 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc(), 3620 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 3621 OverloadingResult OvResult = 3622 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, 3623 CandidateSet, AllowedExplicit::None, false); 3624 3625 if (!(OvResult == OR_Ambiguous || 3626 (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty()))) 3627 return false; 3628 3629 auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates( 3630 *this, 3631 OvResult == OR_Ambiguous ? OCD_AmbiguousCandidates : OCD_AllCandidates, 3632 From); 3633 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous) 3634 Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition) 3635 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange(); 3636 else { // OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty() 3637 if (!RequireCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType, 3638 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition_incomplete, 3639 From->getType(), From->getSourceRange())) 3640 Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition) 3641 << false << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << ToType; 3642 } 3643 3644 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 3645 *this, From, Cands); 3646 return true; 3647 } 3648 3649 // Helper for compareConversionFunctions that gets the FunctionType that the 3650 // conversion-operator return value 'points' to, or nullptr. 3651 static const FunctionType * 3652 getConversionOpReturnTyAsFunction(CXXConversionDecl *Conv) { 3653 const FunctionType *ConvFuncTy = Conv->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 3654 const PointerType *RetPtrTy = 3655 ConvFuncTy->getReturnType()->getAs<PointerType>(); 3656 3657 if (!RetPtrTy) 3658 return nullptr; 3659 3660 return RetPtrTy->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>(); 3661 } 3662 3663 /// Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors 3664 /// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering 3665 /// is possible. 3666 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3667 compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function1, 3668 FunctionDecl *Function2) { 3669 CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1); 3670 CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2); 3671 if (!Conv1 || !Conv2) 3672 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3673 3674 if (!Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() || !Conv2->getParent()->isLambda()) 3675 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3676 3677 // Objective-C++: 3678 // If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from 3679 // a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer, 3680 // respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer, 3681 // because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely 3682 // to keep code working. 3683 if (S.getLangOpts().ObjC && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 3684 bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType(); 3685 bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType(); 3686 if (Block1 != Block2) 3687 return Block1 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3688 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3689 } 3690 3691 // In order to support multiple calling conventions for the lambda conversion 3692 // operator (such as when the free and member function calling convention is 3693 // different), prefer the 'free' mechanism, followed by the calling-convention 3694 // of operator(). The latter is in place to support the MSVC-like solution of 3695 // defining ALL of the possible conversions in regards to calling-convention. 3696 const FunctionType *Conv1FuncRet = getConversionOpReturnTyAsFunction(Conv1); 3697 const FunctionType *Conv2FuncRet = getConversionOpReturnTyAsFunction(Conv2); 3698 3699 if (Conv1FuncRet && Conv2FuncRet && 3700 Conv1FuncRet->getCallConv() != Conv2FuncRet->getCallConv()) { 3701 CallingConv Conv1CC = Conv1FuncRet->getCallConv(); 3702 CallingConv Conv2CC = Conv2FuncRet->getCallConv(); 3703 3704 CXXMethodDecl *CallOp = Conv2->getParent()->getLambdaCallOperator(); 3705 const FunctionProtoType *CallOpProto = 3706 CallOp->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 3707 3708 CallingConv CallOpCC = 3709 CallOp->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv(); 3710 CallingConv DefaultFree = S.Context.getDefaultCallingConvention( 3711 CallOpProto->isVariadic(), /*IsCXXMethod=*/false); 3712 CallingConv DefaultMember = S.Context.getDefaultCallingConvention( 3713 CallOpProto->isVariadic(), /*IsCXXMethod=*/true); 3714 3715 CallingConv PrefOrder[] = {DefaultFree, DefaultMember, CallOpCC}; 3716 for (CallingConv CC : PrefOrder) { 3717 if (Conv1CC == CC) 3718 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3719 if (Conv2CC == CC) 3720 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3721 } 3722 } 3723 3724 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3725 } 3726 3727 static bool hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion( 3728 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) { 3729 return (ICS.isStandard() && ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) || 3730 (ICS.isUserDefined() && 3731 ICS.UserDefined.Before.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr); 3732 } 3733 3734 /// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit 3735 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the 3736 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2). 3737 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3738 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 3739 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1, 3740 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2) 3741 { 3742 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit 3743 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1) 3744 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better 3745 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or 3746 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and 3747 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better 3748 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence 3749 // (13.3.3.1.3). 3750 // 3751 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10: 3752 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as 3753 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is 3754 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable 3755 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence. 3756 3757 // String literal to 'char *' conversion has been deprecated in C++03. It has 3758 // been removed from C++11. We still accept this conversion, if it happens at 3759 // the best viable function. Otherwise, this conversion is considered worse 3760 // than ellipsis conversion. Consider this as an extension; this is not in the 3761 // standard. For example: 3762 // 3763 // int &f(...); // #1 3764 // void f(char*); // #2 3765 // void g() { int &r = f("foo"); } 3766 // 3767 // In C++03, we pick #2 as the best viable function. 3768 // In C++11, we pick #1 as the best viable function, because ellipsis 3769 // conversion is better than string-literal to char* conversion (since there 3770 // is no such conversion in C++11). If there was no #1 at all or #1 couldn't 3771 // convert arguments, #2 would be the best viable function in C++11. 3772 // If the best viable function has this conversion, a warning will be issued 3773 // in C++03, or an ExtWarn (+SFINAE failure) will be issued in C++11. 3774 3775 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings && 3776 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1) != 3777 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS2)) 3778 return hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1) 3779 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3780 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3781 3782 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank()) 3783 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3784 if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank()) 3785 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3786 3787 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of 3788 // the same kind. 3789 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind()) 3790 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3791 3792 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result = 3793 ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3794 3795 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are 3796 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the 3797 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3): 3798 3799 // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than 3800 // list-initialization sequence L2 if: 3801 // - L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X> for some X and L2 does not, or, 3802 // if not that, 3803 // - L1 converts to type "array of N1 T", L2 converts to type "array of N2 T", 3804 // and N1 is smaller than N2., 3805 // even if one of the other rules in this paragraph would otherwise apply. 3806 if (!ICS1.isBad()) { 3807 if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() && 3808 !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement()) 3809 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3810 if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() && 3811 ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement()) 3812 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3813 } 3814 3815 if (ICS1.isStandard()) 3816 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence than 3817 // standard conversion sequence S2 if [...] 3818 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc, 3819 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard); 3820 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) { 3821 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion 3822 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if 3823 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or 3824 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of 3825 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of 3826 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3). 3827 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction == 3828 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction) 3829 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc, 3830 ICS1.UserDefined.After, 3831 ICS2.UserDefined.After); 3832 else 3833 Result = compareConversionFunctions(S, 3834 ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction, 3835 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction); 3836 } 3837 3838 return Result; 3839 } 3840 3841 // Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to 3842 // determine if one is a proper subset of the other. 3843 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3844 compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context, 3845 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 3846 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 3847 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result 3848 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3849 3850 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of 3851 // any non-identity conversion sequence 3852 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion()) 3853 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3854 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion()) 3855 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3856 3857 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) { 3858 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity) 3859 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3860 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity) 3861 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3862 else 3863 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3864 } else if (!Context.hasSimilarType(SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1))) 3865 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3866 3867 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) { 3868 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result 3869 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3870 } 3871 3872 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity) 3873 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3874 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable 3875 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3876 3877 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity) 3878 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3879 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable 3880 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3881 3882 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3883 } 3884 3885 /// Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better 3886 /// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are. 3887 static bool 3888 isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1, 3889 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) { 3890 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4: 3891 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an 3892 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared 3893 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference 3894 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an 3895 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue 3896 // reference*. 3897 // 3898 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits, 3899 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the 3900 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward 3901 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions. 3902 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration. 3903 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier || 3904 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier) 3905 return false; 3906 3907 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue && 3908 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) || 3909 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue && 3910 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference && SCS2.BindsToFunctionLvalue); 3911 } 3912 3913 enum class FixedEnumPromotion { 3914 None, 3915 ToUnderlyingType, 3916 ToPromotedUnderlyingType 3917 }; 3918 3919 /// Returns kind of fixed enum promotion the \a SCS uses. 3920 static FixedEnumPromotion 3921 getFixedEnumPromtion(Sema &S, const StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 3922 3923 if (SCS.Second != ICK_Integral_Promotion) 3924 return FixedEnumPromotion::None; 3925 3926 QualType FromType = SCS.getFromType(); 3927 if (!FromType->isEnumeralType()) 3928 return FixedEnumPromotion::None; 3929 3930 EnumDecl *Enum = FromType->castAs<EnumType>()->getDecl(); 3931 if (!Enum->isFixed()) 3932 return FixedEnumPromotion::None; 3933 3934 QualType UnderlyingType = Enum->getIntegerType(); 3935 if (S.Context.hasSameType(SCS.getToType(1), UnderlyingType)) 3936 return FixedEnumPromotion::ToUnderlyingType; 3937 3938 return FixedEnumPromotion::ToPromotedUnderlyingType; 3939 } 3940 3941 /// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard 3942 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the 3943 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3). 3944 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3945 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 3946 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 3947 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) 3948 { 3949 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence 3950 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3): 3951 3952 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion 3953 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1, 3954 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion 3955 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any 3956 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that, 3957 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK 3958 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2)) 3959 return CK; 3960 3961 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules 3962 // defined below), or, if not that, 3963 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank(); 3964 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank(); 3965 if (Rank1 < Rank2) 3966 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3967 else if (Rank2 < Rank1) 3968 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3969 3970 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank 3971 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules 3972 // applies: 3973 3974 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or 3975 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion 3976 // that is such a conversion. 3977 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()) 3978 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool() 3979 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3980 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3981 3982 // C++14 [over.ics.rank]p4b2: 3983 // This is retroactively applied to C++11 by CWG 1601. 3984 // 3985 // A conversion that promotes an enumeration whose underlying type is fixed 3986 // to its underlying type is better than one that promotes to the promoted 3987 // underlying type, if the two are different. 3988 FixedEnumPromotion FEP1 = getFixedEnumPromtion(S, SCS1); 3989 FixedEnumPromotion FEP2 = getFixedEnumPromtion(S, SCS2); 3990 if (FEP1 != FixedEnumPromotion::None && FEP2 != FixedEnumPromotion::None && 3991 FEP1 != FEP2) 3992 return FEP1 == FixedEnumPromotion::ToUnderlyingType 3993 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3994 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3995 3996 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2: 3997 // 3998 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A, 3999 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to 4000 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion 4001 // of B* to void*. 4002 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid 4003 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context); 4004 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid 4005 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context); 4006 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) { 4007 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to 4008 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion. 4009 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 4010 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4011 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) { 4012 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare 4013 // their derived-to-base conversions. 4014 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK 4015 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, Loc, SCS1, SCS2)) 4016 return DerivedCK; 4017 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid && 4018 !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) { 4019 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void 4020 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an 4021 // inheritance relationship in their sources. 4022 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType(); 4023 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType(); 4024 4025 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer 4026 // conversion, if we need to. 4027 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 4028 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1); 4029 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 4030 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2); 4031 4032 QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4033 QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4034 4035 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 4036 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4037 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 4038 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4039 4040 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the 4041 // other, it is the better one. 4042 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1 4043 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4044 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2 4045 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4046 if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) { 4047 bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1, 4048 FromObjCPtr2); 4049 bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2, 4050 FromObjCPtr1); 4051 if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) { 4052 return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 4053 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4054 } 4055 } 4056 } 4057 4058 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) { 4059 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings. 4060 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2)) 4061 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4062 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1)) 4063 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4064 } 4065 4066 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3, 4067 // bullet 3). 4068 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK 4069 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2)) 4070 return QualCK; 4071 4072 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) { 4073 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4: 4074 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to 4075 // which the references refer are the same type except for 4076 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference 4077 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type 4078 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers. 4079 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2); 4080 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2); 4081 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1); 4082 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2); 4083 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 4084 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 4085 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 4086 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) { 4087 // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different 4088 // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime. 4089 if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding != 4090 SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) { 4091 return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding 4092 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 4093 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4094 } 4095 4096 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the 4097 // type for comparison. 4098 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals) 4099 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals); 4100 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals) 4101 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals); 4102 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) 4103 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4104 if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) 4105 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4106 } 4107 } 4108 4109 // In Microsoft mode (below 19.28), prefer an integral conversion to a 4110 // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion 4111 // is between types of the same size. 4112 // For example: 4113 // void f(float); 4114 // void f(int); 4115 // int main { 4116 // long a; 4117 // f(a); 4118 // } 4119 // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error 4120 // as clang will do in standard mode. 4121 if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && 4122 !S.getLangOpts().isCompatibleWithMSVC(LangOptions::MSVC2019_8) && 4123 SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion && 4124 SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral && 4125 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) == 4126 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2))) 4127 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4128 4129 // Prefer a compatible vector conversion over a lax vector conversion 4130 // For example: 4131 // 4132 // typedef float __v4sf __attribute__((__vector_size__(16))); 4133 // void f(vector float); 4134 // void f(vector signed int); 4135 // int main() { 4136 // __v4sf a; 4137 // f(a); 4138 // } 4139 // Here, we'd like to choose f(vector float) and not 4140 // report an ambiguous call error 4141 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Vector_Conversion && 4142 SCS2.Second == ICK_Vector_Conversion) { 4143 bool SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion = S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes( 4144 SCS1.getFromType(), SCS1.getToType(2)); 4145 bool SCS2IsCompatibleVectorConversion = S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes( 4146 SCS2.getFromType(), SCS2.getToType(2)); 4147 4148 if (SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion != SCS2IsCompatibleVectorConversion) 4149 return SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion 4150 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 4151 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4152 } 4153 4154 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion && 4155 SCS2.Second == ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion) { 4156 bool SCS1IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion = 4157 S.Context.areCompatibleSveTypes(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS1.getToType(2)); 4158 bool SCS2IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion = 4159 S.Context.areCompatibleSveTypes(SCS2.getFromType(), SCS2.getToType(2)); 4160 4161 if (SCS1IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion != 4162 SCS2IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion) 4163 return SCS1IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion 4164 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 4165 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4166 } 4167 4168 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4169 } 4170 4171 /// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion 4172 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their 4173 /// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3). 4174 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 4175 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S, 4176 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 4177 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 4178 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3: 4179 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and 4180 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the 4181 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of 4182 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the 4183 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2). 4184 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second || 4185 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification) 4186 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4187 4188 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification 4189 // conversion (!) 4190 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2); 4191 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2); 4192 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1); 4193 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2); 4194 assert(!T1->isReferenceType() && !T2->isReferenceType()); 4195 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 4196 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 4197 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 4198 4199 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapping 4200 // them. 4201 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) 4202 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4203 4204 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result 4205 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4206 4207 // Objective-C++ ARC: 4208 // Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime 4209 // to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime. 4210 if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime != 4211 SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) { 4212 Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime 4213 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 4214 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4215 } 4216 4217 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(T1, T2)) { 4218 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to 4219 // determine if this still looks like a qualification 4220 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of 4221 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again 4222 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left 4223 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what 4224 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a 4225 // strict subset of qualifiers. 4226 if (T1.getQualifiers().withoutObjCLifetime() == 4227 T2.getQualifiers().withoutObjCLifetime()) 4228 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything 4229 // about how the sequences rank. 4230 // ObjC ownership quals are omitted above as they interfere with 4231 // the ARC overload rule. 4232 ; 4233 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) { 4234 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence. 4235 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse) 4236 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's 4237 // qualifiers. 4238 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4239 4240 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4241 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) { 4242 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence. 4243 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better) 4244 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's 4245 // qualifiers. 4246 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4247 4248 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4249 } else { 4250 // Qualifiers are disjoint. 4251 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4252 } 4253 4254 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done. 4255 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2)) 4256 break; 4257 } 4258 4259 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using 4260 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion. 4261 switch (Result) { 4262 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 4263 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) 4264 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4265 break; 4266 4267 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 4268 break; 4269 4270 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 4271 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) 4272 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4273 break; 4274 } 4275 4276 return Result; 4277 } 4278 4279 /// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion 4280 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their 4281 /// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++ 4282 /// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at 4283 /// conversions between Objective-C interface types. 4284 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 4285 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 4286 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 4287 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 4288 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType(); 4289 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1); 4290 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType(); 4291 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1); 4292 4293 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer 4294 // conversion, if we need to. 4295 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 4296 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1); 4297 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 4298 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2); 4299 4300 // Canonicalize all of the types. 4301 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1); 4302 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1); 4303 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2); 4304 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2); 4305 4306 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3: 4307 // 4308 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and 4309 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B, 4310 // 4311 // Compare based on pointer conversions. 4312 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 4313 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 4314 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/ 4315 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() && 4316 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) { 4317 QualType FromPointee1 = 4318 FromType1->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4319 QualType ToPointee1 = 4320 ToType1->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4321 QualType FromPointee2 = 4322 FromType2->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4323 QualType ToPointee2 = 4324 ToType2->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4325 4326 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*, 4327 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) { 4328 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee1, ToPointee2)) 4329 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4330 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee2, ToPointee1)) 4331 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4332 } 4333 4334 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*, 4335 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) { 4336 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 4337 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4338 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 4339 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4340 } 4341 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 4342 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) { 4343 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1 4344 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4345 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2 4346 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4347 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1 4348 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4349 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2 4350 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4351 4352 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) { 4353 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types 4354 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the 4355 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of 4356 // Objective-C pointer types. 4357 bool FromAssignLeft 4358 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2); 4359 bool FromAssignRight 4360 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1); 4361 bool ToAssignLeft 4362 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2); 4363 bool ToAssignRight 4364 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1); 4365 4366 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id' 4367 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'. 4368 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() && 4369 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())) 4370 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4371 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() && 4372 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())) 4373 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4374 4375 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a 4376 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type 4377 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()) 4378 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4379 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()) 4380 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4381 4382 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class' 4383 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'. 4384 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() && 4385 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())) 4386 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4387 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() && 4388 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())) 4389 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4390 4391 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a 4392 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type. 4393 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()) 4394 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4395 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()) 4396 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4397 4398 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*," 4399 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) && 4400 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() && 4401 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight)) { 4402 if (FromPtr1->isSpecialized()) { 4403 // "conversion of B<A> * to B * is better than conversion of B * to 4404 // C *. 4405 bool IsFirstSame = 4406 FromPtr1->getInterfaceDecl() == ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl(); 4407 bool IsSecondSame = 4408 FromPtr1->getInterfaceDecl() == ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl(); 4409 if (IsFirstSame) { 4410 if (!IsSecondSame) 4411 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4412 } else if (IsSecondSame) 4413 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4414 } 4415 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 4416 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4417 } 4418 4419 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*," 4420 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) && 4421 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight)) 4422 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 4423 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4424 } 4425 } 4426 4427 // Ranking of member-pointer types. 4428 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && 4429 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() && 4430 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) { 4431 const auto *FromMemPointer1 = FromType1->castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4432 const auto *ToMemPointer1 = ToType1->castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4433 const auto *FromMemPointer2 = FromType2->castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4434 const auto *ToMemPointer2 = ToType2->castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4435 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass(); 4436 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass(); 4437 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass(); 4438 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass(); 4439 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4440 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4441 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4442 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4443 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*, 4444 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) { 4445 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee1, ToPointee2)) 4446 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4447 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee2, ToPointee1)) 4448 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4449 } 4450 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::* 4451 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) { 4452 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 4453 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4454 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 4455 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4456 } 4457 } 4458 4459 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) { 4460 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A, 4461 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type 4462 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a 4463 // reference of type A&, 4464 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) && 4465 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) { 4466 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToType1, ToType2)) 4467 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4468 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToType2, ToType1)) 4469 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4470 } 4471 4472 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A. 4473 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type 4474 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a 4475 // reference of type A&, 4476 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) && 4477 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) { 4478 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType2, FromType1)) 4479 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4480 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType1, FromType2)) 4481 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4482 } 4483 } 4484 4485 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4486 } 4487 4488 /// Determine whether the given type is valid, e.g., it is not an invalid 4489 /// C++ class. 4490 static bool isTypeValid(QualType T) { 4491 if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = T->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) 4492 return !Record->isInvalidDecl(); 4493 4494 return true; 4495 } 4496 4497 static QualType withoutUnaligned(ASTContext &Ctx, QualType T) { 4498 if (!T.getQualifiers().hasUnaligned()) 4499 return T; 4500 4501 Qualifiers Q; 4502 T = Ctx.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T, Q); 4503 Q.removeUnaligned(); 4504 return Ctx.getQualifiedType(T, Q); 4505 } 4506 4507 /// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to 4508 /// determine whether they are reference-compatible, 4509 /// reference-related, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by 4510 /// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference 4511 /// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference 4512 /// type being initialized. 4513 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult 4514 Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc, 4515 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2, 4516 ReferenceConversions *ConvOut) { 4517 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() && 4518 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type"); 4519 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type"); 4520 4521 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1); 4522 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2); 4523 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 4524 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 4525 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 4526 4527 ReferenceConversions ConvTmp; 4528 ReferenceConversions &Conv = ConvOut ? *ConvOut : ConvTmp; 4529 Conv = ReferenceConversions(); 4530 4531 // C++2a [dcl.init.ref]p4: 4532 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is 4533 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is similar to T2, or 4534 // T1 is a base class of T2. 4535 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if 4536 // a prvalue of type "pointer to cv2 T2" can be converted to the type 4537 // "pointer to cv1 T1" via a standard conversion sequence. 4538 4539 // Check for standard conversions we can apply to pointers: derived-to-base 4540 // conversions, ObjC pointer conversions, and function pointer conversions. 4541 // (Qualification conversions are checked last.) 4542 QualType ConvertedT2; 4543 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) { 4544 // Nothing to do. 4545 } else if (isCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2) && 4546 isTypeValid(UnqualT1) && isTypeValid(UnqualT2) && 4547 IsDerivedFrom(Loc, UnqualT2, UnqualT1)) 4548 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::DerivedToBase; 4549 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() && 4550 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() && 4551 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2)) 4552 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::ObjC; 4553 else if (UnqualT2->isFunctionType() && 4554 IsFunctionConversion(UnqualT2, UnqualT1, ConvertedT2)) { 4555 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::Function; 4556 // No need to check qualifiers; function types don't have them. 4557 return Ref_Compatible; 4558 } 4559 bool ConvertedReferent = Conv != 0; 4560 4561 // We can have a qualification conversion. Compute whether the types are 4562 // similar at the same time. 4563 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true; 4564 bool TopLevel = true; 4565 do { 4566 if (T1 == T2) 4567 break; 4568 4569 // We will need a qualification conversion. 4570 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::Qualification; 4571 4572 // Track whether we performed a qualification conversion anywhere other 4573 // than the top level. This matters for ranking reference bindings in 4574 // overload resolution. 4575 if (!TopLevel) 4576 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::NestedQualification; 4577 4578 // MS compiler ignores __unaligned qualifier for references; do the same. 4579 T1 = withoutUnaligned(Context, T1); 4580 T2 = withoutUnaligned(Context, T2); 4581 4582 // If we find a qualifier mismatch, the types are not reference-compatible, 4583 // but are still be reference-related if they're similar. 4584 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 4585 if (!isQualificationConversionStep(T2, T1, /*CStyle=*/false, TopLevel, 4586 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst, 4587 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) 4588 return (ConvertedReferent || Context.hasSimilarType(T1, T2)) 4589 ? Ref_Related 4590 : Ref_Incompatible; 4591 4592 // FIXME: Should we track this for any level other than the first? 4593 if (ObjCLifetimeConversion) 4594 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::ObjCLifetime; 4595 4596 TopLevel = false; 4597 } while (Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(T1, T2)); 4598 4599 // At this point, if the types are reference-related, we must either have the 4600 // same inner type (ignoring qualifiers), or must have already worked out how 4601 // to convert the referent. 4602 return (ConvertedReferent || Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2)) 4603 ? Ref_Compatible 4604 : Ref_Incompatible; 4605 } 4606 4607 /// Look for a user-defined conversion to a value reference-compatible 4608 /// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found. 4609 static bool 4610 FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS, 4611 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc, 4612 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues, 4613 bool AllowExplicit) { 4614 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types."); 4615 auto *T2RecordDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 4616 4617 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet( 4618 DeclLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion); 4619 const auto &Conversions = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 4620 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 4621 NamedDecl *D = *I; 4622 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 4623 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 4624 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 4625 4626 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate 4627 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 4628 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 4629 if (ConvTemplate) 4630 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 4631 else 4632 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 4633 4634 if (AllowRvalues) { 4635 // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion 4636 // functions that return lvalues. 4637 if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) { 4638 const ReferenceType *RefType 4639 = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>(); 4640 if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) 4641 continue; 4642 } 4643 4644 if (!ConvTemplate && 4645 S.CompareReferenceRelationship( 4646 DeclLoc, 4647 Conv->getConversionType() 4648 .getNonReferenceType() 4649 .getUnqualifiedType(), 4650 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType()) == 4651 Sema::Ref_Incompatible) 4652 continue; 4653 } else { 4654 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type, 4655 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference 4656 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type. 4657 4658 const ReferenceType *RefType = 4659 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>(); 4660 if (!RefType || 4661 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() && 4662 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())) 4663 continue; 4664 } 4665 4666 if (ConvTemplate) 4667 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate( 4668 ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init, DeclType, CandidateSet, 4669 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, AllowExplicit); 4670 else 4671 S.AddConversionCandidate( 4672 Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init, DeclType, CandidateSet, 4673 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, AllowExplicit); 4674 } 4675 4676 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 4677 4678 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 4679 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best)) { 4680 case OR_Success: 4681 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1: 4682 // 4683 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of 4684 // applying a conversion function to the argument 4685 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a 4686 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the 4687 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity 4688 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an 4689 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter 4690 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion. 4691 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding) 4692 return false; 4693 4694 ICS.setUserDefined(); 4695 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 4696 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion; 4697 ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 4698 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function; 4699 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 4700 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false; 4701 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding && 4702 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding && 4703 "Expected a direct reference binding!"); 4704 return true; 4705 4706 case OR_Ambiguous: 4707 ICS.setAmbiguous(); 4708 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(); 4709 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand) 4710 if (Cand->Best) 4711 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function); 4712 return true; 4713 4714 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 4715 case OR_Deleted: 4716 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted 4717 // conversion; continue with other checks. 4718 return false; 4719 } 4720 4721 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 4722 } 4723 4724 /// Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference 4725 /// initialization. 4726 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4727 TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType, 4728 SourceLocation DeclLoc, 4729 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4730 bool AllowExplicit) { 4731 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference"); 4732 4733 // Most paths end in a failed conversion. 4734 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 4735 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType); 4736 4737 QualType T1 = DeclType->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType(); 4738 QualType T2 = Init->getType(); 4739 4740 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try 4741 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the 4742 // type of the resulting function. 4743 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 4744 DeclAccessPair Found; 4745 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType, 4746 false, Found)) 4747 T2 = Fn->getType(); 4748 } 4749 4750 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer. 4751 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType(); 4752 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context); 4753 4754 Sema::ReferenceConversions RefConv; 4755 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship = 4756 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, &RefConv); 4757 4758 auto SetAsReferenceBinding = [&](bool BindsDirectly) { 4759 ICS.setStandard(); 4760 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity; 4761 // FIXME: A reference binding can be a function conversion too. We should 4762 // consider that when ordering reference-to-function bindings. 4763 ICS.Standard.Second = (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::DerivedToBase) 4764 ? ICK_Derived_To_Base 4765 : (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::ObjC) 4766 ? ICK_Compatible_Conversion 4767 : ICK_Identity; 4768 // FIXME: As a speculative fix to a defect introduced by CWG2352, we rank 4769 // a reference binding that performs a non-top-level qualification 4770 // conversion as a qualification conversion, not as an identity conversion. 4771 ICS.Standard.Third = (RefConv & 4772 Sema::ReferenceConversions::NestedQualification) 4773 ? ICK_Qualification 4774 : ICK_Identity; 4775 ICS.Standard.setFromType(T2); 4776 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2); 4777 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1); 4778 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1); 4779 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 4780 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = BindsDirectly; 4781 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4782 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType(); 4783 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue(); 4784 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4785 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = 4786 (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::ObjCLifetime) != 0; 4787 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 4788 ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false; 4789 }; 4790 4791 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5: 4792 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression 4793 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows: 4794 4795 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression 4796 if (!isRValRef) { 4797 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is 4798 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or 4799 // 4800 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here. 4801 if (InitCategory.isLValue() && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Compatible) { 4802 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1: 4803 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3) 4804 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence 4805 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression 4806 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type, 4807 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a 4808 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1). 4809 SetAsReferenceBinding(/*BindsDirectly=*/true); 4810 4811 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for 4812 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're 4813 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++ 4814 // [over.best.ics]p2). 4815 return ICS; 4816 } 4817 4818 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is 4819 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly 4820 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1" 4821 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this 4822 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable 4823 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best 4824 // one through overload resolution (13.3)), 4825 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() && 4826 S.isCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2) && 4827 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) { 4828 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc, 4829 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false, 4830 AllowExplicit)) 4831 return ICS; 4832 } 4833 } 4834 4835 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a 4836 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference 4837 // shall be an rvalue reference. 4838 if (!isRValRef && (!T1.isConstQualified() || T1.isVolatileQualified())) { 4839 if (InitCategory.isRValue() && RefRelationship != Sema::Ref_Incompatible) 4840 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init, DeclType); 4841 return ICS; 4842 } 4843 4844 // -- If the initializer expression 4845 // 4846 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function 4847 // lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or 4848 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Compatible && 4849 (InitCategory.isXValue() || 4850 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && 4851 (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) || 4852 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) { 4853 // In C++11, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct 4854 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue. 4855 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we 4856 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of 4857 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here. 4858 SetAsReferenceBinding(/*BindsDirectly=*/S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 || 4859 !(InitCategory.isPRValue() || T2->isRecordType())); 4860 return ICS; 4861 } 4862 4863 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not 4864 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to 4865 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type 4866 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with 4867 // "cv3 T3", 4868 // 4869 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer 4870 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion 4871 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base 4872 // class subobject). 4873 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible && 4874 T2->isRecordType() && S.isCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2) && 4875 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc, 4876 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true, 4877 AllowExplicit)) { 4878 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference 4879 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the 4880 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue 4881 // conversion, the program is ill-formed. 4882 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef && 4883 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) 4884 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType); 4885 4886 return ICS; 4887 } 4888 4889 // A temporary of function type cannot be created; don't even try. 4890 if (T1->isFunctionType()) 4891 return ICS; 4892 4893 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and 4894 // initialized from the initializer expression using the 4895 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The 4896 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is 4897 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same 4898 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than, 4899 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed. 4900 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) { 4901 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then 4902 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with 4903 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference 4904 // initialization fails. 4905 // 4906 // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here. 4907 // ObjC GC, lifetime and unaligned qualifiers aren't important. 4908 Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers(); 4909 Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers(); 4910 T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 4911 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 4912 T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 4913 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 4914 // MS compiler ignores __unaligned qualifier for references; do the same. 4915 T1Quals.removeUnaligned(); 4916 T2Quals.removeUnaligned(); 4917 if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals)) 4918 return ICS; 4919 } 4920 4921 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not 4922 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the 4923 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking 4924 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to 4925 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor. 4926 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible && 4927 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType())) 4928 return ICS; 4929 4930 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue 4931 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue. 4932 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related && isRValRef && 4933 Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue()) { 4934 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, Init, DeclType); 4935 return ICS; 4936 } 4937 4938 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2: 4939 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to 4940 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one 4941 // required to convert the argument expression to the 4942 // underlying type of the reference according to 4943 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds 4944 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with 4945 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level 4946 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself 4947 // and does not constitute a conversion. 4948 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions, 4949 AllowedExplicit::None, 4950 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 4951 /*CStyle=*/false, 4952 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 4953 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 4954 4955 // Of course, that's still a reference binding. 4956 if (ICS.isStandard()) { 4957 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 4958 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4959 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 4960 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true; 4961 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4962 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 4963 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) { 4964 const ReferenceType *LValRefType = 4965 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getReturnType() 4966 ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>(); 4967 4968 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p3: 4969 // Except for an implicit object parameter, for which see 13.3.1, a 4970 // standard conversion sequence cannot be formed if it requires [...] 4971 // binding an rvalue reference to an lvalue other than a function 4972 // lvalue. 4973 // Note that the function case is not possible here. 4974 if (isRValRef && LValRefType) { 4975 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType); 4976 return ICS; 4977 } 4978 4979 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true; 4980 ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4981 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 4982 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = !LValRefType; 4983 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4984 ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 4985 } 4986 4987 return ICS; 4988 } 4989 4990 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4991 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 4992 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4993 bool InOverloadResolution, 4994 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 4995 bool AllowExplicit = false); 4996 4997 /// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the 4998 /// initializer list From. 4999 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5000 TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType, 5001 bool SuppressUserConversions, 5002 bool InOverloadResolution, 5003 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 5004 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1: 5005 // When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and 5006 // special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type. 5007 5008 ImplicitConversionSequence Result; 5009 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 5010 5011 // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be 5012 // initialized from init lists. 5013 if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType)) 5014 return Result; 5015 5016 // Per DR1467: 5017 // If the parameter type is a class X and the initializer list has a single 5018 // element of type cv U, where U is X or a class derived from X, the 5019 // implicit conversion sequence is the one required to convert the element 5020 // to the parameter type. 5021 // 5022 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is a character array [... ] 5023 // and the initializer list has a single element that is an 5024 // appropriately-typed string literal (8.5.2 [dcl.init.string]), the 5025 // implicit conversion sequence is the identity conversion. 5026 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) { 5027 if (ToType->isRecordType()) { 5028 QualType InitType = From->getInit(0)->getType(); 5029 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(InitType, ToType) || 5030 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), InitType, ToType)) 5031 return TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType, 5032 SuppressUserConversions, 5033 InOverloadResolution, 5034 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 5035 } 5036 5037 if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)) { 5038 if (S.IsStringInit(From->getInit(0), AT)) { 5039 InitializedEntity Entity = 5040 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType, 5041 /*Consumed=*/false); 5042 if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, From)) { 5043 Result.setStandard(); 5044 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5045 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 5046 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 5047 return Result; 5048 } 5049 } 5050 } 5051 } 5052 5053 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p2: Otherwise, if the parameter type [...] (below). 5054 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2: 5055 // If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and 5056 // all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit 5057 // conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an 5058 // element of the list to X. 5059 // 5060 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p3: 5061 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is "array of N X", if the initializer 5062 // list has exactly N elements or if it has fewer than N elements and X is 5063 // default-constructible, and if all the elements of the initializer list 5064 // can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit conversion sequence is 5065 // the worst conversion necessary to convert an element of the list to X. 5066 // 5067 // FIXME: We're missing a lot of these checks. 5068 bool toStdInitializerList = false; 5069 QualType X; 5070 if (ToType->isArrayType()) 5071 X = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)->getElementType(); 5072 else 5073 toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X); 5074 if (!X.isNull()) { 5075 for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) { 5076 Expr *Init = From->getInit(i); 5077 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5078 TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions, 5079 InOverloadResolution, 5080 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 5081 // If a single element isn't convertible, fail. 5082 if (ICS.isBad()) { 5083 Result = ICS; 5084 break; 5085 } 5086 // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion. 5087 if (Result.isBad() || CompareImplicitConversionSequences( 5088 S, From->getBeginLoc(), ICS, Result) == 5089 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse) 5090 Result = ICS; 5091 } 5092 5093 // For an empty list, we won't have computed any conversion sequence. 5094 // Introduce the identity conversion sequence. 5095 if (From->getNumInits() == 0) { 5096 Result.setStandard(); 5097 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5098 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 5099 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 5100 } 5101 5102 Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList); 5103 return Result; 5104 } 5105 5106 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p4: 5107 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3: 5108 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload 5109 // resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit 5110 // conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple 5111 // constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the 5112 // implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. 5113 if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) { 5114 // This function can deal with initializer lists. 5115 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 5116 AllowedExplicit::None, 5117 InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false, 5118 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 5119 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 5120 } 5121 5122 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p5: 5123 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4: 5124 // Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be 5125 // initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion 5126 // sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. 5127 if (ToType->isAggregateType()) { 5128 // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes 5129 // down to checking whether the initialization works. 5130 // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not. 5131 InitializedEntity Entity = 5132 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType, 5133 /*Consumed=*/false); 5134 if (S.CanPerformAggregateInitializationForOverloadResolution(Entity, 5135 From)) { 5136 Result.setUserDefined(); 5137 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5138 // Initializer lists don't have a type. 5139 Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType()); 5140 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType()); 5141 5142 Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5143 Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType); 5144 Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 5145 Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = nullptr; 5146 } 5147 return Result; 5148 } 5149 5150 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p6: 5151 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5: 5152 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4. 5153 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) { 5154 // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't 5155 // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list- 5156 // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that. 5157 5158 QualType T1 = ToType->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType(); 5159 5160 // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related 5161 // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that. 5162 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) { 5163 Expr *Init = From->getInit(0); 5164 5165 QualType T2 = Init->getType(); 5166 5167 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try 5168 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the 5169 // type of the resulting function. 5170 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 5171 DeclAccessPair Found; 5172 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction( 5173 Init, ToType, false, Found)) 5174 T2 = Fn->getType(); 5175 } 5176 5177 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer. 5178 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship = 5179 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getBeginLoc(), T1, T2); 5180 5181 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related) { 5182 return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType, /*FIXME*/ From->getBeginLoc(), 5183 SuppressUserConversions, 5184 /*AllowExplicit=*/false); 5185 } 5186 } 5187 5188 // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the 5189 // initializer list. 5190 Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions, 5191 InOverloadResolution, 5192 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 5193 if (Result.isFailure()) 5194 return Result; 5195 assert(!Result.isEllipsis() && 5196 "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion."); 5197 5198 // Can we even bind to a temporary? 5199 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() || 5200 (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) { 5201 StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard : 5202 Result.UserDefined.After; 5203 SCS.ReferenceBinding = true; 5204 SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType(); 5205 SCS.BindsToRvalue = true; 5206 SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 5207 SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 5208 SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 5209 } else 5210 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, 5211 From, ToType); 5212 return Result; 5213 } 5214 5215 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p7: 5216 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6: 5217 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class: 5218 if (!ToType->isRecordType()) { 5219 // - if the initializer list has one element that is not itself an 5220 // initializer list, the implicit conversion sequence is the one 5221 // required to convert the element to the parameter type. 5222 unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits(); 5223 if (NumInits == 1 && !isa<InitListExpr>(From->getInit(0))) 5224 Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType, 5225 SuppressUserConversions, 5226 InOverloadResolution, 5227 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 5228 // - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion 5229 // sequence is the identity conversion. 5230 else if (NumInits == 0) { 5231 Result.setStandard(); 5232 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5233 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 5234 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 5235 } 5236 return Result; 5237 } 5238 5239 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p8: 5240 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7: 5241 // In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible 5242 return Result; 5243 } 5244 5245 /// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type 5246 /// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion 5247 /// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad 5248 /// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to 5249 /// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we 5250 /// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences. 5251 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5252 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 5253 bool SuppressUserConversions, 5254 bool InOverloadResolution, 5255 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 5256 bool AllowExplicit) { 5257 if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) 5258 return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 5259 InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 5260 5261 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) 5262 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType, 5263 /*FIXME:*/ From->getBeginLoc(), 5264 SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit); 5265 5266 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType, 5267 SuppressUserConversions, 5268 AllowedExplicit::None, 5269 InOverloadResolution, 5270 /*CStyle=*/false, 5271 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 5272 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 5273 } 5274 5275 static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy, 5276 const CanQualType ToQTy, 5277 Sema &S, 5278 SourceLocation Loc, 5279 ExprValueKind FromVK) { 5280 OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK); 5281 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5282 TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false); 5283 5284 return !ICS.isBad(); 5285 } 5286 5287 /// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object 5288 /// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the 5289 /// expression @p From. 5290 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5291 TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType FromType, 5292 Expr::Classification FromClassification, 5293 CXXMethodDecl *Method, 5294 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) { 5295 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext); 5296 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or 5297 // const volatile object. 5298 Qualifiers Quals = Method->getMethodQualifiers(); 5299 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method)) { 5300 Quals.addConst(); 5301 Quals.addVolatile(); 5302 } 5303 5304 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals); 5305 5306 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us 5307 // to exit early. 5308 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 5309 5310 // We need to have an object of class type. 5311 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 5312 FromType = PT->getPointeeType(); 5313 5314 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we 5315 // better have an lvalue. 5316 assert(FromClassification.isLValue()); 5317 } 5318 5319 assert(FromType->isRecordType()); 5320 5321 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4: 5322 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object 5323 // parameter is 5324 // 5325 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a 5326 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier 5327 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the && 5328 // ref-qualifier 5329 // 5330 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the 5331 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration. 5332 // 5333 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we 5334 // are not allowed to perform user-defined conversions 5335 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of 5336 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to 5337 // non-constant references. 5338 5339 // First check the qualifiers. 5340 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 5341 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers() 5342 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() && 5343 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) { 5344 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers, 5345 FromType, ImplicitParamType); 5346 return ICS; 5347 } 5348 5349 if (FromTypeCanon.hasAddressSpace()) { 5350 Qualifiers QualsImplicitParamType = ImplicitParamType.getQualifiers(); 5351 Qualifiers QualsFromType = FromTypeCanon.getQualifiers(); 5352 if (!QualsImplicitParamType.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(QualsFromType)) { 5353 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers, 5354 FromType, ImplicitParamType); 5355 return ICS; 5356 } 5357 } 5358 5359 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It 5360 // affects the conversion rank. 5361 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType); 5362 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind; 5363 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) { 5364 SecondKind = ICK_Identity; 5365 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType, ClassType)) 5366 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 5367 else { 5368 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class, 5369 FromType, ImplicitParamType); 5370 return ICS; 5371 } 5372 5373 // Check the ref-qualifier. 5374 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) { 5375 case RQ_None: 5376 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness. 5377 break; 5378 5379 case RQ_LValue: 5380 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && !Quals.hasOnlyConst()) { 5381 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue 5382 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType, 5383 ImplicitParamType); 5384 return ICS; 5385 } 5386 break; 5387 5388 case RQ_RValue: 5389 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) { 5390 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue 5391 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType, 5392 ImplicitParamType); 5393 return ICS; 5394 } 5395 break; 5396 } 5397 5398 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding. 5399 ICS.setStandard(); 5400 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5401 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind; 5402 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType); 5403 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType); 5404 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 5405 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true; 5406 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue; 5407 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 5408 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue(); 5409 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier 5410 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None); 5411 return ICS; 5412 } 5413 5414 /// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of 5415 /// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given 5416 /// expression. 5417 ExprResult 5418 Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From, 5419 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier, 5420 NamedDecl *FoundDecl, 5421 CXXMethodDecl *Method) { 5422 QualType FromRecordType, DestType; 5423 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType = 5424 Method->getThisType()->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5425 5426 Expr::Classification FromClassification; 5427 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) { 5428 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType(); 5429 DestType = Method->getThisType(); 5430 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(); 5431 } else { 5432 FromRecordType = From->getType(); 5433 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType; 5434 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context); 5435 5436 // When performing member access on an rvalue, materialize a temporary. 5437 if (From->isRValue()) { 5438 From = CreateMaterializeTemporaryExpr(FromRecordType, From, 5439 Method->getRefQualifier() != 5440 RefQualifierKind::RQ_RValue); 5441 } 5442 } 5443 5444 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing 5445 // the actual argument initialization. 5446 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 5447 *this, From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType(), FromClassification, Method, 5448 Method->getParent()); 5449 if (ICS.isBad()) { 5450 switch (ICS.Bad.Kind) { 5451 case BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers: { 5452 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers(); 5453 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers(); 5454 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers(); 5455 if (CVR) { 5456 Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr) 5457 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1) 5458 << From->getSourceRange(); 5459 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 5460 << Method->getDeclName(); 5461 return ExprError(); 5462 } 5463 break; 5464 } 5465 5466 case BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue: 5467 case BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue: { 5468 bool IsRValueQualified = 5469 Method->getRefQualifier() == RefQualifierKind::RQ_RValue; 5470 Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_ref) 5471 << Method->getDeclName() << FromClassification.isRValue() 5472 << IsRValueQualified; 5473 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 5474 << Method->getDeclName(); 5475 return ExprError(); 5476 } 5477 5478 case BadConversionSequence::no_conversion: 5479 case BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class: 5480 break; 5481 } 5482 5483 return Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_type) 5484 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType 5485 << From->getSourceRange(); 5486 } 5487 5488 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) { 5489 ExprResult FromRes = 5490 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method); 5491 if (FromRes.isInvalid()) 5492 return ExprError(); 5493 From = FromRes.get(); 5494 } 5495 5496 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType)) { 5497 CastKind CK; 5498 QualType PteeTy = DestType->getPointeeType(); 5499 LangAS DestAS = 5500 PteeTy.isNull() ? DestType.getAddressSpace() : PteeTy.getAddressSpace(); 5501 if (FromRecordType.getAddressSpace() != DestAS) 5502 CK = CK_AddressSpaceConversion; 5503 else 5504 CK = CK_NoOp; 5505 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK, From->getValueKind()).get(); 5506 } 5507 return From; 5508 } 5509 5510 /// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the 5511 /// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3). 5512 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5513 TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) { 5514 // C++ [dcl.init]/17.8: 5515 // - Otherwise, if the initialization is direct-initialization, the source 5516 // type is std::nullptr_t, and the destination type is bool, the initial 5517 // value of the object being initialized is false. 5518 if (From->getType()->isNullPtrType()) 5519 return ImplicitConversionSequence::getNullptrToBool(From->getType(), 5520 S.Context.BoolTy, 5521 From->isGLValue()); 5522 5523 // All other direct-initialization of bool is equivalent to an implicit 5524 // conversion to bool in which explicit conversions are permitted. 5525 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy, 5526 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 5527 AllowedExplicit::Conversions, 5528 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5529 /*CStyle=*/false, 5530 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 5531 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 5532 } 5533 5534 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion 5535 /// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3). 5536 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) { 5537 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 5538 return ExprError(); 5539 5540 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From); 5541 if (!ICS.isBad()) 5542 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting); 5543 5544 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy)) 5545 return Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition) 5546 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange(); 5547 return ExprError(); 5548 } 5549 5550 /// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant 5551 /// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion 5552 /// is acceptable. 5553 static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S, 5554 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 5555 // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration 5556 // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third 5557 // conversions are fine. 5558 switch (SCS.Second) { 5559 case ICK_Identity: 5560 case ICK_Integral_Promotion: 5561 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: // Narrowing conversions are checked elsewhere. 5562 case ICK_Zero_Queue_Conversion: 5563 return true; 5564 5565 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: 5566 // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is 5567 // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also arguably an integral 5568 // conversion, so we allow it in a converted constant expression. 5569 // 5570 // FIXME: Per core issue 1407, we should not allow this, but that breaks 5571 // a lot of popular code. We should at least add a warning for this 5572 // (non-conforming) extension. 5573 return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 5574 SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType(); 5575 5576 case ICK_Pointer_Conversion: 5577 case ICK_Pointer_Member: 5578 // C++1z: null pointer conversions and null member pointer conversions are 5579 // only permitted if the source type is std::nullptr_t. 5580 return SCS.getFromType()->isNullPtrType(); 5581 5582 case ICK_Floating_Promotion: 5583 case ICK_Complex_Promotion: 5584 case ICK_Floating_Conversion: 5585 case ICK_Complex_Conversion: 5586 case ICK_Floating_Integral: 5587 case ICK_Compatible_Conversion: 5588 case ICK_Derived_To_Base: 5589 case ICK_Vector_Conversion: 5590 case ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion: 5591 case ICK_Vector_Splat: 5592 case ICK_Complex_Real: 5593 case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion: 5594 case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion: 5595 case ICK_Writeback_Conversion: 5596 case ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion: 5597 case ICK_C_Only_Conversion: 5598 case ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion: 5599 return false; 5600 5601 case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue: 5602 case ICK_Array_To_Pointer: 5603 case ICK_Function_To_Pointer: 5604 llvm_unreachable("found a first conversion kind in Second"); 5605 5606 case ICK_Function_Conversion: 5607 case ICK_Qualification: 5608 llvm_unreachable("found a third conversion kind in Second"); 5609 5610 case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds: 5611 break; 5612 } 5613 5614 llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind"); 5615 } 5616 5617 /// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a 5618 /// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce 5619 /// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3. 5620 static ExprResult CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Sema &S, Expr *From, 5621 QualType T, APValue &Value, 5622 Sema::CCEKind CCE, 5623 bool RequireInt, 5624 NamedDecl *Dest) { 5625 assert(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && 5626 "converted constant expression outside C++11"); 5627 5628 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, From)) 5629 return ExprError(); 5630 5631 // C++1z [expr.const]p3: 5632 // A converted constant expression of type T is an expression, 5633 // implicitly converted to type T, where the converted 5634 // expression is a constant expression and the implicit conversion 5635 // sequence contains only [... list of conversions ...]. 5636 // C++1z [stmt.if]p2: 5637 // If the if statement is of the form if constexpr, the value of the 5638 // condition shall be a contextually converted constant expression of type 5639 // bool. 5640 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5641 CCE == Sema::CCEK_ConstexprIf || CCE == Sema::CCEK_ExplicitBool 5642 ? TryContextuallyConvertToBool(S, From) 5643 : TryCopyInitialization(S, From, T, 5644 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 5645 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5646 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 5647 /*AllowExplicit=*/false); 5648 StandardConversionSequence *SCS = nullptr; 5649 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 5650 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 5651 SCS = &ICS.Standard; 5652 break; 5653 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion: 5654 if (T->isRecordType()) 5655 SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.Before; 5656 else 5657 SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After; 5658 break; 5659 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion: 5660 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 5661 if (!S.DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T)) 5662 return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), 5663 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression) 5664 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 5665 return ExprError(); 5666 5667 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion: 5668 llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression"); 5669 } 5670 5671 // Check that we would only use permitted conversions. 5672 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(S, *SCS)) { 5673 return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), 5674 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed) 5675 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 5676 } 5677 // [...] and where the reference binding (if any) binds directly. 5678 if (SCS->ReferenceBinding && !SCS->DirectBinding) { 5679 return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), 5680 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_indirect) 5681 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 5682 } 5683 5684 // Usually we can simply apply the ImplicitConversionSequence we formed 5685 // earlier, but that's not guaranteed to work when initializing an object of 5686 // class type. 5687 ExprResult Result; 5688 if (T->isRecordType()) { 5689 assert(CCE == Sema::CCEK_TemplateArg && 5690 "unexpected class type converted constant expr"); 5691 Result = S.PerformCopyInitialization( 5692 InitializedEntity::InitializeTemplateParameter( 5693 T, cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(Dest)), 5694 SourceLocation(), From); 5695 } else { 5696 Result = S.PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, Sema::AA_Converting); 5697 } 5698 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5699 return Result; 5700 5701 // C++2a [intro.execution]p5: 5702 // A full-expression is [...] a constant-expression [...] 5703 Result = 5704 S.ActOnFinishFullExpr(Result.get(), From->getExprLoc(), 5705 /*DiscardedValue=*/false, /*IsConstexpr=*/true); 5706 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5707 return Result; 5708 5709 // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion. 5710 bool ReturnPreNarrowingValue = false; 5711 APValue PreNarrowingValue; 5712 QualType PreNarrowingType; 5713 switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(S.Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue, 5714 PreNarrowingType)) { 5715 case NK_Dependent_Narrowing: 5716 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, but the expression is 5717 // value-dependent so we can't tell whether it's actually narrowing. 5718 case NK_Variable_Narrowing: 5719 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant 5720 // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment. 5721 case NK_Not_Narrowing: 5722 break; 5723 5724 case NK_Constant_Narrowing: 5725 if (CCE == Sema::CCEK_ArrayBound && 5726 PreNarrowingType->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && 5727 PreNarrowingValue.isInt()) { 5728 // Don't diagnose array bound narrowing here; we produce more precise 5729 // errors by allowing the un-narrowed value through. 5730 ReturnPreNarrowingValue = true; 5731 break; 5732 } 5733 S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing) 5734 << CCE << /*Constant*/ 1 5735 << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(S.Context, PreNarrowingType) << T; 5736 break; 5737 5738 case NK_Type_Narrowing: 5739 // FIXME: It would be better to diagnose that the expression is not a 5740 // constant expression. 5741 S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing) 5742 << CCE << /*Constant*/ 0 << From->getType() << T; 5743 break; 5744 } 5745 5746 if (Result.get()->isValueDependent()) { 5747 Value = APValue(); 5748 return Result; 5749 } 5750 5751 // Check the expression is a constant expression. 5752 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes; 5753 Expr::EvalResult Eval; 5754 Eval.Diag = &Notes; 5755 5756 ConstantExprKind Kind; 5757 if (CCE == Sema::CCEK_TemplateArg && T->isRecordType()) 5758 Kind = ConstantExprKind::ClassTemplateArgument; 5759 else if (CCE == Sema::CCEK_TemplateArg) 5760 Kind = ConstantExprKind::NonClassTemplateArgument; 5761 else 5762 Kind = ConstantExprKind::Normal; 5763 5764 if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsConstantExpr(Eval, S.Context, Kind) || 5765 (RequireInt && !Eval.Val.isInt())) { 5766 // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in 5767 // the AST. 5768 Result = ExprError(); 5769 } else { 5770 Value = Eval.Val; 5771 5772 if (Notes.empty()) { 5773 // It's a constant expression. 5774 Expr *E = ConstantExpr::Create(S.Context, Result.get(), Value); 5775 if (ReturnPreNarrowingValue) 5776 Value = std::move(PreNarrowingValue); 5777 return E; 5778 } 5779 } 5780 5781 // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic. 5782 if (Notes.size() == 1 && 5783 Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) { 5784 S.Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE; 5785 } else if (!Notes.empty() && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == 5786 diag::note_constexpr_invalid_template_arg) { 5787 Notes[0].second.setDiagID(diag::err_constexpr_invalid_template_arg); 5788 for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I) 5789 S.Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 5790 } else { 5791 S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_cce) 5792 << CCE << From->getSourceRange(); 5793 for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I) 5794 S.Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 5795 } 5796 return ExprError(); 5797 } 5798 5799 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T, 5800 APValue &Value, CCEKind CCE, 5801 NamedDecl *Dest) { 5802 return ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, Value, CCE, false, 5803 Dest); 5804 } 5805 5806 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T, 5807 llvm::APSInt &Value, 5808 CCEKind CCE) { 5809 assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type"); 5810 5811 APValue V; 5812 auto R = ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, V, CCE, true, 5813 /*Dest=*/nullptr); 5814 if (!R.isInvalid() && !R.get()->isValueDependent()) 5815 Value = V.getInt(); 5816 return R; 5817 } 5818 5819 5820 /// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence 5821 /// involves any pointer conversions, remove them. This may change 5822 /// the result type of the conversion sequence. 5823 static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 5824 if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) { 5825 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 5826 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 5827 SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0]; 5828 } 5829 } 5830 5831 /// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually 5832 /// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type. 5833 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5834 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) { 5835 // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'. 5836 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType(); 5837 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS 5838 = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty, 5839 // FIXME: Are these flags correct? 5840 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 5841 AllowedExplicit::Conversions, 5842 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5843 /*CStyle=*/false, 5844 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 5845 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/true); 5846 5847 // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'. 5848 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 5849 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 5850 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion: 5851 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion: 5852 break; 5853 5854 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion: 5855 dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After); 5856 break; 5857 5858 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 5859 dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard); 5860 break; 5861 } 5862 5863 return ICS; 5864 } 5865 5866 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual 5867 /// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type. 5868 /// Returns a valid but null ExprResult if no conversion sequence exists. 5869 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) { 5870 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 5871 return ExprError(); 5872 5873 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType(); 5874 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5875 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From); 5876 if (!ICS.isBad()) 5877 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting); 5878 return ExprResult(); 5879 } 5880 5881 /// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration 5882 /// type of a permitted flavor. 5883 bool Sema::ICEConvertDiagnoser::match(QualType T) { 5884 return AllowScopedEnumerations ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() 5885 : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType(); 5886 } 5887 5888 static ExprResult 5889 diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, 5890 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, 5891 QualType T, UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions) { 5892 5893 if (Converter.Suppress) 5894 return ExprError(); 5895 5896 Converter.diagnoseAmbiguous(SemaRef, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 5897 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) { 5898 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = 5899 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5900 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5901 Converter.noteAmbiguous(SemaRef, Conv, ConvTy); 5902 } 5903 return From; 5904 } 5905 5906 static bool 5907 diagnoseNoViableConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From, 5908 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, 5909 QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates, 5910 UnresolvedSetImpl &ExplicitConversions) { 5911 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && !Converter.Suppress) { 5912 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0]; 5913 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = 5914 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5915 5916 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit 5917 // conversion; use it. 5918 QualType ConvTy = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5919 std::string TypeStr; 5920 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, SemaRef.getPrintingPolicy()); 5921 5922 Converter.diagnoseExplicitConv(SemaRef, Loc, T, ConvTy) 5923 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getBeginLoc(), 5924 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(") 5925 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion( 5926 SemaRef.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getEndLoc()), ")"); 5927 Converter.noteExplicitConv(SemaRef, Conversion, ConvTy); 5928 5929 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the 5930 // explicit conversion function. 5931 if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext()) 5932 return true; 5933 5934 SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found); 5935 ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion, 5936 HadMultipleCandidates); 5937 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5938 return true; 5939 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 5940 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(), 5941 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(), 5942 nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind(), 5943 SemaRef.CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 5944 } 5945 return false; 5946 } 5947 5948 static bool recordConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From, 5949 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, 5950 QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates, 5951 DeclAccessPair &Found) { 5952 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = 5953 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5954 SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found); 5955 5956 QualType ToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5957 if (!Converter.SuppressConversion) { 5958 if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext()) 5959 return true; 5960 5961 Converter.diagnoseConversion(SemaRef, Loc, T, ToType) 5962 << From->getSourceRange(); 5963 } 5964 5965 ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion, 5966 HadMultipleCandidates); 5967 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5968 return true; 5969 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 5970 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(), 5971 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(), 5972 nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind(), 5973 SemaRef.CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 5974 return false; 5975 } 5976 5977 static ExprResult finishContextualImplicitConversion( 5978 Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, 5979 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) { 5980 if (!Converter.match(From->getType()) && !Converter.Suppress) 5981 Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(SemaRef, Loc, From->getType()) 5982 << From->getSourceRange(); 5983 5984 return SemaRef.DefaultLvalueConversion(From); 5985 } 5986 5987 static void 5988 collectViableConversionCandidates(Sema &SemaRef, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 5989 UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions, 5990 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 5991 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) { 5992 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = ViableConversions[I]; 5993 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 5994 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 5995 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 5996 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 5997 5998 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 5999 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate; 6000 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))) 6001 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 6002 else 6003 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 6004 6005 if (ConvTemplate) 6006 SemaRef.AddTemplateConversionCandidate( 6007 ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, CandidateSet, 6008 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, /*AllowExplicit*/ true); 6009 else 6010 SemaRef.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, 6011 ToType, CandidateSet, 6012 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, 6013 /*AllowExplicit*/ true); 6014 } 6015 } 6016 6017 /// Attempt to convert the given expression to a type which is accepted 6018 /// by the given converter. 6019 /// 6020 /// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to a 6021 /// type accepted by the specified converter. In C++11 and before, the class 6022 /// must have a single non-explicit conversion function converting to a matching 6023 /// type. In C++1y, there can be multiple such conversion functions, but only 6024 /// one target type. 6025 /// 6026 /// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the 6027 /// conversion. 6028 /// 6029 /// \param From The expression we're converting from. 6030 /// 6031 /// \param Converter Used to control and diagnose the conversion process. 6032 /// 6033 /// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if 6034 /// successful. 6035 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextualImplicitConversion( 6036 SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) { 6037 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions. 6038 if (From->isTypeDependent()) 6039 return From; 6040 6041 // Process placeholders immediately. 6042 if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) { 6043 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From); 6044 if (result.isInvalid()) 6045 return result; 6046 From = result.get(); 6047 } 6048 6049 // If the expression already has a matching type, we're golden. 6050 QualType T = From->getType(); 6051 if (Converter.match(T)) 6052 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From); 6053 6054 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type? 6055 6056 // We can only perform contextual implicit conversions on objects of class 6057 // type. 6058 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>(); 6059 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6060 if (!Converter.Suppress) 6061 Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 6062 return From; 6063 } 6064 6065 // We must have a complete class type. 6066 struct TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag : TypeDiagnoser { 6067 ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter; 6068 Expr *From; 6069 6070 TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag(ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, Expr *From) 6071 : Converter(Converter), From(From) {} 6072 6073 void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 6074 Converter.diagnoseIncomplete(S, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 6075 } 6076 } IncompleteDiagnoser(Converter, From); 6077 6078 if (Converter.Suppress ? !isCompleteType(Loc, T) 6079 : RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiagnoser)) 6080 return From; 6081 6082 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type. 6083 UnresolvedSet<4> 6084 ViableConversions; // These are *potentially* viable in C++1y. 6085 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions; 6086 const auto &Conversions = 6087 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 6088 6089 bool HadMultipleCandidates = 6090 (std::distance(Conversions.begin(), Conversions.end()) > 1); 6091 6092 // To check that there is only one target type, in C++1y: 6093 QualType ToType; 6094 bool HasUniqueTargetType = true; 6095 6096 // Collect explicit or viable (potentially in C++1y) conversions. 6097 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 6098 NamedDecl *D = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 6099 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion; 6100 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 6101 if (ConvTemplate) { 6102 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) 6103 Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 6104 else 6105 continue; // C++11 does not consider conversion operator templates(?). 6106 } else 6107 Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 6108 6109 assert((!ConvTemplate || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) && 6110 "Conversion operator templates are considered potentially " 6111 "viable in C++1y"); 6112 6113 QualType CurToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 6114 if (Converter.match(CurToType) || ConvTemplate) { 6115 6116 if (Conversion->isExplicit()) { 6117 // FIXME: For C++1y, do we need this restriction? 6118 // cf. diagnoseNoViableConversion() 6119 if (!ConvTemplate) 6120 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess()); 6121 } else { 6122 if (!ConvTemplate && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) { 6123 if (ToType.isNull()) 6124 ToType = CurToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 6125 else if (HasUniqueTargetType && 6126 (CurToType.getUnqualifiedType() != ToType)) 6127 HasUniqueTargetType = false; 6128 } 6129 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess()); 6130 } 6131 } 6132 } 6133 6134 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) { 6135 // C++1y [conv]p6: 6136 // ... An expression e of class type E appearing in such a context 6137 // is said to be contextually implicitly converted to a specified 6138 // type T and is well-formed if and only if e can be implicitly 6139 // converted to a type T that is determined as follows: E is searched 6140 // for conversion functions whose return type is cv T or reference to 6141 // cv T such that T is allowed by the context. There shall be 6142 // exactly one such T. 6143 6144 // If no unique T is found: 6145 if (ToType.isNull()) { 6146 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6147 HadMultipleCandidates, 6148 ExplicitConversions)) 6149 return ExprError(); 6150 return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter); 6151 } 6152 6153 // If more than one unique Ts are found: 6154 if (!HasUniqueTargetType) 6155 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6156 ViableConversions); 6157 6158 // If one unique T is found: 6159 // First, build a candidate set from the previously recorded 6160 // potentially viable conversions. 6161 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 6162 collectViableConversionCandidates(*this, From, ToType, ViableConversions, 6163 CandidateSet); 6164 6165 // Then, perform overload resolution over the candidate set. 6166 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 6167 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Loc, Best)) { 6168 case OR_Success: { 6169 // Apply this conversion. 6170 DeclAccessPair Found = 6171 DeclAccessPair::make(Best->Function, Best->FoundDecl.getAccess()); 6172 if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6173 HadMultipleCandidates, Found)) 6174 return ExprError(); 6175 break; 6176 } 6177 case OR_Ambiguous: 6178 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6179 ViableConversions); 6180 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 6181 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6182 HadMultipleCandidates, 6183 ExplicitConversions)) 6184 return ExprError(); 6185 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 6186 case OR_Deleted: 6187 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type. 6188 break; 6189 } 6190 } else { 6191 switch (ViableConversions.size()) { 6192 case 0: { 6193 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6194 HadMultipleCandidates, 6195 ExplicitConversions)) 6196 return ExprError(); 6197 6198 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type. 6199 break; 6200 } 6201 case 1: { 6202 // Apply this conversion. 6203 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0]; 6204 if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6205 HadMultipleCandidates, Found)) 6206 return ExprError(); 6207 break; 6208 } 6209 default: 6210 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6211 ViableConversions); 6212 } 6213 } 6214 6215 return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter); 6216 } 6217 6218 /// IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate - Determine whether Fn is 6219 /// an acceptable non-member overloaded operator for a call whose 6220 /// arguments have types T1 (and, if non-empty, T2). This routine 6221 /// implements the check in C++ [over.match.oper]p3b2 concerning 6222 /// enumeration types. 6223 static bool IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(ASTContext &Context, 6224 FunctionDecl *Fn, 6225 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 6226 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType(); 6227 QualType T2 = Args.size() > 1 ? Args[1]->getType() : QualType(); 6228 6229 if (T1->isDependentType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isDependentType())) 6230 return true; 6231 6232 if (T1->isRecordType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isRecordType())) 6233 return true; 6234 6235 const auto *Proto = Fn->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 6236 if (Proto->getNumParams() < 1) 6237 return false; 6238 6239 if (T1->isEnumeralType()) { 6240 QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(0).getNonReferenceType(); 6241 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, ArgType)) 6242 return true; 6243 } 6244 6245 if (Proto->getNumParams() < 2) 6246 return false; 6247 6248 if (!T2.isNull() && T2->isEnumeralType()) { 6249 QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(1).getNonReferenceType(); 6250 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T2, ArgType)) 6251 return true; 6252 } 6253 6254 return false; 6255 } 6256 6257 /// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of 6258 /// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If 6259 /// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined 6260 /// conversions via constructors or conversion operators. 6261 /// 6262 /// \param PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading 6263 /// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by 6264 /// code completion. 6265 void Sema::AddOverloadCandidate( 6266 FunctionDecl *Function, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6267 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions, 6268 bool PartialOverloading, bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowExplicitConversions, 6269 ADLCallKind IsADLCandidate, ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions, 6270 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 6271 const FunctionProtoType *Proto 6272 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()); 6273 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded"); 6274 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 6275 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates"); 6276 6277 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) { 6278 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) { 6279 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function 6280 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g., 6281 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created 6282 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member 6283 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied 6284 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context 6285 // is irrelevant. 6286 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(), QualType(), 6287 Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(), Args, 6288 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 6289 PartialOverloading, EarlyConversions, PO); 6290 return; 6291 } 6292 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object 6293 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution. 6294 } 6295 6296 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function, PO)) 6297 return; 6298 6299 // C++11 [class.copy]p11: [DR1402] 6300 // A defaulted move constructor that is defined as deleted is ignored by 6301 // overload resolution. 6302 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function); 6303 if (Constructor && Constructor->isDefaulted() && Constructor->isDeleted() && 6304 Constructor->isMoveConstructor()) 6305 return; 6306 6307 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 6308 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 6309 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 6310 6311 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 6312 // if no operand has a class type, only those non-member functions in the 6313 // lookup set that have a first parameter of type T1 or "reference to 6314 // (possibly cv-qualified) T1", when T1 is an enumeration type, or (if there 6315 // is a right operand) a second parameter of type T2 or "reference to 6316 // (possibly cv-qualified) T2", when T2 is an enumeration type, are 6317 // candidate functions. 6318 if (CandidateSet.getKind() == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator && 6319 !IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(Context, Function, Args)) 6320 return; 6321 6322 // Add this candidate 6323 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 6324 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size(), EarlyConversions); 6325 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6326 Candidate.Function = Function; 6327 Candidate.Viable = true; 6328 Candidate.RewriteKind = 6329 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Function, PO); 6330 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6331 Candidate.IsADLCandidate = IsADLCandidate; 6332 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 6333 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 6334 6335 // Explicit functions are not actually candidates at all if we're not 6336 // allowing them in this context, but keep them around so we can point 6337 // to them in diagnostics. 6338 if (!AllowExplicit && ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(Function).isExplicit()) { 6339 Candidate.Viable = false; 6340 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit; 6341 return; 6342 } 6343 6344 if (Function->isMultiVersion() && Function->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() && 6345 !Function->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) { 6346 Candidate.Viable = false; 6347 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function; 6348 return; 6349 } 6350 6351 if (Constructor) { 6352 // C++ [class.copy]p3: 6353 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy 6354 // of a class object to an object of its class type. 6355 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent()); 6356 if (Args.size() == 1 && Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() && 6357 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) || 6358 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getBeginLoc(), Args[0]->getType(), 6359 ClassType))) { 6360 Candidate.Viable = false; 6361 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_illegal_constructor; 6362 return; 6363 } 6364 6365 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p8: (proposed DR resolution) 6366 // A constructor inherited from class type C that has a first parameter 6367 // of type "reference to P" (including such a constructor instantiated 6368 // from a template) is excluded from the set of candidate functions when 6369 // constructing an object of type cv D if the argument list has exactly 6370 // one argument and D is reference-related to P and P is reference-related 6371 // to C. 6372 auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl.getDecl()); 6373 if (Shadow && Args.size() == 1 && Constructor->getNumParams() >= 1 && 6374 Constructor->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->isReferenceType()) { 6375 QualType P = Constructor->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getPointeeType(); 6376 QualType C = Context.getRecordType(Constructor->getParent()); 6377 QualType D = Context.getRecordType(Shadow->getParent()); 6378 SourceLocation Loc = Args.front()->getExprLoc(); 6379 if ((Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(P, C) || IsDerivedFrom(Loc, P, C)) && 6380 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(D, P) || IsDerivedFrom(Loc, D, P))) { 6381 Candidate.Viable = false; 6382 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_inhctor_slice; 6383 return; 6384 } 6385 } 6386 6387 // Check that the constructor is capable of constructing an object in the 6388 // destination address space. 6389 if (!Qualifiers::isAddressSpaceSupersetOf( 6390 Constructor->getMethodQualifiers().getAddressSpace(), 6391 CandidateSet.getDestAS())) { 6392 Candidate.Viable = false; 6393 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_object_addrspace_mismatch; 6394 } 6395 } 6396 6397 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 6398 6399 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 6400 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 6401 // list (8.3.5). 6402 if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) && 6403 !Proto->isVariadic()) { 6404 Candidate.Viable = false; 6405 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 6406 return; 6407 } 6408 6409 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters 6410 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument 6411 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the 6412 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are 6413 // exactly m parameters. 6414 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments(); 6415 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) { 6416 // Not enough arguments. 6417 Candidate.Viable = false; 6418 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 6419 return; 6420 } 6421 6422 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets. 6423 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 6424 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) 6425 // Skip the check for callers that are implicit members, because in this 6426 // case we may not yet know what the member's target is; the target is 6427 // inferred for the member automatically, based on the bases and fields of 6428 // the class. 6429 if (!Caller->isImplicit() && !IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, Function)) { 6430 Candidate.Viable = false; 6431 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target; 6432 return; 6433 } 6434 6435 if (Function->getTrailingRequiresClause()) { 6436 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 6437 if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Function, Satisfaction) || 6438 !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) { 6439 Candidate.Viable = false; 6440 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied; 6441 return; 6442 } 6443 } 6444 6445 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 6446 // arguments. 6447 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 6448 unsigned ConvIdx = 6449 PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 - ArgIdx : ArgIdx; 6450 if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) { 6451 // We already formed a conversion sequence for this parameter during 6452 // template argument deduction. 6453 } else if (ArgIdx < NumParams) { 6454 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 6455 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 6456 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 6457 // parameter of F. 6458 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx); 6459 Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryCopyInitialization( 6460 *this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, SuppressUserConversions, 6461 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 6462 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6463 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, AllowExplicitConversions); 6464 if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) { 6465 Candidate.Viable = false; 6466 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6467 return; 6468 } 6469 } else { 6470 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 6471 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 6472 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 6473 Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis(); 6474 } 6475 } 6476 6477 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = 6478 CheckEnableIf(Function, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Args)) { 6479 Candidate.Viable = false; 6480 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 6481 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 6482 return; 6483 } 6484 6485 if (LangOpts.OpenCL && isOpenCLDisabledDecl(Function)) { 6486 Candidate.Viable = false; 6487 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_ext_disabled; 6488 return; 6489 } 6490 } 6491 6492 ObjCMethodDecl * 6493 Sema::SelectBestMethod(Selector Sel, MultiExprArg Args, bool IsInstance, 6494 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCMethodDecl *> &Methods) { 6495 if (Methods.size() <= 1) 6496 return nullptr; 6497 6498 for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) { 6499 bool Match = true; 6500 ObjCMethodDecl *Method = Methods[b]; 6501 unsigned NumNamedArgs = Sel.getNumArgs(); 6502 // Method might have more arguments than selector indicates. This is due 6503 // to addition of c-style arguments in method. 6504 if (Method->param_size() > NumNamedArgs) 6505 NumNamedArgs = Method->param_size(); 6506 if (Args.size() < NumNamedArgs) 6507 continue; 6508 6509 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumNamedArgs; i++) { 6510 // We can't do any type-checking on a type-dependent argument. 6511 if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) { 6512 Match = false; 6513 break; 6514 } 6515 6516 ParmVarDecl *param = Method->parameters()[i]; 6517 Expr *argExpr = Args[i]; 6518 assert(argExpr && "SelectBestMethod(): missing expression"); 6519 6520 // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off unless it's 6521 // a consumed argument. 6522 if (argExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast) && 6523 !param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>()) 6524 argExpr = stripARCUnbridgedCast(argExpr); 6525 6526 // If the parameter is __unknown_anytype, move on to the next method. 6527 if (param->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 6528 Match = false; 6529 break; 6530 } 6531 6532 ImplicitConversionSequence ConversionState 6533 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, argExpr, param->getType(), 6534 /*SuppressUserConversions*/false, 6535 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 6536 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6537 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, 6538 /*AllowExplicit*/false); 6539 // This function looks for a reasonably-exact match, so we consider 6540 // incompatible pointer conversions to be a failure here. 6541 if (ConversionState.isBad() || 6542 (ConversionState.isStandard() && 6543 ConversionState.Standard.Second == 6544 ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion)) { 6545 Match = false; 6546 break; 6547 } 6548 } 6549 // Promote additional arguments to variadic methods. 6550 if (Match && Method->isVariadic()) { 6551 for (unsigned i = NumNamedArgs, e = Args.size(); i < e; ++i) { 6552 if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) { 6553 Match = false; 6554 break; 6555 } 6556 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 6557 nullptr); 6558 if (Arg.isInvalid()) { 6559 Match = false; 6560 break; 6561 } 6562 } 6563 } else { 6564 // Check for extra arguments to non-variadic methods. 6565 if (Args.size() != NumNamedArgs) 6566 Match = false; 6567 else if (Match && NumNamedArgs == 0 && Methods.size() > 1) { 6568 // Special case when selectors have no argument. In this case, select 6569 // one with the most general result type of 'id'. 6570 for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) { 6571 QualType ReturnT = Methods[b]->getReturnType(); 6572 if (ReturnT->isObjCIdType()) 6573 return Methods[b]; 6574 } 6575 } 6576 } 6577 6578 if (Match) 6579 return Method; 6580 } 6581 return nullptr; 6582 } 6583 6584 static bool convertArgsForAvailabilityChecks( 6585 Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function, Expr *ThisArg, SourceLocation CallLoc, 6586 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, Sema::SFINAETrap &Trap, bool MissingImplicitThis, 6587 Expr *&ConvertedThis, SmallVectorImpl<Expr *> &ConvertedArgs) { 6588 if (ThisArg) { 6589 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function); 6590 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) && 6591 "Shouldn't have `this` for ctors!"); 6592 assert(!Method->isStatic() && "Shouldn't have `this` for static methods!"); 6593 ExprResult R = S.PerformObjectArgumentInitialization( 6594 ThisArg, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, Method, Method); 6595 if (R.isInvalid()) 6596 return false; 6597 ConvertedThis = R.get(); 6598 } else { 6599 if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) { 6600 (void)MD; 6601 assert((MissingImplicitThis || MD->isStatic() || 6602 isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD)) && 6603 "Expected `this` for non-ctor instance methods"); 6604 } 6605 ConvertedThis = nullptr; 6606 } 6607 6608 // Ignore any variadic arguments. Converting them is pointless, since the 6609 // user can't refer to them in the function condition. 6610 unsigned ArgSizeNoVarargs = std::min(Function->param_size(), Args.size()); 6611 6612 // Convert the arguments. 6613 for (unsigned I = 0; I != ArgSizeNoVarargs; ++I) { 6614 ExprResult R; 6615 R = S.PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 6616 S.Context, Function->getParamDecl(I)), 6617 SourceLocation(), Args[I]); 6618 6619 if (R.isInvalid()) 6620 return false; 6621 6622 ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get()); 6623 } 6624 6625 if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred()) 6626 return false; 6627 6628 // Push default arguments if needed. 6629 if (!Function->isVariadic() && Args.size() < Function->getNumParams()) { 6630 for (unsigned i = Args.size(), e = Function->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 6631 ParmVarDecl *P = Function->getParamDecl(i); 6632 if (!P->hasDefaultArg()) 6633 return false; 6634 ExprResult R = S.BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, Function, P); 6635 if (R.isInvalid()) 6636 return false; 6637 ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get()); 6638 } 6639 6640 if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred()) 6641 return false; 6642 } 6643 return true; 6644 } 6645 6646 EnableIfAttr *Sema::CheckEnableIf(FunctionDecl *Function, 6647 SourceLocation CallLoc, 6648 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6649 bool MissingImplicitThis) { 6650 auto EnableIfAttrs = Function->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>(); 6651 if (EnableIfAttrs.begin() == EnableIfAttrs.end()) 6652 return nullptr; 6653 6654 SFINAETrap Trap(*this); 6655 SmallVector<Expr *, 16> ConvertedArgs; 6656 // FIXME: We should look into making enable_if late-parsed. 6657 Expr *DiscardedThis; 6658 if (!convertArgsForAvailabilityChecks( 6659 *this, Function, /*ThisArg=*/nullptr, CallLoc, Args, Trap, 6660 /*MissingImplicitThis=*/true, DiscardedThis, ConvertedArgs)) 6661 return *EnableIfAttrs.begin(); 6662 6663 for (auto *EIA : EnableIfAttrs) { 6664 APValue Result; 6665 // FIXME: This doesn't consider value-dependent cases, because doing so is 6666 // very difficult. Ideally, we should handle them more gracefully. 6667 if (EIA->getCond()->isValueDependent() || 6668 !EIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution( 6669 Result, Context, Function, llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvertedArgs))) 6670 return EIA; 6671 6672 if (!Result.isInt() || !Result.getInt().getBoolValue()) 6673 return EIA; 6674 } 6675 return nullptr; 6676 } 6677 6678 template <typename CheckFn> 6679 static bool diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith(Sema &S, const NamedDecl *ND, 6680 bool ArgDependent, SourceLocation Loc, 6681 CheckFn &&IsSuccessful) { 6682 SmallVector<const DiagnoseIfAttr *, 8> Attrs; 6683 for (const auto *DIA : ND->specific_attrs<DiagnoseIfAttr>()) { 6684 if (ArgDependent == DIA->getArgDependent()) 6685 Attrs.push_back(DIA); 6686 } 6687 6688 // Common case: No diagnose_if attributes, so we can quit early. 6689 if (Attrs.empty()) 6690 return false; 6691 6692 auto WarningBegin = std::stable_partition( 6693 Attrs.begin(), Attrs.end(), 6694 [](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { return DIA->isError(); }); 6695 6696 // Note that diagnose_if attributes are late-parsed, so they appear in the 6697 // correct order (unlike enable_if attributes). 6698 auto ErrAttr = llvm::find_if(llvm::make_range(Attrs.begin(), WarningBegin), 6699 IsSuccessful); 6700 if (ErrAttr != WarningBegin) { 6701 const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA = *ErrAttr; 6702 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_diagnose_if_succeeded) << DIA->getMessage(); 6703 S.Diag(DIA->getLocation(), diag::note_from_diagnose_if) 6704 << DIA->getParent() << DIA->getCond()->getSourceRange(); 6705 return true; 6706 } 6707 6708 for (const auto *DIA : llvm::make_range(WarningBegin, Attrs.end())) 6709 if (IsSuccessful(DIA)) { 6710 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_diagnose_if_succeeded) << DIA->getMessage(); 6711 S.Diag(DIA->getLocation(), diag::note_from_diagnose_if) 6712 << DIA->getParent() << DIA->getCond()->getSourceRange(); 6713 } 6714 6715 return false; 6716 } 6717 6718 bool Sema::diagnoseArgDependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const FunctionDecl *Function, 6719 const Expr *ThisArg, 6720 ArrayRef<const Expr *> Args, 6721 SourceLocation Loc) { 6722 return diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith( 6723 *this, Function, /*ArgDependent=*/true, Loc, 6724 [&](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { 6725 APValue Result; 6726 // It's sane to use the same Args for any redecl of this function, since 6727 // EvaluateWithSubstitution only cares about the position of each 6728 // argument in the arg list, not the ParmVarDecl* it maps to. 6729 if (!DIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution( 6730 Result, Context, cast<FunctionDecl>(DIA->getParent()), Args, ThisArg)) 6731 return false; 6732 return Result.isInt() && Result.getInt().getBoolValue(); 6733 }); 6734 } 6735 6736 bool Sema::diagnoseArgIndependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const NamedDecl *ND, 6737 SourceLocation Loc) { 6738 return diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith( 6739 *this, ND, /*ArgDependent=*/false, Loc, 6740 [&](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { 6741 bool Result; 6742 return DIA->getCond()->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Result, Context) && 6743 Result; 6744 }); 6745 } 6746 6747 /// Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to 6748 /// the overload candidate set. 6749 void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 6750 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6751 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 6752 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 6753 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6754 bool PartialOverloading, 6755 bool FirstArgumentIsBase) { 6756 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) { 6757 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl(); 6758 ArrayRef<Expr *> FunctionArgs = Args; 6759 6760 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 6761 FunctionDecl *FD = 6762 FunTmpl ? FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl() : cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 6763 6764 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic()) { 6765 QualType ObjectType; 6766 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification; 6767 if (Args.size() > 0) { 6768 if (Expr *E = Args[0]) { 6769 // Use the explicit base to restrict the lookup: 6770 ObjectType = E->getType(); 6771 // Pointers in the object arguments are implicitly dereferenced, so we 6772 // always classify them as l-values. 6773 if (!ObjectType.isNull() && ObjectType->isPointerType()) 6774 ObjectClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(); 6775 else 6776 ObjectClassification = E->Classify(Context); 6777 } // .. else there is an implicit base. 6778 FunctionArgs = Args.slice(1); 6779 } 6780 if (FunTmpl) { 6781 AddMethodTemplateCandidate( 6782 FunTmpl, F.getPair(), 6783 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()), 6784 ExplicitTemplateArgs, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 6785 FunctionArgs, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 6786 PartialOverloading); 6787 } else { 6788 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(), 6789 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(), ObjectType, 6790 ObjectClassification, FunctionArgs, CandidateSet, 6791 SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading); 6792 } 6793 } else { 6794 // This branch handles both standalone functions and static methods. 6795 6796 // Slice the first argument (which is the base) when we access 6797 // static method as non-static. 6798 if (Args.size() > 0 && 6799 (!Args[0] || (FirstArgumentIsBase && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && 6800 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)))) { 6801 assert(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic()); 6802 FunctionArgs = Args.slice(1); 6803 } 6804 if (FunTmpl) { 6805 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(), 6806 ExplicitTemplateArgs, FunctionArgs, 6807 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 6808 PartialOverloading); 6809 } else { 6810 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), FunctionArgs, CandidateSet, 6811 SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading); 6812 } 6813 } 6814 } 6815 } 6816 6817 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of 6818 /// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set. 6819 void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, QualType ObjectType, 6820 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, 6821 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6822 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 6823 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6824 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 6825 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 6826 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext()); 6827 6828 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)) 6829 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl(); 6830 6831 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) { 6832 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) && 6833 "Expected a member function template"); 6834 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext, 6835 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, ObjectType, 6836 ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 6837 SuppressUserConversions, false, PO); 6838 } else { 6839 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext, 6840 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 6841 SuppressUserConversions, false, None, PO); 6842 } 6843 } 6844 6845 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set 6846 /// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments 6847 /// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call 6848 /// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain 6849 /// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't 6850 /// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion 6851 /// operators. 6852 void 6853 Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6854 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType, 6855 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, 6856 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6857 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 6858 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6859 bool PartialOverloading, 6860 ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions, 6861 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 6862 const FunctionProtoType *Proto 6863 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()); 6864 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded"); 6865 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) && 6866 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors"); 6867 6868 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method, PO)) 6869 return; 6870 6871 // C++11 [class.copy]p23: [DR1402] 6872 // A defaulted move assignment operator that is defined as deleted is 6873 // ignored by overload resolution. 6874 if (Method->isDefaulted() && Method->isDeleted() && 6875 Method->isMoveAssignmentOperator()) 6876 return; 6877 6878 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 6879 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 6880 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 6881 6882 // Add this candidate 6883 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 6884 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1, EarlyConversions); 6885 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6886 Candidate.Function = Method; 6887 Candidate.RewriteKind = 6888 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Method, PO); 6889 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6890 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 6891 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 6892 6893 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 6894 6895 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 6896 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 6897 // list (8.3.5). 6898 if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) && 6899 !Proto->isVariadic()) { 6900 Candidate.Viable = false; 6901 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 6902 return; 6903 } 6904 6905 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters 6906 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument 6907 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the 6908 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are 6909 // exactly m parameters. 6910 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments(); 6911 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) { 6912 // Not enough arguments. 6913 Candidate.Viable = false; 6914 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 6915 return; 6916 } 6917 6918 Candidate.Viable = true; 6919 6920 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull()) 6921 // The implicit object argument is ignored. 6922 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true; 6923 else { 6924 unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 : 0; 6925 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object 6926 // parameter. 6927 Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 6928 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 6929 Method, ActingContext); 6930 if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) { 6931 Candidate.Viable = false; 6932 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6933 return; 6934 } 6935 } 6936 6937 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets. 6938 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 6939 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) 6940 if (!IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, Method)) { 6941 Candidate.Viable = false; 6942 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target; 6943 return; 6944 } 6945 6946 if (Method->getTrailingRequiresClause()) { 6947 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 6948 if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Method, Satisfaction) || 6949 !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) { 6950 Candidate.Viable = false; 6951 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied; 6952 return; 6953 } 6954 } 6955 6956 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 6957 // arguments. 6958 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 6959 unsigned ConvIdx = 6960 PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 0 : (ArgIdx + 1); 6961 if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) { 6962 // We already formed a conversion sequence for this parameter during 6963 // template argument deduction. 6964 } else if (ArgIdx < NumParams) { 6965 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 6966 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 6967 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 6968 // parameter of F. 6969 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx); 6970 Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx] 6971 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 6972 SuppressUserConversions, 6973 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 6974 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6975 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 6976 if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) { 6977 Candidate.Viable = false; 6978 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6979 return; 6980 } 6981 } else { 6982 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 6983 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 6984 // considered to "match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 6985 Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis(); 6986 } 6987 } 6988 6989 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = 6990 CheckEnableIf(Method, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Args, true)) { 6991 Candidate.Viable = false; 6992 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 6993 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 6994 return; 6995 } 6996 6997 if (Method->isMultiVersion() && Method->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() && 6998 !Method->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) { 6999 Candidate.Viable = false; 7000 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function; 7001 } 7002 } 7003 7004 /// Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate 7005 /// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member 7006 /// function template specialization. 7007 void Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate( 7008 FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 7009 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 7010 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, QualType ObjectType, 7011 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7012 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions, 7013 bool PartialOverloading, OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 7014 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl, PO)) 7015 return; 7016 7017 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7: 7018 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate 7019 // function template specializations are generated using template argument 7020 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as 7021 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one 7022 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template 7023 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each 7024 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate 7025 // functions. 7026 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation()); 7027 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 7028 ConversionSequenceList Conversions; 7029 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result = DeduceTemplateArguments( 7030 MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, Specialization, Info, 7031 PartialOverloading, [&](ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes) { 7032 return CheckNonDependentConversions( 7033 MethodTmpl, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, Conversions, 7034 SuppressUserConversions, ActingContext, ObjectType, 7035 ObjectClassification, PO); 7036 })) { 7037 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 7038 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Conversions.size(), Conversions); 7039 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7040 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(); 7041 Candidate.Viable = false; 7042 Candidate.RewriteKind = 7043 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Candidate.Function, PO); 7044 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 7045 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = 7046 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Candidate.Function)->isStatic() || 7047 ObjectType.isNull(); 7048 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 7049 if (Result == TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure) 7050 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7051 else { 7052 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 7053 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 7054 Info); 7055 } 7056 return; 7057 } 7058 7059 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument 7060 // deduction as a candidate. 7061 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?"); 7062 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) && 7063 "Specialization is not a member function?"); 7064 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl, 7065 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, 7066 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading, 7067 Conversions, PO); 7068 } 7069 7070 /// Determine whether a given function template has a simple explicit specifier 7071 /// or a non-value-dependent explicit-specification that evaluates to true. 7072 static bool isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD) { 7073 return ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(FTD->getTemplatedDecl()).isExplicit(); 7074 } 7075 7076 /// Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate 7077 /// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce 7078 /// an appropriate function template specialization. 7079 void Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 7080 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 7081 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7082 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions, 7083 bool PartialOverloading, bool AllowExplicit, ADLCallKind IsADLCandidate, 7084 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 7085 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate, PO)) 7086 return; 7087 7088 // If the function template has a non-dependent explicit specification, 7089 // exclude it now if appropriate; we are not permitted to perform deduction 7090 // and substitution in this case. 7091 if (!AllowExplicit && isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplate)) { 7092 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 7093 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7094 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 7095 Candidate.Viable = false; 7096 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit; 7097 return; 7098 } 7099 7100 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7: 7101 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate 7102 // function template specializations are generated using template argument 7103 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as 7104 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one 7105 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template 7106 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each 7107 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate 7108 // functions. 7109 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation()); 7110 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 7111 ConversionSequenceList Conversions; 7112 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result = DeduceTemplateArguments( 7113 FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, Specialization, Info, 7114 PartialOverloading, [&](ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes) { 7115 return CheckNonDependentConversions( 7116 FunctionTemplate, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, Conversions, 7117 SuppressUserConversions, nullptr, QualType(), {}, PO); 7118 })) { 7119 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 7120 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Conversions.size(), Conversions); 7121 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7122 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 7123 Candidate.Viable = false; 7124 Candidate.RewriteKind = 7125 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Candidate.Function, PO); 7126 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 7127 Candidate.IsADLCandidate = IsADLCandidate; 7128 // Ignore the object argument if there is one, since we don't have an object 7129 // type. 7130 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = 7131 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Candidate.Function) && 7132 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Candidate.Function); 7133 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 7134 if (Result == TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure) 7135 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7136 else { 7137 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 7138 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 7139 Info); 7140 } 7141 return; 7142 } 7143 7144 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument 7145 // deduction as a candidate. 7146 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?"); 7147 AddOverloadCandidate( 7148 Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 7149 PartialOverloading, AllowExplicit, 7150 /*AllowExplicitConversions*/ false, IsADLCandidate, Conversions, PO); 7151 } 7152 7153 /// Check that implicit conversion sequences can be formed for each argument 7154 /// whose corresponding parameter has a non-dependent type, per DR1391's 7155 /// [temp.deduct.call]p10. 7156 bool Sema::CheckNonDependentConversions( 7157 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes, 7158 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 7159 ConversionSequenceList &Conversions, bool SuppressUserConversions, 7160 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType, 7161 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 7162 // FIXME: The cases in which we allow explicit conversions for constructor 7163 // arguments never consider calling a constructor template. It's not clear 7164 // that is correct. 7165 const bool AllowExplicit = false; 7166 7167 auto *FD = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 7168 auto *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 7169 bool HasThisConversion = Method && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method); 7170 unsigned ThisConversions = HasThisConversion ? 1 : 0; 7171 7172 Conversions = 7173 CandidateSet.allocateConversionSequences(ThisConversions + Args.size()); 7174 7175 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 7176 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 7177 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 7178 7179 // For a method call, check the 'this' conversion here too. DR1391 doesn't 7180 // require that, but this check should never result in a hard error, and 7181 // overload resolution is permitted to sidestep instantiations. 7182 if (HasThisConversion && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic() && 7183 !ObjectType.isNull()) { 7184 unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 : 0; 7185 Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 7186 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 7187 Method, ActingContext); 7188 if (Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) 7189 return true; 7190 } 7191 7192 for (unsigned I = 0, N = std::min(ParamTypes.size(), Args.size()); I != N; 7193 ++I) { 7194 QualType ParamType = ParamTypes[I]; 7195 if (!ParamType->isDependentType()) { 7196 unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed 7197 ? 0 7198 : (ThisConversions + I); 7199 Conversions[ConvIdx] 7200 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[I], ParamType, 7201 SuppressUserConversions, 7202 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 7203 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 7204 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, 7205 AllowExplicit); 7206 if (Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) 7207 return true; 7208 } 7209 } 7210 7211 return false; 7212 } 7213 7214 /// Determine whether this is an allowable conversion from the result 7215 /// of an explicit conversion operator to the expected type, per C++ 7216 /// [over.match.conv]p1 and [over.match.ref]p1. 7217 /// 7218 /// \param ConvType The return type of the conversion function. 7219 /// 7220 /// \param ToType The type we are converting to. 7221 /// 7222 /// \param AllowObjCPointerConversion Allow a conversion from one 7223 /// Objective-C pointer to another. 7224 /// 7225 /// \returns true if the conversion is allowable, false otherwise. 7226 static bool isAllowableExplicitConversion(Sema &S, 7227 QualType ConvType, QualType ToType, 7228 bool AllowObjCPointerConversion) { 7229 QualType ToNonRefType = ToType.getNonReferenceType(); 7230 7231 // Easy case: the types are the same. 7232 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ConvType, ToNonRefType)) 7233 return true; 7234 7235 // Allow qualification conversions. 7236 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion; 7237 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, /*CStyle*/false, 7238 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) 7239 return true; 7240 7241 // If we're not allowed to consider Objective-C pointer conversions, 7242 // we're done. 7243 if (!AllowObjCPointerConversion) 7244 return false; 7245 7246 // Is this an Objective-C pointer conversion? 7247 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 7248 QualType ConvertedType; 7249 return S.isObjCPointerConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, ConvertedType, 7250 IncompatibleObjC); 7251 } 7252 7253 /// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a 7254 /// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv], 7255 /// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from, 7256 /// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to 7257 /// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the 7258 /// conversion function produces). 7259 void Sema::AddConversionCandidate( 7260 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 7261 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 7262 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 7263 bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowResultConversion) { 7264 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 7265 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate"); 7266 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 7267 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion)) 7268 return; 7269 7270 // If the conversion function has an undeduced return type, trigger its 7271 // deduction now. 7272 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && ConvType->isUndeducedType()) { 7273 if (DeduceReturnType(Conversion, From->getExprLoc())) 7274 return; 7275 ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 7276 } 7277 7278 // If we don't allow any conversion of the result type, ignore conversion 7279 // functions that don't convert to exactly (possibly cv-qualified) T. 7280 if (!AllowResultConversion && 7281 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Conversion->getConversionType(), ToType)) 7282 return; 7283 7284 // Per C++ [over.match.conv]p1, [over.match.ref]p1, an explicit conversion 7285 // operator is only a candidate if its return type is the target type or 7286 // can be converted to the target type with a qualification conversion. 7287 // 7288 // FIXME: Include such functions in the candidate list and explain why we 7289 // can't select them. 7290 if (Conversion->isExplicit() && 7291 !isAllowableExplicitConversion(*this, ConvType, ToType, 7292 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit)) 7293 return; 7294 7295 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 7296 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 7297 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 7298 7299 // Add this candidate 7300 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1); 7301 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7302 Candidate.Function = Conversion; 7303 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 7304 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 7305 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion(); 7306 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType); 7307 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType); 7308 Candidate.Viable = true; 7309 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1; 7310 7311 // Explicit functions are not actually candidates at all if we're not 7312 // allowing them in this context, but keep them around so we can point 7313 // to them in diagnostics. 7314 if (!AllowExplicit && Conversion->isExplicit()) { 7315 Candidate.Viable = false; 7316 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit; 7317 return; 7318 } 7319 7320 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4: 7321 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of 7322 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of 7323 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter. 7324 // 7325 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit 7326 // object parameter. 7327 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType(); 7328 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>()) 7329 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(); 7330 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext 7331 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 7332 7333 Candidate.Conversions[0] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 7334 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), From->getType(), 7335 From->Classify(Context), Conversion, ConversionContext); 7336 7337 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) { 7338 Candidate.Viable = false; 7339 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7340 return; 7341 } 7342 7343 if (Conversion->getTrailingRequiresClause()) { 7344 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 7345 if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Conversion, Satisfaction) || 7346 !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) { 7347 Candidate.Viable = false; 7348 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied; 7349 return; 7350 } 7351 } 7352 7353 // We won't go through a user-defined type conversion function to convert a 7354 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only 7355 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user] 7356 QualType FromCanon 7357 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType()); 7358 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType(); 7359 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || 7360 IsDerivedFrom(CandidateSet.getLocation(), FromCanon, ToCanon)) { 7361 Candidate.Viable = false; 7362 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion; 7363 return; 7364 } 7365 7366 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the 7367 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to 7368 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the 7369 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This 7370 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to 7371 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this 7372 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be 7373 // well-formed. 7374 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Context, Conversion, false, Conversion->getType(), 7375 VK_LValue, From->getBeginLoc()); 7376 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack, 7377 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()), 7378 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, &ConversionRef, 7379 VK_RValue, FPOptionsOverride()); 7380 7381 QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType(); 7382 if (!isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ConversionType)) { 7383 Candidate.Viable = false; 7384 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 7385 return; 7386 } 7387 7388 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType); 7389 7390 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because 7391 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's 7392 // allocator). 7393 QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 7394 7395 alignas(CallExpr) char Buffer[sizeof(CallExpr) + sizeof(Stmt *)]; 7396 CallExpr *TheTemporaryCall = CallExpr::CreateTemporary( 7397 Buffer, &ConversionFn, CallResultType, VK, From->getBeginLoc()); 7398 7399 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 7400 TryCopyInitialization(*this, TheTemporaryCall, ToType, 7401 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true, 7402 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 7403 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false); 7404 7405 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 7406 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 7407 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard; 7408 7409 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3: 7410 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a 7411 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence 7412 // shall have exact match rank. 7413 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() && 7414 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) { 7415 Candidate.Viable = false; 7416 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact; 7417 return; 7418 } 7419 7420 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5: 7421 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and 7422 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined 7423 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the 7424 // program is ill-formed. 7425 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() && 7426 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) { 7427 Candidate.Viable = false; 7428 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 7429 return; 7430 } 7431 break; 7432 7433 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 7434 Candidate.Viable = false; 7435 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 7436 return; 7437 7438 default: 7439 llvm_unreachable( 7440 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure"); 7441 } 7442 7443 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = 7444 CheckEnableIf(Conversion, CandidateSet.getLocation(), None)) { 7445 Candidate.Viable = false; 7446 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 7447 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 7448 return; 7449 } 7450 7451 if (Conversion->isMultiVersion() && Conversion->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() && 7452 !Conversion->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) { 7453 Candidate.Viable = false; 7454 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function; 7455 } 7456 } 7457 7458 /// Adds a conversion function template specialization 7459 /// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction 7460 /// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function 7461 /// template from the type that we are converting to (C++ 7462 /// [temp.deduct.conv]). 7463 void Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate( 7464 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 7465 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 7466 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 7467 bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowResultConversion) { 7468 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) && 7469 "Only conversion function templates permitted here"); 7470 7471 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate)) 7472 return; 7473 7474 // If the function template has a non-dependent explicit specification, 7475 // exclude it now if appropriate; we are not permitted to perform deduction 7476 // and substitution in this case. 7477 if (!AllowExplicit && isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplate)) { 7478 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 7479 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7480 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 7481 Candidate.Viable = false; 7482 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit; 7483 return; 7484 } 7485 7486 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation()); 7487 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 7488 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 7489 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType, 7490 Specialization, Info)) { 7491 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 7492 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7493 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 7494 Candidate.Viable = false; 7495 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 7496 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 7497 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 7498 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1; 7499 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 7500 Info); 7501 return; 7502 } 7503 7504 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by 7505 // template argument deduction as a candidate. 7506 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?"); 7507 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType, 7508 CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 7509 AllowExplicit, AllowResultConversion); 7510 } 7511 7512 /// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that 7513 /// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the 7514 /// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it 7515 /// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is 7516 /// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling. 7517 void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, 7518 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 7519 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 7520 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 7521 Expr *Object, 7522 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7523 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) { 7524 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion)) 7525 return; 7526 7527 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 7528 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 7529 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 7530 7531 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1); 7532 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7533 Candidate.Function = nullptr; 7534 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion; 7535 Candidate.Viable = true; 7536 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true; 7537 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 7538 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 7539 7540 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit 7541 // object parameter. 7542 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 7543 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Object->getType(), 7544 Object->Classify(Context), Conversion, ActingContext); 7545 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) { 7546 Candidate.Viable = false; 7547 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7548 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit; 7549 return; 7550 } 7551 7552 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose 7553 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is 7554 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such. 7555 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined(); 7556 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard; 7557 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false; 7558 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false; 7559 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion; 7560 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl; 7561 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After 7562 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before; 7563 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 7564 7565 // Find the 7566 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 7567 7568 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 7569 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 7570 // list (8.3.5). 7571 if (Args.size() > NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()) { 7572 Candidate.Viable = false; 7573 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 7574 return; 7575 } 7576 7577 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if 7578 // we have enough arguments. 7579 if (Args.size() < NumParams) { 7580 // Not enough arguments. 7581 Candidate.Viable = false; 7582 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 7583 return; 7584 } 7585 7586 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 7587 // arguments. 7588 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 7589 if (ArgIdx < NumParams) { 7590 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 7591 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 7592 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 7593 // parameter of F. 7594 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx); 7595 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1] 7596 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 7597 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 7598 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 7599 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 7600 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 7601 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) { 7602 Candidate.Viable = false; 7603 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7604 return; 7605 } 7606 } else { 7607 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 7608 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 7609 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 7610 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis(); 7611 } 7612 } 7613 7614 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = 7615 CheckEnableIf(Conversion, CandidateSet.getLocation(), None)) { 7616 Candidate.Viable = false; 7617 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 7618 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 7619 return; 7620 } 7621 } 7622 7623 /// Add all of the non-member operator function declarations in the given 7624 /// function set to the overload candidate set. 7625 void Sema::AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates( 7626 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7627 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 7628 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs) { 7629 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) { 7630 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl(); 7631 ArrayRef<Expr *> FunctionArgs = Args; 7632 7633 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 7634 FunctionDecl *FD = 7635 FunTmpl ? FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl() : cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 7636 7637 // Don't consider rewritten functions if we're not rewriting. 7638 if (!CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().isAcceptableCandidate(FD)) 7639 continue; 7640 7641 assert(!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && 7642 "unqualified operator lookup found a member function"); 7643 7644 if (FunTmpl) { 7645 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, 7646 FunctionArgs, CandidateSet); 7647 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD)) 7648 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 7649 FunTmpl, F.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, 7650 {FunctionArgs[1], FunctionArgs[0]}, CandidateSet, false, false, 7651 true, ADLCallKind::NotADL, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 7652 } else { 7653 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) 7654 continue; 7655 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), FunctionArgs, CandidateSet); 7656 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD)) 7657 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), 7658 {FunctionArgs[1], FunctionArgs[0]}, CandidateSet, 7659 false, false, true, false, ADLCallKind::NotADL, 7660 None, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 7661 } 7662 } 7663 } 7664 7665 /// Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are 7666 /// member functions. 7667 /// 7668 /// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions 7669 /// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such 7670 /// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and 7671 /// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++ 7672 /// [over.match.oper]). 7673 void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 7674 SourceLocation OpLoc, 7675 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7676 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 7677 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 7678 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 7679 7680 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 7681 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose 7682 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with 7683 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and 7684 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2, 7685 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member 7686 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are 7687 // constructed as follows: 7688 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType(); 7689 7690 // -- If T1 is a complete class type or a class currently being 7691 // defined, the set of member candidates is the result of the 7692 // qualified lookup of T1::operator@ (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, 7693 // the set of member candidates is empty. 7694 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) { 7695 // Complete the type if it can be completed. 7696 if (!isCompleteType(OpLoc, T1) && !T1Rec->isBeingDefined()) 7697 return; 7698 // If the type is neither complete nor being defined, bail out now. 7699 if (!T1Rec->getDecl()->getDefinition()) 7700 return; 7701 7702 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 7703 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl()); 7704 Operators.suppressDiagnostics(); 7705 7706 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(), 7707 OperEnd = Operators.end(); 7708 Oper != OperEnd; 7709 ++Oper) 7710 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(), 7711 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1), 7712 CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false, PO); 7713 } 7714 } 7715 7716 /// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in 7717 /// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types 7718 /// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the 7719 /// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator 7720 /// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment 7721 /// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments 7722 /// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually 7723 /// converted to bool. 7724 void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType *ParamTys, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7725 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 7726 bool IsAssignmentOperator, 7727 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) { 7728 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 7729 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 7730 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 7731 7732 // Add this candidate 7733 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size()); 7734 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_none); 7735 Candidate.Function = nullptr; 7736 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 7737 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 7738 std::copy(ParamTys, ParamTys + Args.size(), Candidate.BuiltinParamTypes); 7739 7740 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 7741 // arguments. 7742 Candidate.Viable = true; 7743 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 7744 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 7745 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4: 7746 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the 7747 // left operand are restricted as follows: 7748 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and 7749 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left 7750 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most 7751 // parameter of a built-in candidate. 7752 // 7753 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined 7754 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of 7755 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that 7756 // is not of the same type. 7757 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) { 7758 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy && 7759 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type"); 7760 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 7761 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]); 7762 } else { 7763 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 7764 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx], 7765 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator, 7766 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 7767 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 7768 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 7769 } 7770 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) { 7771 Candidate.Viable = false; 7772 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7773 break; 7774 } 7775 } 7776 } 7777 7778 namespace { 7779 7780 /// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the 7781 /// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++ 7782 /// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and 7783 /// enumeration types. 7784 class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet { 7785 /// TypeSet - A set of types. 7786 typedef llvm::SetVector<QualType, SmallVector<QualType, 8>, 7787 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8>> TypeSet; 7788 7789 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the 7790 /// built-in candidates. 7791 TypeSet PointerTypes; 7792 7793 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be 7794 /// used in the built-in candidates. 7795 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes; 7796 7797 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be 7798 /// used in the built-in candidates. 7799 TypeSet EnumerationTypes; 7800 7801 /// The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in 7802 /// candidates. 7803 TypeSet VectorTypes; 7804 7805 /// The set of matrix types that will be used in the built-in 7806 /// candidates. 7807 TypeSet MatrixTypes; 7808 7809 /// A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates 7810 bool HasNonRecordTypes; 7811 7812 /// A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types 7813 /// were present in the candidate set. 7814 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; 7815 7816 /// A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the 7817 /// candidate set. 7818 bool HasNullPtrType; 7819 7820 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the 7821 /// candidate type set. 7822 Sema &SemaRef; 7823 7824 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets. 7825 ASTContext &Context; 7826 7827 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty, 7828 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals); 7829 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty); 7830 7831 public: 7832 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set. 7833 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator; 7834 7835 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef) 7836 : HasNonRecordTypes(false), 7837 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false), 7838 HasNullPtrType(false), 7839 SemaRef(SemaRef), 7840 Context(SemaRef.Context) { } 7841 7842 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty, 7843 SourceLocation Loc, 7844 bool AllowUserConversions, 7845 bool AllowExplicitConversions, 7846 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals); 7847 7848 llvm::iterator_range<iterator> pointer_types() { return PointerTypes; } 7849 llvm::iterator_range<iterator> member_pointer_types() { 7850 return MemberPointerTypes; 7851 } 7852 llvm::iterator_range<iterator> enumeration_types() { 7853 return EnumerationTypes; 7854 } 7855 llvm::iterator_range<iterator> vector_types() { return VectorTypes; } 7856 llvm::iterator_range<iterator> matrix_types() { return MatrixTypes; } 7857 7858 bool containsMatrixType(QualType Ty) const { return MatrixTypes.count(Ty); } 7859 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; } 7860 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; } 7861 bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; } 7862 }; 7863 7864 } // end anonymous namespace 7865 7866 /// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to 7867 /// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of 7868 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine 7869 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const 7870 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of 7871 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded, 7872 /// false otherwise. 7873 /// 7874 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers? 7875 bool 7876 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty, 7877 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) { 7878 7879 // Insert this type. 7880 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty)) 7881 return false; 7882 7883 QualType PointeeTy; 7884 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>(); 7885 bool buildObjCPtr = false; 7886 if (!PointerTy) { 7887 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 7888 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType(); 7889 buildObjCPtr = true; 7890 } else { 7891 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType(); 7892 } 7893 7894 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed 7895 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the 7896 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int, 7897 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway. 7898 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType()) 7899 return true; 7900 7901 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers(); 7902 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile(); 7903 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict(); 7904 7905 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR. 7906 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) { 7907 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue; 7908 // Skip over volatile if no volatile found anywhere in the types. 7909 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue; 7910 7911 // Skip over restrict if no restrict found anywhere in the types, or if 7912 // the type cannot be restrict-qualified. 7913 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) && 7914 (!hasRestrict || 7915 (!(PointeeTy->isAnyPointerType() || PointeeTy->isReferenceType())))) 7916 continue; 7917 7918 // Build qualified pointee type. 7919 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR); 7920 7921 // Build qualified pointer type. 7922 QualType QPointerTy; 7923 if (!buildObjCPtr) 7924 QPointerTy = Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy); 7925 else 7926 QPointerTy = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy); 7927 7928 // Insert qualified pointer type. 7929 PointerTypes.insert(QPointerTy); 7930 } 7931 7932 return true; 7933 } 7934 7935 /// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty 7936 /// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of 7937 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine 7938 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const 7939 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of 7940 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded, 7941 /// false otherwise. 7942 /// 7943 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers? 7944 bool 7945 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants( 7946 QualType Ty) { 7947 // Insert this type. 7948 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty)) 7949 return false; 7950 7951 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 7952 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!"); 7953 7954 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType(); 7955 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed 7956 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the 7957 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int, 7958 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway. 7959 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType()) 7960 return true; 7961 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass(); 7962 7963 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR 7964 // qualifiers. 7965 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers(); 7966 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) { 7967 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue; 7968 7969 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR); 7970 MemberPointerTypes.insert( 7971 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy)); 7972 } 7973 7974 return true; 7975 } 7976 7977 /// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p 7978 /// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're 7979 /// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also 7980 /// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator. 7981 /// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion 7982 /// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we 7983 /// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class 7984 /// type. 7985 void 7986 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty, 7987 SourceLocation Loc, 7988 bool AllowUserConversions, 7989 bool AllowExplicitConversions, 7990 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) { 7991 // Only deal with canonical types. 7992 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty); 7993 7994 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an 7995 // expression for the purposes of conversions. 7996 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 7997 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType(); 7998 7999 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer. 8000 if (Ty->isArrayType()) 8001 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty); 8002 8003 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type. 8004 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType(); 8005 8006 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type. 8007 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 8008 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec; 8009 8010 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type. 8011 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = 8012 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType(); 8013 8014 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType()) 8015 PointerTypes.insert(Ty); 8016 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 8017 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set 8018 // of types. 8019 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals)) 8020 return; 8021 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) { 8022 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted. 8023 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty)) 8024 return; 8025 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) { 8026 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true; 8027 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty); 8028 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) { 8029 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an 8030 // extension. 8031 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true; 8032 VectorTypes.insert(Ty); 8033 } else if (Ty->isMatrixType()) { 8034 // Similar to vector types, we treat vector types as arithmetic types in 8035 // many contexts as an extension. 8036 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true; 8037 MatrixTypes.insert(Ty); 8038 } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) { 8039 HasNullPtrType = true; 8040 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) { 8041 // No conversion functions in incomplete types. 8042 if (!SemaRef.isCompleteType(Loc, Ty)) 8043 return; 8044 8045 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl()); 8046 for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) { 8047 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 8048 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 8049 8050 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything 8051 // about which builtin types we can convert to. 8052 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 8053 continue; 8054 8055 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 8056 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) { 8057 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false, 8058 VisibleQuals); 8059 } 8060 } 8061 } 8062 } 8063 /// Helper function for adjusting address spaces for the pointer or reference 8064 /// operands of builtin operators depending on the argument. 8065 static QualType AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T, 8066 Expr *Arg) { 8067 return S.Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(T, Arg->getType().getAddressSpace()); 8068 } 8069 8070 /// Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds 8071 /// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the 8072 /// given type to the candidate set. 8073 static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S, 8074 QualType T, 8075 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 8076 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 8077 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 8078 8079 // T& operator=(T&, T) 8080 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8081 AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(S, T, Args[0])); 8082 ParamTypes[1] = T; 8083 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8084 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8085 8086 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) { 8087 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T) 8088 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8089 AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(S, S.Context.getVolatileType(T), 8090 Args[0])); 8091 ParamTypes[1] = T; 8092 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8093 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8094 } 8095 } 8096 8097 /// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers, 8098 /// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type. 8099 static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) { 8100 Qualifiers VRQuals; 8101 const RecordType *TyRec; 8102 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType = 8103 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 8104 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>(); 8105 else 8106 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 8107 if (!TyRec) { 8108 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case. 8109 VRQuals.addVolatile(); 8110 VRQuals.addRestrict(); 8111 return VRQuals; 8112 } 8113 8114 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl()); 8115 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition()) 8116 return VRQuals; 8117 8118 for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) { 8119 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 8120 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 8121 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) { 8122 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType()); 8123 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 8124 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 8125 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers 8126 // as see them. 8127 bool done = false; 8128 while (!done) { 8129 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified()) 8130 VRQuals.addRestrict(); 8131 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 8132 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 8133 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr = 8134 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 8135 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType(); 8136 else 8137 done = true; 8138 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified()) 8139 VRQuals.addVolatile(); 8140 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile()) 8141 return VRQuals; 8142 } 8143 } 8144 } 8145 return VRQuals; 8146 } 8147 8148 namespace { 8149 8150 /// Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload 8151 /// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout 8152 /// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin 8153 /// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set. 8154 class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder { 8155 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods. 8156 Sema &S; 8157 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args; 8158 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals; 8159 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType; 8160 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes; 8161 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet; 8162 8163 static constexpr int ArithmeticTypesCap = 24; 8164 SmallVector<CanQualType, ArithmeticTypesCap> ArithmeticTypes; 8165 8166 // Define some indices used to iterate over the arithmetic types in 8167 // ArithmeticTypes. The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic 8168 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2). 8169 unsigned FirstIntegralType, 8170 LastIntegralType; 8171 unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType, 8172 LastPromotedIntegralType; 8173 unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType, 8174 LastPromotedArithmeticType; 8175 unsigned NumArithmeticTypes; 8176 8177 void InitArithmeticTypes() { 8178 // Start of promoted types. 8179 FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0; 8180 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.FloatTy); 8181 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.DoubleTy); 8182 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongDoubleTy); 8183 if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasFloat128Type()) 8184 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Float128Ty); 8185 8186 // Start of integral types. 8187 FirstIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8188 FirstPromotedIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8189 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.IntTy); 8190 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongTy); 8191 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongLongTy); 8192 if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type() || 8193 (S.Context.getAuxTargetInfo() && 8194 S.Context.getAuxTargetInfo()->hasInt128Type())) 8195 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Int128Ty); 8196 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedIntTy); 8197 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedLongTy); 8198 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy); 8199 if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type() || 8200 (S.Context.getAuxTargetInfo() && 8201 S.Context.getAuxTargetInfo()->hasInt128Type())) 8202 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty); 8203 LastPromotedIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8204 LastPromotedArithmeticType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8205 // End of promoted types. 8206 8207 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.BoolTy); 8208 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.CharTy); 8209 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.WCharTy); 8210 if (S.Context.getLangOpts().Char8) 8211 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char8Ty); 8212 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char16Ty); 8213 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char32Ty); 8214 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.SignedCharTy); 8215 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.ShortTy); 8216 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedCharTy); 8217 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedShortTy); 8218 LastIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8219 NumArithmeticTypes = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8220 // End of integral types. 8221 // FIXME: What about complex? What about half? 8222 8223 assert(ArithmeticTypes.size() <= ArithmeticTypesCap && 8224 "Enough inline storage for all arithmetic types."); 8225 } 8226 8227 /// Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads 8228 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators. 8229 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy, 8230 bool HasVolatile, 8231 bool HasRestrict) { 8232 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 8233 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy), 8234 S.Context.IntTy 8235 }; 8236 8237 // Non-volatile version. 8238 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8239 8240 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set: 8241 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type. 8242 if (HasVolatile) { 8243 ParamTypes[0] = 8244 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8245 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy)); 8246 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8247 } 8248 8249 // Add restrict version only if there are conversions to a restrict type 8250 // and our candidate type is a non-restrict-qualified pointer. 8251 if (HasRestrict && CandidateTy->isAnyPointerType() && 8252 !CandidateTy.isRestrictQualified()) { 8253 ParamTypes[0] 8254 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8255 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, Qualifiers::Restrict)); 8256 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8257 8258 if (HasVolatile) { 8259 ParamTypes[0] 8260 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8261 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, 8262 (Qualifiers::Volatile | 8263 Qualifiers::Restrict))); 8264 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8265 } 8266 } 8267 8268 } 8269 8270 /// Helper to add an overload candidate for a binary builtin with types \p L 8271 /// and \p R. 8272 void AddCandidate(QualType L, QualType R) { 8273 QualType LandR[2] = {L, R}; 8274 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 8275 } 8276 8277 public: 8278 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder( 8279 Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 8280 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals, 8281 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType, 8282 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes, 8283 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) 8284 : S(S), Args(Args), 8285 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals), 8286 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType( 8287 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType), 8288 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes), 8289 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) { 8290 8291 InitArithmeticTypes(); 8292 } 8293 8294 // Increment is deprecated for bool since C++17. 8295 // 8296 // C++ [over.built]p3: 8297 // 8298 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other 8299 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist 8300 // candidate operator functions of the form 8301 // 8302 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&); 8303 // T operator++(VQ T&, int); 8304 // 8305 // C++ [over.built]p4: 8306 // 8307 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other 8308 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist 8309 // candidate operator functions of the form 8310 // 8311 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&); 8312 // T operator--(VQ T&, int); 8313 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 8314 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8315 return; 8316 8317 for (unsigned Arith = 0; Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) { 8318 const auto TypeOfT = ArithmeticTypes[Arith]; 8319 if (TypeOfT == S.Context.BoolTy) { 8320 if (Op == OO_MinusMinus) 8321 continue; 8322 if (Op == OO_PlusPlus && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17) 8323 continue; 8324 } 8325 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads( 8326 TypeOfT, 8327 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(), 8328 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()); 8329 } 8330 } 8331 8332 // C++ [over.built]p5: 8333 // 8334 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or 8335 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or 8336 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8337 // 8338 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&); 8339 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&); 8340 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int); 8341 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int); 8342 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() { 8343 for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) { 8344 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types. 8345 if (!PtrTy->getPointeeType()->isObjectType()) 8346 continue; 8347 8348 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads( 8349 PtrTy, 8350 (!PtrTy.isVolatileQualified() && 8351 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()), 8352 (!PtrTy.isRestrictQualified() && 8353 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict())); 8354 } 8355 } 8356 8357 // C++ [over.built]p6: 8358 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there 8359 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8360 // 8361 // T& operator*(T*); 8362 // 8363 // C++ [over.built]p7: 8364 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a 8365 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8366 // T& operator*(T*); 8367 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() { 8368 for (QualType ParamTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) { 8369 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType(); 8370 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) 8371 continue; 8372 8373 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 8374 if (Proto->getMethodQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier()) 8375 continue; 8376 8377 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8378 } 8379 } 8380 8381 // C++ [over.built]p9: 8382 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate 8383 // operator functions of the form 8384 // 8385 // T operator+(T); 8386 // T operator-(T); 8387 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() { 8388 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8389 return; 8390 8391 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8392 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) { 8393 QualType ArithTy = ArithmeticTypes[Arith]; 8394 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ArithTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8395 } 8396 8397 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types. 8398 for (QualType VecTy : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types()) 8399 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&VecTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8400 } 8401 8402 // C++ [over.built]p8: 8403 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of 8404 // the form 8405 // 8406 // T* operator+(T*); 8407 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() { 8408 for (QualType ParamTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) 8409 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8410 } 8411 8412 // C++ [over.built]p10: 8413 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate 8414 // operator functions of the form 8415 // 8416 // T operator~(T); 8417 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() { 8418 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8419 return; 8420 8421 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8422 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) { 8423 QualType IntTy = ArithmeticTypes[Int]; 8424 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&IntTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8425 } 8426 8427 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types. 8428 for (QualType VecTy : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types()) 8429 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&VecTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8430 } 8431 8432 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16: 8433 // For every pointer to member type T or type std::nullptr_t, there 8434 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8435 // 8436 // bool operator==(T,T); 8437 // bool operator!=(T,T); 8438 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOrNullptrOverloads() { 8439 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8440 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8441 8442 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 8443 for (QualType MemPtrTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_types()) { 8444 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice. 8445 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(MemPtrTy)).second) 8446 continue; 8447 8448 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {MemPtrTy, MemPtrTy}; 8449 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8450 } 8451 8452 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) { 8453 CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy); 8454 if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy).second) { 8455 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy }; 8456 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8457 } 8458 } 8459 } 8460 } 8461 8462 // C++ [over.built]p15: 8463 // 8464 // For every T, where T is an enumeration type or a pointer type, 8465 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8466 // 8467 // bool operator<(T, T); 8468 // bool operator>(T, T); 8469 // bool operator<=(T, T); 8470 // bool operator>=(T, T); 8471 // bool operator==(T, T); 8472 // bool operator!=(T, T); 8473 // R operator<=>(T, T) 8474 void addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() { 8475 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 8476 // [...]the built-in candidates include all of the candidate operator 8477 // functions defined in 13.6 that, compared to the given operator, [...] 8478 // do not have the same parameter-type-list as any non-template non-member 8479 // candidate. 8480 // 8481 // Note that in practice, this only affects enumeration types because there 8482 // aren't any built-in candidates of record type, and a user-defined operator 8483 // must have an operand of record or enumeration type. Also, the only other 8484 // overloaded operator with enumeration arguments, operator=, 8485 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place 8486 // where we must suppress candidates like this. 8487 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> > 8488 UserDefinedBinaryOperators; 8489 8490 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 8491 if (!CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_types().empty()) { 8492 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(), 8493 CEnd = CandidateSet.end(); 8494 C != CEnd; ++C) { 8495 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2) 8496 continue; 8497 8498 if (C->Function->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization()) 8499 continue; 8500 8501 // We interpret "same parameter-type-list" as applying to the 8502 // "synthesized candidate, with the order of the two parameters 8503 // reversed", not to the original function. 8504 bool Reversed = C->isReversed(); 8505 QualType FirstParamType = C->Function->getParamDecl(Reversed ? 1 : 0) 8506 ->getType() 8507 .getUnqualifiedType(); 8508 QualType SecondParamType = C->Function->getParamDecl(Reversed ? 0 : 1) 8509 ->getType() 8510 .getUnqualifiedType(); 8511 8512 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type. 8513 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() || 8514 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType()) 8515 continue; 8516 8517 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators. 8518 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert( 8519 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType), 8520 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType))); 8521 } 8522 } 8523 } 8524 8525 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8526 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8527 8528 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 8529 for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_types()) { 8530 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice. 8531 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(PtrTy)).second) 8532 continue; 8533 8534 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {PtrTy, PtrTy}; 8535 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8536 } 8537 for (QualType EnumTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_types()) { 8538 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(EnumTy); 8539 8540 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined 8541 // candidate exists. 8542 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType).second || 8543 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType, 8544 CanonType))) 8545 continue; 8546 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {EnumTy, EnumTy}; 8547 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8548 } 8549 } 8550 } 8551 8552 // C++ [over.built]p13: 8553 // 8554 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T 8555 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8556 // 8557 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); 8558 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW] 8559 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); 8560 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); 8561 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW] 8562 // 8563 // C++ [over.built]p14: 8564 // 8565 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there 8566 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8567 // 8568 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T); 8569 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 8570 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8571 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8572 8573 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) { 8574 QualType AsymmetricParamTypes[2] = { 8575 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 8576 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 8577 }; 8578 for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_types()) { 8579 QualType PointeeTy = PtrTy->getPointeeType(); 8580 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType()) 8581 continue; 8582 8583 AsymmetricParamTypes[Arg] = PtrTy; 8584 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) { 8585 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t) 8586 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); 8587 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(AsymmetricParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8588 } 8589 if (Op == OO_Minus) { 8590 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T); 8591 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(PtrTy)).second) 8592 continue; 8593 8594 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {PtrTy, PtrTy}; 8595 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8596 } 8597 } 8598 } 8599 } 8600 8601 // C++ [over.built]p12: 8602 // 8603 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there 8604 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8605 // 8606 // LR operator*(L, R); 8607 // LR operator/(L, R); 8608 // LR operator+(L, R); 8609 // LR operator-(L, R); 8610 // bool operator<(L, R); 8611 // bool operator>(L, R); 8612 // bool operator<=(L, R); 8613 // bool operator>=(L, R); 8614 // bool operator==(L, R); 8615 // bool operator!=(L, R); 8616 // 8617 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 8618 // between types L and R. 8619 // 8620 // C++ [over.built]p24: 8621 // 8622 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist 8623 // candidate operator functions of the form 8624 // 8625 // LR operator?(bool, L, R); 8626 // 8627 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 8628 // between types L and R. 8629 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter. 8630 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads() { 8631 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8632 return; 8633 8634 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8635 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) { 8636 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8637 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) { 8638 QualType LandR[2] = { ArithmeticTypes[Left], 8639 ArithmeticTypes[Right] }; 8640 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 8641 } 8642 } 8643 8644 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the 8645 // conditional operator for vector types. 8646 for (QualType Vec1Ty : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types()) 8647 for (QualType Vec2Ty : CandidateTypes[1].vector_types()) { 8648 QualType LandR[2] = {Vec1Ty, Vec2Ty}; 8649 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 8650 } 8651 } 8652 8653 /// Add binary operator overloads for each candidate matrix type M1, M2: 8654 /// * (M1, M1) -> M1 8655 /// * (M1, M1.getElementType()) -> M1 8656 /// * (M2.getElementType(), M2) -> M2 8657 /// * (M2, M2) -> M2 // Only if M2 is not part of CandidateTypes[0]. 8658 void addMatrixBinaryArithmeticOverloads() { 8659 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8660 return; 8661 8662 for (QualType M1 : CandidateTypes[0].matrix_types()) { 8663 AddCandidate(M1, cast<MatrixType>(M1)->getElementType()); 8664 AddCandidate(M1, M1); 8665 } 8666 8667 for (QualType M2 : CandidateTypes[1].matrix_types()) { 8668 AddCandidate(cast<MatrixType>(M2)->getElementType(), M2); 8669 if (!CandidateTypes[0].containsMatrixType(M2)) 8670 AddCandidate(M2, M2); 8671 } 8672 } 8673 8674 // C++2a [over.built]p14: 8675 // 8676 // For every integral type T there exists a candidate operator function 8677 // of the form 8678 // 8679 // std::strong_ordering operator<=>(T, T) 8680 // 8681 // C++2a [over.built]p15: 8682 // 8683 // For every pair of floating-point types L and R, there exists a candidate 8684 // operator function of the form 8685 // 8686 // std::partial_ordering operator<=>(L, R); 8687 // 8688 // FIXME: The current specification for integral types doesn't play nice with 8689 // the direction of p0946r0, which allows mixed integral and unscoped-enum 8690 // comparisons. Under the current spec this can lead to ambiguity during 8691 // overload resolution. For example: 8692 // 8693 // enum A : int {a}; 8694 // auto x = (a <=> (long)42); 8695 // 8696 // error: call is ambiguous for arguments 'A' and 'long'. 8697 // note: candidate operator<=>(int, int) 8698 // note: candidate operator<=>(long, long) 8699 // 8700 // To avoid this error, this function deviates from the specification and adds 8701 // the mixed overloads `operator<=>(L, R)` where L and R are promoted 8702 // arithmetic types (the same as the generic relational overloads). 8703 // 8704 // For now this function acts as a placeholder. 8705 void addThreeWayArithmeticOverloads() { 8706 addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 8707 } 8708 8709 // C++ [over.built]p17: 8710 // 8711 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there 8712 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8713 // 8714 // LR operator%(L, R); 8715 // LR operator&(L, R); 8716 // LR operator^(L, R); 8717 // LR operator|(L, R); 8718 // L operator<<(L, R); 8719 // L operator>>(L, R); 8720 // 8721 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 8722 // between types L and R. 8723 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 8724 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8725 return; 8726 8727 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8728 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) { 8729 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8730 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) { 8731 QualType LandR[2] = { ArithmeticTypes[Left], 8732 ArithmeticTypes[Right] }; 8733 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 8734 } 8735 } 8736 } 8737 8738 // C++ [over.built]p20: 8739 // 8740 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or 8741 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or 8742 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8743 // 8744 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T); 8745 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() { 8746 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8747 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8748 8749 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) { 8750 for (QualType EnumTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_types()) { 8751 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(EnumTy)).second) 8752 continue; 8753 8754 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, EnumTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8755 } 8756 8757 for (QualType MemPtrTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_types()) { 8758 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(MemPtrTy)).second) 8759 continue; 8760 8761 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, MemPtrTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8762 } 8763 } 8764 } 8765 8766 // C++ [over.built]p19: 8767 // 8768 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either 8769 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions 8770 // of the form 8771 // 8772 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*); 8773 // 8774 // C++ [over.built]p21: 8775 // 8776 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or 8777 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or 8778 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8779 // 8780 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t); 8781 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t); 8782 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) { 8783 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8784 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8785 8786 for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) { 8787 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added. 8788 if (isEqualOp) 8789 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(PtrTy)); 8790 else if (!PtrTy->getPointeeType()->isObjectType()) 8791 continue; 8792 8793 // non-volatile version 8794 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 8795 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PtrTy), 8796 isEqualOp ? PtrTy : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 8797 }; 8798 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8799 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp); 8800 8801 bool NeedVolatile = !PtrTy.isVolatileQualified() && 8802 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(); 8803 if (NeedVolatile) { 8804 // volatile version 8805 ParamTypes[0] = 8806 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(PtrTy)); 8807 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8808 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8809 } 8810 8811 if (!PtrTy.isRestrictQualified() && 8812 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) { 8813 // restrict version 8814 ParamTypes[0] = 8815 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(PtrTy)); 8816 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8817 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8818 8819 if (NeedVolatile) { 8820 // volatile restrict version 8821 ParamTypes[0] = 8822 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType( 8823 PtrTy, (Qualifiers::Volatile | Qualifiers::Restrict))); 8824 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8825 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8826 } 8827 } 8828 } 8829 8830 if (isEqualOp) { 8831 for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[1].pointer_types()) { 8832 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice. 8833 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(PtrTy)).second) 8834 continue; 8835 8836 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 8837 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PtrTy), 8838 PtrTy, 8839 }; 8840 8841 // non-volatile version 8842 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8843 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8844 8845 bool NeedVolatile = !PtrTy.isVolatileQualified() && 8846 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(); 8847 if (NeedVolatile) { 8848 // volatile version 8849 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8850 S.Context.getVolatileType(PtrTy)); 8851 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8852 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8853 } 8854 8855 if (!PtrTy.isRestrictQualified() && 8856 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) { 8857 // restrict version 8858 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8859 S.Context.getRestrictType(PtrTy)); 8860 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8861 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8862 8863 if (NeedVolatile) { 8864 // volatile restrict version 8865 ParamTypes[0] = 8866 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType( 8867 PtrTy, (Qualifiers::Volatile | Qualifiers::Restrict))); 8868 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8869 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8870 } 8871 } 8872 } 8873 } 8874 } 8875 8876 // C++ [over.built]p18: 8877 // 8878 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type, 8879 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted 8880 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of 8881 // the form 8882 // 8883 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R); 8884 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R); 8885 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R); 8886 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R); 8887 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R); 8888 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) { 8889 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8890 return; 8891 8892 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) { 8893 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8894 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) { 8895 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 8896 ParamTypes[1] = ArithmeticTypes[Right]; 8897 auto LeftBaseTy = AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType( 8898 S, ArithmeticTypes[Left], Args[0]); 8899 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 8900 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(LeftBaseTy); 8901 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8902 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8903 8904 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 8905 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 8906 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(LeftBaseTy); 8907 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 8908 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8909 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8910 } 8911 } 8912 } 8913 8914 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types. 8915 for (QualType Vec1Ty : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types()) 8916 for (QualType Vec2Ty : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types()) { 8917 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 8918 ParamTypes[1] = Vec2Ty; 8919 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 8920 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(Vec1Ty); 8921 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8922 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8923 8924 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 8925 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 8926 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(Vec1Ty); 8927 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 8928 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8929 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8930 } 8931 } 8932 } 8933 8934 // C++ [over.built]p22: 8935 // 8936 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ 8937 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral 8938 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8939 // 8940 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R); 8941 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R); 8942 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R); 8943 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R); 8944 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R); 8945 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R); 8946 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() { 8947 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8948 return; 8949 8950 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) { 8951 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8952 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) { 8953 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 8954 ParamTypes[1] = ArithmeticTypes[Right]; 8955 auto LeftBaseTy = AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType( 8956 S, ArithmeticTypes[Left], Args[0]); 8957 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 8958 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(LeftBaseTy); 8959 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8960 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 8961 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 8962 ParamTypes[0] = LeftBaseTy; 8963 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]); 8964 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 8965 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8966 } 8967 } 8968 } 8969 } 8970 8971 // C++ [over.operator]p23: 8972 // 8973 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form 8974 // 8975 // bool operator!(bool); 8976 // bool operator&&(bool, bool); 8977 // bool operator||(bool, bool); 8978 void addExclaimOverload() { 8979 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy; 8980 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet, 8981 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false, 8982 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1); 8983 } 8984 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() { 8985 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy }; 8986 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8987 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false, 8988 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2); 8989 } 8990 8991 // C++ [over.built]p13: 8992 // 8993 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there 8994 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8995 // 8996 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE] 8997 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); 8998 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE] 8999 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE] 9000 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); 9001 void addSubscriptOverloads() { 9002 for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) { 9003 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {PtrTy, S.Context.getPointerDiffType()}; 9004 QualType PointeeType = PtrTy->getPointeeType(); 9005 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType()) 9006 continue; 9007 9008 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t) 9009 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9010 } 9011 9012 for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[1].pointer_types()) { 9013 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), PtrTy}; 9014 QualType PointeeType = PtrTy->getPointeeType(); 9015 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType()) 9016 continue; 9017 9018 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*) 9019 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9020 } 9021 } 9022 9023 // C++ [over.built]p11: 9024 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type, 9025 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object 9026 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs, 9027 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 9028 // 9029 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*); 9030 // 9031 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2. 9032 void addArrowStarOverloads() { 9033 for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) { 9034 QualType C1Ty = PtrTy; 9035 QualType C1; 9036 QualifierCollector Q1; 9037 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0); 9038 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1)) 9039 continue; 9040 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set. 9041 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a 9042 // volatile/restrict type. 9043 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile()) 9044 continue; 9045 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict()) 9046 continue; 9047 for (QualType MemPtrTy : CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_types()) { 9048 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(MemPtrTy); 9049 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0); 9050 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType(); 9051 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(CandidateSet.getLocation(), C1, C2)) 9052 break; 9053 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {PtrTy, MemPtrTy}; 9054 // build CV12 T& 9055 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType(); 9056 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && 9057 T.isVolatileQualified()) 9058 continue; 9059 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && 9060 T.isRestrictQualified()) 9061 continue; 9062 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T); 9063 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9064 } 9065 } 9066 } 9067 9068 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been 9069 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are 9070 // therefore added as binary. 9071 // 9072 // C++ [over.built]p25: 9073 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped 9074 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 9075 // 9076 // T operator?(bool, T, T); 9077 // 9078 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() { 9079 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 9080 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 9081 9082 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) { 9083 for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_types()) { 9084 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(PtrTy)).second) 9085 continue; 9086 9087 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {PtrTy, PtrTy}; 9088 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9089 } 9090 9091 for (QualType MemPtrTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_types()) { 9092 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(MemPtrTy)).second) 9093 continue; 9094 9095 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {MemPtrTy, MemPtrTy}; 9096 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9097 } 9098 9099 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 9100 for (QualType EnumTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_types()) { 9101 if (!EnumTy->castAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped()) 9102 continue; 9103 9104 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(EnumTy)).second) 9105 continue; 9106 9107 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {EnumTy, EnumTy}; 9108 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9109 } 9110 } 9111 } 9112 } 9113 }; 9114 9115 } // end anonymous namespace 9116 9117 /// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in 9118 /// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based 9119 /// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the 9120 /// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int 9121 /// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition. 9122 void Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 9123 SourceLocation OpLoc, 9124 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 9125 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 9126 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only 9127 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates 9128 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record 9129 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types. 9130 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals; 9131 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst(); 9132 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) 9133 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]); 9134 9135 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false; 9136 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false; 9137 SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes; 9138 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 9139 CandidateTypes.emplace_back(*this); 9140 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(), 9141 OpLoc, 9142 true, 9143 (Op == OO_Exclaim || 9144 Op == OO_AmpAmp || 9145 Op == OO_PipePipe), 9146 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals); 9147 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType || 9148 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes(); 9149 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = 9150 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType || 9151 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(); 9152 } 9153 9154 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set 9155 // for any of the arguments to the operator. 9156 // 9157 // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have 9158 // 'bool' overloads. 9159 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType && 9160 !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe)) 9161 return; 9162 9163 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads. 9164 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, 9165 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals, 9166 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType, 9167 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet); 9168 9169 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply. 9170 switch (Op) { 9171 case OO_None: 9172 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS: 9173 llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator"); 9174 9175 case OO_New: 9176 case OO_Delete: 9177 case OO_Array_New: 9178 case OO_Array_Delete: 9179 case OO_Call: 9180 llvm_unreachable( 9181 "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates"); 9182 9183 case OO_Comma: 9184 case OO_Arrow: 9185 case OO_Coawait: 9186 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 9187 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', the 9188 // operator '->', or the operator 'co_await', the 9189 // built-in candidates set is empty. 9190 break; 9191 9192 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary 9193 if (Args.size() == 1) 9194 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads(); 9195 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 9196 9197 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary 9198 if (Args.size() == 1) { 9199 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads(); 9200 } else { 9201 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op); 9202 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9203 OpBuilder.addMatrixBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9204 } 9205 break; 9206 9207 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary 9208 if (Args.size() == 1) 9209 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads(); 9210 else { 9211 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9212 OpBuilder.addMatrixBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9213 } 9214 break; 9215 9216 case OO_Slash: 9217 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9218 break; 9219 9220 case OO_PlusPlus: 9221 case OO_MinusMinus: 9222 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op); 9223 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads(); 9224 break; 9225 9226 case OO_EqualEqual: 9227 case OO_ExclaimEqual: 9228 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOrNullptrOverloads(); 9229 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 9230 9231 case OO_Less: 9232 case OO_Greater: 9233 case OO_LessEqual: 9234 case OO_GreaterEqual: 9235 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 9236 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9237 break; 9238 9239 case OO_Spaceship: 9240 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 9241 OpBuilder.addThreeWayArithmeticOverloads(); 9242 break; 9243 9244 case OO_Percent: 9245 case OO_Caret: 9246 case OO_Pipe: 9247 case OO_LessLess: 9248 case OO_GreaterGreater: 9249 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op); 9250 break; 9251 9252 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary 9253 if (Args.size() == 1) 9254 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 9255 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the 9256 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty. 9257 break; 9258 9259 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op); 9260 break; 9261 9262 case OO_Tilde: 9263 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads(); 9264 break; 9265 9266 case OO_Equal: 9267 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 9268 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 9269 9270 case OO_PlusEqual: 9271 case OO_MinusEqual: 9272 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal); 9273 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 9274 9275 case OO_StarEqual: 9276 case OO_SlashEqual: 9277 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal); 9278 break; 9279 9280 case OO_PercentEqual: 9281 case OO_LessLessEqual: 9282 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual: 9283 case OO_AmpEqual: 9284 case OO_CaretEqual: 9285 case OO_PipeEqual: 9286 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads(); 9287 break; 9288 9289 case OO_Exclaim: 9290 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload(); 9291 break; 9292 9293 case OO_AmpAmp: 9294 case OO_PipePipe: 9295 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload(); 9296 break; 9297 9298 case OO_Subscript: 9299 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads(); 9300 break; 9301 9302 case OO_ArrowStar: 9303 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads(); 9304 break; 9305 9306 case OO_Conditional: 9307 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads(); 9308 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9309 break; 9310 } 9311 } 9312 9313 /// Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup 9314 /// to the set of overloading candidates. 9315 /// 9316 /// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the 9317 /// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds 9318 /// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload 9319 /// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]). 9320 void 9321 Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name, 9322 SourceLocation Loc, 9323 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 9324 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 9325 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 9326 bool PartialOverloading) { 9327 ADLResult Fns; 9328 9329 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing 9330 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality, 9331 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However, 9332 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the 9333 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are 9334 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway? 9335 9336 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments? 9337 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Loc, Args, Fns); 9338 9339 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about. 9340 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(), 9341 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end(); 9342 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand) 9343 if (Cand->Function) { 9344 Fns.erase(Cand->Function); 9345 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) 9346 Fns.erase(FunTmpl); 9347 } 9348 9349 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload 9350 // set. 9351 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) { 9352 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none); 9353 9354 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) { 9355 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) 9356 continue; 9357 9358 AddOverloadCandidate( 9359 FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 9360 PartialOverloading, /*AllowExplicit=*/true, 9361 /*AllowExplicitConversions=*/false, ADLCallKind::UsesADL); 9362 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD)) { 9363 AddOverloadCandidate( 9364 FD, FoundDecl, {Args[1], Args[0]}, CandidateSet, 9365 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading, 9366 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, /*AllowExplicitConversions=*/false, 9367 ADLCallKind::UsesADL, None, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 9368 } 9369 } else { 9370 auto *FTD = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I); 9371 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 9372 FTD, FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet, 9373 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading, 9374 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, ADLCallKind::UsesADL); 9375 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed( 9376 Context, FTD->getTemplatedDecl())) { 9377 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 9378 FTD, FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, {Args[1], Args[0]}, 9379 CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading, 9380 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, ADLCallKind::UsesADL, 9381 OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 9382 } 9383 } 9384 } 9385 } 9386 9387 namespace { 9388 enum class Comparison { Equal, Better, Worse }; 9389 } 9390 9391 /// Compares the enable_if attributes of two FunctionDecls, for the purposes of 9392 /// overload resolution. 9393 /// 9394 /// Cand1's set of enable_if attributes are said to be "better" than Cand2's iff 9395 /// Cand1's first N enable_if attributes have precisely the same conditions as 9396 /// Cand2's first N enable_if attributes (where N = the number of enable_if 9397 /// attributes on Cand2), and Cand1 has more than N enable_if attributes. 9398 /// 9399 /// Note that you can have a pair of candidates such that Cand1's enable_if 9400 /// attributes are worse than Cand2's, and Cand2's enable_if attributes are 9401 /// worse than Cand1's. 9402 static Comparison compareEnableIfAttrs(const Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *Cand1, 9403 const FunctionDecl *Cand2) { 9404 // Common case: One (or both) decls don't have enable_if attrs. 9405 bool Cand1Attr = Cand1->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>(); 9406 bool Cand2Attr = Cand2->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>(); 9407 if (!Cand1Attr || !Cand2Attr) { 9408 if (Cand1Attr == Cand2Attr) 9409 return Comparison::Equal; 9410 return Cand1Attr ? Comparison::Better : Comparison::Worse; 9411 } 9412 9413 auto Cand1Attrs = Cand1->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>(); 9414 auto Cand2Attrs = Cand2->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>(); 9415 9416 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID Cand1ID, Cand2ID; 9417 for (auto Pair : zip_longest(Cand1Attrs, Cand2Attrs)) { 9418 Optional<EnableIfAttr *> Cand1A = std::get<0>(Pair); 9419 Optional<EnableIfAttr *> Cand2A = std::get<1>(Pair); 9420 9421 // It's impossible for Cand1 to be better than (or equal to) Cand2 if Cand1 9422 // has fewer enable_if attributes than Cand2, and vice versa. 9423 if (!Cand1A) 9424 return Comparison::Worse; 9425 if (!Cand2A) 9426 return Comparison::Better; 9427 9428 Cand1ID.clear(); 9429 Cand2ID.clear(); 9430 9431 (*Cand1A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand1ID, S.getASTContext(), true); 9432 (*Cand2A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand2ID, S.getASTContext(), true); 9433 if (Cand1ID != Cand2ID) 9434 return Comparison::Worse; 9435 } 9436 9437 return Comparison::Equal; 9438 } 9439 9440 static Comparison 9441 isBetterMultiversionCandidate(const OverloadCandidate &Cand1, 9442 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2) { 9443 if (!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->isMultiVersion() || !Cand2.Function || 9444 !Cand2.Function->isMultiVersion()) 9445 return Comparison::Equal; 9446 9447 // If both are invalid, they are equal. If one of them is invalid, the other 9448 // is better. 9449 if (Cand1.Function->isInvalidDecl()) { 9450 if (Cand2.Function->isInvalidDecl()) 9451 return Comparison::Equal; 9452 return Comparison::Worse; 9453 } 9454 if (Cand2.Function->isInvalidDecl()) 9455 return Comparison::Better; 9456 9457 // If this is a cpu_dispatch/cpu_specific multiversion situation, prefer 9458 // cpu_dispatch, else arbitrarily based on the identifiers. 9459 bool Cand1CPUDisp = Cand1.Function->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>(); 9460 bool Cand2CPUDisp = Cand2.Function->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>(); 9461 const auto *Cand1CPUSpec = Cand1.Function->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>(); 9462 const auto *Cand2CPUSpec = Cand2.Function->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>(); 9463 9464 if (!Cand1CPUDisp && !Cand2CPUDisp && !Cand1CPUSpec && !Cand2CPUSpec) 9465 return Comparison::Equal; 9466 9467 if (Cand1CPUDisp && !Cand2CPUDisp) 9468 return Comparison::Better; 9469 if (Cand2CPUDisp && !Cand1CPUDisp) 9470 return Comparison::Worse; 9471 9472 if (Cand1CPUSpec && Cand2CPUSpec) { 9473 if (Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_size() != Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_size()) 9474 return Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_size() < Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_size() 9475 ? Comparison::Better 9476 : Comparison::Worse; 9477 9478 std::pair<CPUSpecificAttr::cpus_iterator, CPUSpecificAttr::cpus_iterator> 9479 FirstDiff = std::mismatch( 9480 Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_begin(), Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_end(), 9481 Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_begin(), 9482 [](const IdentifierInfo *LHS, const IdentifierInfo *RHS) { 9483 return LHS->getName() == RHS->getName(); 9484 }); 9485 9486 assert(FirstDiff.first != Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_end() && 9487 "Two different cpu-specific versions should not have the same " 9488 "identifier list, otherwise they'd be the same decl!"); 9489 return (*FirstDiff.first)->getName() < (*FirstDiff.second)->getName() 9490 ? Comparison::Better 9491 : Comparison::Worse; 9492 } 9493 llvm_unreachable("No way to get here unless both had cpu_dispatch"); 9494 } 9495 9496 /// Compute the type of the implicit object parameter for the given function, 9497 /// if any. Returns None if there is no implicit object parameter, and a null 9498 /// QualType if there is a 'matches anything' implicit object parameter. 9499 static Optional<QualType> getImplicitObjectParamType(ASTContext &Context, 9500 const FunctionDecl *F) { 9501 if (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(F) || isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(F)) 9502 return llvm::None; 9503 9504 auto *M = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(F); 9505 // Static member functions' object parameters match all types. 9506 if (M->isStatic()) 9507 return QualType(); 9508 9509 QualType T = M->getThisObjectType(); 9510 if (M->getRefQualifier() == RQ_RValue) 9511 return Context.getRValueReferenceType(T); 9512 return Context.getLValueReferenceType(T); 9513 } 9514 9515 static bool haveSameParameterTypes(ASTContext &Context, const FunctionDecl *F1, 9516 const FunctionDecl *F2, unsigned NumParams) { 9517 if (declaresSameEntity(F1, F2)) 9518 return true; 9519 9520 auto NextParam = [&](const FunctionDecl *F, unsigned &I, bool First) { 9521 if (First) { 9522 if (Optional<QualType> T = getImplicitObjectParamType(Context, F)) 9523 return *T; 9524 } 9525 assert(I < F->getNumParams()); 9526 return F->getParamDecl(I++)->getType(); 9527 }; 9528 9529 unsigned I1 = 0, I2 = 0; 9530 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumParams; ++I) { 9531 QualType T1 = NextParam(F1, I1, I == 0); 9532 QualType T2 = NextParam(F2, I2, I == 0); 9533 if (!T1.isNull() && !T1.isNull() && !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2)) 9534 return false; 9535 } 9536 return true; 9537 } 9538 9539 /// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload 9540 /// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1). 9541 bool clang::isBetterOverloadCandidate( 9542 Sema &S, const OverloadCandidate &Cand1, const OverloadCandidate &Cand2, 9543 SourceLocation Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind Kind) { 9544 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable 9545 // functions. 9546 if (!Cand2.Viable) 9547 return Cand1.Viable; 9548 else if (!Cand1.Viable) 9549 return false; 9550 9551 // [CUDA] A function with 'never' preference is marked not viable, therefore 9552 // is never shown up here. The worst preference shown up here is 'wrong side', 9553 // e.g. an H function called by a HD function in device compilation. This is 9554 // valid AST as long as the HD function is not emitted, e.g. it is an inline 9555 // function which is called only by an H function. A deferred diagnostic will 9556 // be triggered if it is emitted. However a wrong-sided function is still 9557 // a viable candidate here. 9558 // 9559 // If Cand1 can be emitted and Cand2 cannot be emitted in the current 9560 // context, Cand1 is better than Cand2. If Cand1 can not be emitted and Cand2 9561 // can be emitted, Cand1 is not better than Cand2. This rule should have 9562 // precedence over other rules. 9563 // 9564 // If both Cand1 and Cand2 can be emitted, or neither can be emitted, then 9565 // other rules should be used to determine which is better. This is because 9566 // host/device based overloading resolution is mostly for determining 9567 // viability of a function. If two functions are both viable, other factors 9568 // should take precedence in preference, e.g. the standard-defined preferences 9569 // like argument conversion ranks or enable_if partial-ordering. The 9570 // preference for pass-object-size parameters is probably most similar to a 9571 // type-based-overloading decision and so should take priority. 9572 // 9573 // If other rules cannot determine which is better, CUDA preference will be 9574 // used again to determine which is better. 9575 // 9576 // TODO: Currently IdentifyCUDAPreference does not return correct values 9577 // for functions called in global variable initializers due to missing 9578 // correct context about device/host. Therefore we can only enforce this 9579 // rule when there is a caller. We should enforce this rule for functions 9580 // in global variable initializers once proper context is added. 9581 // 9582 // TODO: We can only enable the hostness based overloading resolution when 9583 // -fgpu-exclude-wrong-side-overloads is on since this requires deferring 9584 // overloading resolution diagnostics. 9585 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && 9586 S.getLangOpts().GPUExcludeWrongSideOverloads) { 9587 if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext)) { 9588 bool IsCallerImplicitHD = Sema::isCUDAImplicitHostDeviceFunction(Caller); 9589 bool IsCand1ImplicitHD = 9590 Sema::isCUDAImplicitHostDeviceFunction(Cand1.Function); 9591 bool IsCand2ImplicitHD = 9592 Sema::isCUDAImplicitHostDeviceFunction(Cand2.Function); 9593 auto P1 = S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand1.Function); 9594 auto P2 = S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand2.Function); 9595 assert(P1 != Sema::CFP_Never && P2 != Sema::CFP_Never); 9596 // The implicit HD function may be a function in a system header which 9597 // is forced by pragma. In device compilation, if we prefer HD candidates 9598 // over wrong-sided candidates, overloading resolution may change, which 9599 // may result in non-deferrable diagnostics. As a workaround, we let 9600 // implicit HD candidates take equal preference as wrong-sided candidates. 9601 // This will preserve the overloading resolution. 9602 // TODO: We still need special handling of implicit HD functions since 9603 // they may incur other diagnostics to be deferred. We should make all 9604 // host/device related diagnostics deferrable and remove special handling 9605 // of implicit HD functions. 9606 auto EmitThreshold = 9607 (S.getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice && IsCallerImplicitHD && 9608 (IsCand1ImplicitHD || IsCand2ImplicitHD)) 9609 ? Sema::CFP_Never 9610 : Sema::CFP_WrongSide; 9611 auto Cand1Emittable = P1 > EmitThreshold; 9612 auto Cand2Emittable = P2 > EmitThreshold; 9613 if (Cand1Emittable && !Cand2Emittable) 9614 return true; 9615 if (!Cand1Emittable && Cand2Emittable) 9616 return false; 9617 } 9618 } 9619 9620 // C++ [over.match.best]p1: 9621 // 9622 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such 9623 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for 9624 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither 9625 // better nor worse than ICS1(F). 9626 unsigned StartArg = 0; 9627 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument) 9628 StartArg = 1; 9629 9630 auto IsIllFormedConversion = [&](const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) { 9631 // We don't allow incompatible pointer conversions in C++. 9632 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 9633 return ICS.isStandard() && 9634 ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion; 9635 9636 // The only ill-formed conversion we allow in C++ is the string literal to 9637 // char* conversion, which is only considered ill-formed after C++11. 9638 return S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings && 9639 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS); 9640 }; 9641 9642 // Define functions that don't require ill-formed conversions for a given 9643 // argument to be better candidates than functions that do. 9644 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.Conversions.size(); 9645 assert(Cand2.Conversions.size() == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch"); 9646 bool HasBetterConversion = false; 9647 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 9648 bool Cand1Bad = IsIllFormedConversion(Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx]); 9649 bool Cand2Bad = IsIllFormedConversion(Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx]); 9650 if (Cand1Bad != Cand2Bad) { 9651 if (Cand1Bad) 9652 return false; 9653 HasBetterConversion = true; 9654 } 9655 } 9656 9657 if (HasBetterConversion) 9658 return true; 9659 9660 // C++ [over.match.best]p1: 9661 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another 9662 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse 9663 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then... 9664 bool HasWorseConversion = false; 9665 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 9666 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, Loc, 9667 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx], 9668 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) { 9669 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 9670 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence. 9671 HasBetterConversion = true; 9672 break; 9673 9674 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 9675 if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && 9676 Cand1.isReversed() != Cand2.isReversed() && 9677 haveSameParameterTypes(S.Context, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function, 9678 NumArgs)) { 9679 // Work around large-scale breakage caused by considering reversed 9680 // forms of operator== in C++20: 9681 // 9682 // When comparing a function against a reversed function with the same 9683 // parameter types, if we have a better conversion for one argument and 9684 // a worse conversion for the other, the implicit conversion sequences 9685 // are treated as being equally good. 9686 // 9687 // This prevents a comparison function from being considered ambiguous 9688 // with a reversed form that is written in the same way. 9689 // 9690 // We diagnose this as an extension from CreateOverloadedBinOp. 9691 HasWorseConversion = true; 9692 break; 9693 } 9694 9695 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2. 9696 return false; 9697 9698 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 9699 // Do nothing. 9700 break; 9701 } 9702 } 9703 9704 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than 9705 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that, 9706 if (HasBetterConversion && !HasWorseConversion) 9707 return true; 9708 9709 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion 9710 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence 9711 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e., 9712 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better 9713 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence 9714 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type. 9715 if (Kind == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion && 9716 Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && 9717 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) && 9718 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) { 9719 // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the 9720 // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension 9721 // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function 9722 // pointer or block. 9723 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result = 9724 compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function); 9725 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable) 9726 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc, 9727 Cand1.FinalConversion, 9728 Cand2.FinalConversion); 9729 9730 if (Result != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable) 9731 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 9732 9733 // FIXME: Compare kind of reference binding if conversion functions 9734 // convert to a reference type used in direct reference binding, per 9735 // C++14 [over.match.best]p1 section 2 bullet 3. 9736 } 9737 9738 // FIXME: Work around a defect in the C++17 guaranteed copy elision wording, 9739 // as combined with the resolution to CWG issue 243. 9740 // 9741 // When the context is initialization by constructor ([over.match.ctor] or 9742 // either phase of [over.match.list]), a constructor is preferred over 9743 // a conversion function. 9744 if (Kind == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByConstructor && NumArgs == 1 && 9745 Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && 9746 isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand1.Function) != 9747 isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand2.Function)) 9748 return isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand1.Function); 9749 9750 // -- F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template 9751 // specialization, or, if not that, 9752 bool Cand1IsSpecialization = Cand1.Function && 9753 Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 9754 bool Cand2IsSpecialization = Cand2.Function && 9755 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 9756 if (Cand1IsSpecialization != Cand2IsSpecialization) 9757 return Cand2IsSpecialization; 9758 9759 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function 9760 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2 9761 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or, 9762 // if not that, 9763 if (Cand1IsSpecialization && Cand2IsSpecialization) { 9764 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate( 9765 Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), 9766 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), Loc, 9767 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) ? TPOC_Conversion 9768 : TPOC_Call, 9769 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments, Cand2.ExplicitCallArguments, 9770 Cand1.isReversed() ^ Cand2.isReversed())) 9771 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 9772 } 9773 9774 // -— F1 and F2 are non-template functions with the same 9775 // parameter-type-lists, and F1 is more constrained than F2 [...], 9776 if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && !Cand1IsSpecialization && 9777 !Cand2IsSpecialization && Cand1.Function->hasPrototype() && 9778 Cand2.Function->hasPrototype()) { 9779 auto *PT1 = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Cand1.Function->getFunctionType()); 9780 auto *PT2 = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Cand2.Function->getFunctionType()); 9781 if (PT1->getNumParams() == PT2->getNumParams() && 9782 PT1->isVariadic() == PT2->isVariadic() && 9783 S.FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(PT1, PT2)) { 9784 Expr *RC1 = Cand1.Function->getTrailingRequiresClause(); 9785 Expr *RC2 = Cand2.Function->getTrailingRequiresClause(); 9786 if (RC1 && RC2) { 9787 bool AtLeastAsConstrained1, AtLeastAsConstrained2; 9788 if (S.IsAtLeastAsConstrained(Cand1.Function, {RC1}, Cand2.Function, 9789 {RC2}, AtLeastAsConstrained1) || 9790 S.IsAtLeastAsConstrained(Cand2.Function, {RC2}, Cand1.Function, 9791 {RC1}, AtLeastAsConstrained2)) 9792 return false; 9793 if (AtLeastAsConstrained1 != AtLeastAsConstrained2) 9794 return AtLeastAsConstrained1; 9795 } else if (RC1 || RC2) { 9796 return RC1 != nullptr; 9797 } 9798 } 9799 } 9800 9801 // -- F1 is a constructor for a class D, F2 is a constructor for a base 9802 // class B of D, and for all arguments the corresponding parameters of 9803 // F1 and F2 have the same type. 9804 // FIXME: Implement the "all parameters have the same type" check. 9805 bool Cand1IsInherited = 9806 dyn_cast_or_null<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Cand1.FoundDecl.getDecl()); 9807 bool Cand2IsInherited = 9808 dyn_cast_or_null<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Cand2.FoundDecl.getDecl()); 9809 if (Cand1IsInherited != Cand2IsInherited) 9810 return Cand2IsInherited; 9811 else if (Cand1IsInherited) { 9812 assert(Cand2IsInherited); 9813 auto *Cand1Class = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cand1.Function->getDeclContext()); 9814 auto *Cand2Class = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cand2.Function->getDeclContext()); 9815 if (Cand1Class->isDerivedFrom(Cand2Class)) 9816 return true; 9817 if (Cand2Class->isDerivedFrom(Cand1Class)) 9818 return false; 9819 // Inherited from sibling base classes: still ambiguous. 9820 } 9821 9822 // -- F2 is a rewritten candidate (12.4.1.2) and F1 is not 9823 // -- F1 and F2 are rewritten candidates, and F2 is a synthesized candidate 9824 // with reversed order of parameters and F1 is not 9825 // 9826 // We rank reversed + different operator as worse than just reversed, but 9827 // that comparison can never happen, because we only consider reversing for 9828 // the maximally-rewritten operator (== or <=>). 9829 if (Cand1.RewriteKind != Cand2.RewriteKind) 9830 return Cand1.RewriteKind < Cand2.RewriteKind; 9831 9832 // Check C++17 tie-breakers for deduction guides. 9833 { 9834 auto *Guide1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(Cand1.Function); 9835 auto *Guide2 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(Cand2.Function); 9836 if (Guide1 && Guide2) { 9837 // -- F1 is generated from a deduction-guide and F2 is not 9838 if (Guide1->isImplicit() != Guide2->isImplicit()) 9839 return Guide2->isImplicit(); 9840 9841 // -- F1 is the copy deduction candidate(16.3.1.8) and F2 is not 9842 if (Guide1->isCopyDeductionCandidate()) 9843 return true; 9844 } 9845 } 9846 9847 // Check for enable_if value-based overload resolution. 9848 if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) { 9849 Comparison Cmp = compareEnableIfAttrs(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function); 9850 if (Cmp != Comparison::Equal) 9851 return Cmp == Comparison::Better; 9852 } 9853 9854 bool HasPS1 = Cand1.Function != nullptr && 9855 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Cand1.Function); 9856 bool HasPS2 = Cand2.Function != nullptr && 9857 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Cand2.Function); 9858 if (HasPS1 != HasPS2 && HasPS1) 9859 return true; 9860 9861 auto MV = isBetterMultiversionCandidate(Cand1, Cand2); 9862 if (MV == Comparison::Better) 9863 return true; 9864 if (MV == Comparison::Worse) 9865 return false; 9866 9867 // If other rules cannot determine which is better, CUDA preference is used 9868 // to determine which is better. 9869 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) { 9870 FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext); 9871 return S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand1.Function) > 9872 S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand2.Function); 9873 } 9874 9875 return false; 9876 } 9877 9878 /// Determine whether two declarations are "equivalent" for the purposes of 9879 /// name lookup and overload resolution. This applies when the same internal/no 9880 /// linkage entity is defined by two modules (probably by textually including 9881 /// the same header). In such a case, we don't consider the declarations to 9882 /// declare the same entity, but we also don't want lookups with both 9883 /// declarations visible to be ambiguous in some cases (this happens when using 9884 /// a modularized libstdc++). 9885 bool Sema::isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(const NamedDecl *A, 9886 const NamedDecl *B) { 9887 auto *VA = dyn_cast_or_null<ValueDecl>(A); 9888 auto *VB = dyn_cast_or_null<ValueDecl>(B); 9889 if (!VA || !VB) 9890 return false; 9891 9892 // The declarations must be declaring the same name as an internal linkage 9893 // entity in different modules. 9894 if (!VA->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals( 9895 VB->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) || 9896 getOwningModule(VA) == getOwningModule(VB) || 9897 VA->isExternallyVisible() || VB->isExternallyVisible()) 9898 return false; 9899 9900 // Check that the declarations appear to be equivalent. 9901 // 9902 // FIXME: Checking the type isn't really enough to resolve the ambiguity. 9903 // For constants and functions, we should check the initializer or body is 9904 // the same. For non-constant variables, we shouldn't allow it at all. 9905 if (Context.hasSameType(VA->getType(), VB->getType())) 9906 return true; 9907 9908 // Enum constants within unnamed enumerations will have different types, but 9909 // may still be similar enough to be interchangeable for our purposes. 9910 if (auto *EA = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(VA)) { 9911 if (auto *EB = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(VB)) { 9912 // Only handle anonymous enums. If the enumerations were named and 9913 // equivalent, they would have been merged to the same type. 9914 auto *EnumA = cast<EnumDecl>(EA->getDeclContext()); 9915 auto *EnumB = cast<EnumDecl>(EB->getDeclContext()); 9916 if (EnumA->hasNameForLinkage() || EnumB->hasNameForLinkage() || 9917 !Context.hasSameType(EnumA->getIntegerType(), 9918 EnumB->getIntegerType())) 9919 return false; 9920 // Allow this only if the value is the same for both enumerators. 9921 return llvm::APSInt::isSameValue(EA->getInitVal(), EB->getInitVal()); 9922 } 9923 } 9924 9925 // Nothing else is sufficiently similar. 9926 return false; 9927 } 9928 9929 void Sema::diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations( 9930 SourceLocation Loc, const NamedDecl *D, ArrayRef<const NamedDecl *> Equiv) { 9931 assert(D && "Unknown declaration"); 9932 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl_in_modules) << D; 9933 9934 Module *M = getOwningModule(D); 9935 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl) 9936 << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : ""); 9937 9938 for (auto *E : Equiv) { 9939 Module *M = getOwningModule(E); 9940 Diag(E->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl) 9941 << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : ""); 9942 } 9943 } 9944 9945 /// Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3) 9946 /// within an overload candidate set. 9947 /// 9948 /// \param Loc The location of the function name (or operator symbol) for 9949 /// which overload resolution occurs. 9950 /// 9951 /// \param Best If overload resolution was successful or found a deleted 9952 /// function, \p Best points to the candidate function found. 9953 /// 9954 /// \returns The result of overload resolution. 9955 OverloadingResult 9956 OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9957 iterator &Best) { 9958 llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate *, 16> Candidates; 9959 std::transform(begin(), end(), std::back_inserter(Candidates), 9960 [](OverloadCandidate &Cand) { return &Cand; }); 9961 9962 // [CUDA] HD->H or HD->D calls are technically not allowed by CUDA but 9963 // are accepted by both clang and NVCC. However, during a particular 9964 // compilation mode only one call variant is viable. We need to 9965 // exclude non-viable overload candidates from consideration based 9966 // only on their host/device attributes. Specifically, if one 9967 // candidate call is WrongSide and the other is SameSide, we ignore 9968 // the WrongSide candidate. 9969 // We only need to remove wrong-sided candidates here if 9970 // -fgpu-exclude-wrong-side-overloads is off. When 9971 // -fgpu-exclude-wrong-side-overloads is on, all candidates are compared 9972 // uniformly in isBetterOverloadCandidate. 9973 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && !S.getLangOpts().GPUExcludeWrongSideOverloads) { 9974 const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext); 9975 bool ContainsSameSideCandidate = 9976 llvm::any_of(Candidates, [&](OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 9977 // Check viable function only. 9978 return Cand->Viable && Cand->Function && 9979 S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand->Function) == 9980 Sema::CFP_SameSide; 9981 }); 9982 if (ContainsSameSideCandidate) { 9983 auto IsWrongSideCandidate = [&](OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 9984 // Check viable function only to avoid unnecessary data copying/moving. 9985 return Cand->Viable && Cand->Function && 9986 S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand->Function) == 9987 Sema::CFP_WrongSide; 9988 }; 9989 llvm::erase_if(Candidates, IsWrongSideCandidate); 9990 } 9991 } 9992 9993 // Find the best viable function. 9994 Best = end(); 9995 for (auto *Cand : Candidates) { 9996 Cand->Best = false; 9997 if (Cand->Viable) 9998 if (Best == end() || 9999 isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc, Kind)) 10000 Best = Cand; 10001 } 10002 10003 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort. 10004 if (Best == end()) 10005 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 10006 10007 llvm::SmallVector<const NamedDecl *, 4> EquivalentCands; 10008 10009 llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 4> PendingBest; 10010 PendingBest.push_back(&*Best); 10011 Best->Best = true; 10012 10013 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable 10014 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity. 10015 while (!PendingBest.empty()) { 10016 auto *Curr = PendingBest.pop_back_val(); 10017 for (auto *Cand : Candidates) { 10018 if (Cand->Viable && !Cand->Best && 10019 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Curr, *Cand, Loc, Kind)) { 10020 PendingBest.push_back(Cand); 10021 Cand->Best = true; 10022 10023 if (S.isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(Cand->Function, 10024 Curr->Function)) 10025 EquivalentCands.push_back(Cand->Function); 10026 else 10027 Best = end(); 10028 } 10029 } 10030 } 10031 10032 // If we found more than one best candidate, this is ambiguous. 10033 if (Best == end()) 10034 return OR_Ambiguous; 10035 10036 // Best is the best viable function. 10037 if (Best->Function && Best->Function->isDeleted()) 10038 return OR_Deleted; 10039 10040 if (!EquivalentCands.empty()) 10041 S.diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations(Loc, Best->Function, 10042 EquivalentCands); 10043 10044 return OR_Success; 10045 } 10046 10047 namespace { 10048 10049 enum OverloadCandidateKind { 10050 oc_function, 10051 oc_method, 10052 oc_reversed_binary_operator, 10053 oc_constructor, 10054 oc_implicit_default_constructor, 10055 oc_implicit_copy_constructor, 10056 oc_implicit_move_constructor, 10057 oc_implicit_copy_assignment, 10058 oc_implicit_move_assignment, 10059 oc_implicit_equality_comparison, 10060 oc_inherited_constructor 10061 }; 10062 10063 enum OverloadCandidateSelect { 10064 ocs_non_template, 10065 ocs_template, 10066 ocs_described_template, 10067 }; 10068 10069 static std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> 10070 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, FunctionDecl *Fn, 10071 OverloadCandidateRewriteKind CRK, 10072 std::string &Description) { 10073 10074 bool isTemplate = Fn->isTemplateDecl() || Found->isTemplateDecl(); 10075 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) { 10076 isTemplate = true; 10077 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 10078 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs()); 10079 } 10080 10081 OverloadCandidateSelect Select = [&]() { 10082 if (!Description.empty()) 10083 return ocs_described_template; 10084 return isTemplate ? ocs_template : ocs_non_template; 10085 }(); 10086 10087 OverloadCandidateKind Kind = [&]() { 10088 if (Fn->isImplicit() && Fn->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_EqualEqual) 10089 return oc_implicit_equality_comparison; 10090 10091 if (CRK & CRK_Reversed) 10092 return oc_reversed_binary_operator; 10093 10094 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) { 10095 if (!Ctor->isImplicit()) { 10096 if (isa<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Found)) 10097 return oc_inherited_constructor; 10098 else 10099 return oc_constructor; 10100 } 10101 10102 if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor()) 10103 return oc_implicit_default_constructor; 10104 10105 if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor()) 10106 return oc_implicit_move_constructor; 10107 10108 assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() && 10109 "unexpected sort of implicit constructor"); 10110 return oc_implicit_copy_constructor; 10111 } 10112 10113 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 10114 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but 10115 // it doesn't hurt to split it out. 10116 if (!Meth->isImplicit()) 10117 return oc_method; 10118 10119 if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator()) 10120 return oc_implicit_move_assignment; 10121 10122 if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator()) 10123 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment; 10124 10125 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion"); 10126 return oc_method; 10127 } 10128 10129 return oc_function; 10130 }(); 10131 10132 return std::make_pair(Kind, Select); 10133 } 10134 10135 void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, Decl *FoundDecl) { 10136 // FIXME: It'd be nice to only emit a note once per using-decl per overload 10137 // set. 10138 if (auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl)) 10139 S.Diag(FoundDecl->getLocation(), 10140 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor) 10141 << Shadow->getNominatedBaseClass(); 10142 } 10143 10144 } // end anonymous namespace 10145 10146 static bool isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(const ASTContext &Ctx, 10147 const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10148 for (auto *EnableIf : FD->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>()) { 10149 bool AlwaysTrue; 10150 if (EnableIf->getCond()->isValueDependent() || 10151 !EnableIf->getCond()->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(AlwaysTrue, Ctx)) 10152 return false; 10153 if (!AlwaysTrue) 10154 return false; 10155 } 10156 return true; 10157 } 10158 10159 /// Returns true if we can take the address of the function. 10160 /// 10161 /// \param Complain - If true, we'll emit a diagnostic 10162 /// \param InOverloadResolution - For the purposes of emitting a diagnostic, are 10163 /// we in overload resolution? 10164 /// \param Loc - The location of the statement we're complaining about. Ignored 10165 /// if we're not complaining, or if we're in overload resolution. 10166 static bool checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD, 10167 bool Complain, 10168 bool InOverloadResolution, 10169 SourceLocation Loc) { 10170 if (!isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(S.Context, FD)) { 10171 if (Complain) { 10172 if (InOverloadResolution) 10173 S.Diag(FD->getBeginLoc(), 10174 diag::note_addrof_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if_attr); 10175 else 10176 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_addrof_function_disabled_by_enable_if_attr) << FD; 10177 } 10178 return false; 10179 } 10180 10181 if (FD->getTrailingRequiresClause()) { 10182 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 10183 if (S.CheckFunctionConstraints(FD, Satisfaction, Loc)) 10184 return false; 10185 if (!Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) { 10186 if (Complain) { 10187 if (InOverloadResolution) 10188 S.Diag(FD->getBeginLoc(), 10189 diag::note_ovl_candidate_unsatisfied_constraints); 10190 else 10191 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_addrof_function_constraints_not_satisfied) 10192 << FD; 10193 S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint(Satisfaction); 10194 } 10195 return false; 10196 } 10197 } 10198 10199 auto I = llvm::find_if(FD->parameters(), [](const ParmVarDecl *P) { 10200 return P->hasAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 10201 }); 10202 if (I == FD->param_end()) 10203 return true; 10204 10205 if (Complain) { 10206 // Add one to ParamNo because it's user-facing 10207 unsigned ParamNo = std::distance(FD->param_begin(), I) + 1; 10208 if (InOverloadResolution) 10209 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), 10210 diag::note_ovl_candidate_has_pass_object_size_params) 10211 << ParamNo; 10212 else 10213 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_address_of_function_with_pass_object_size_params) 10214 << FD << ParamNo; 10215 } 10216 return false; 10217 } 10218 10219 static bool checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(Sema &S, 10220 const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10221 return checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(S, FD, /*Complain=*/true, 10222 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 10223 /*Loc=*/SourceLocation()); 10224 } 10225 10226 bool Sema::checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(const FunctionDecl *Function, 10227 bool Complain, 10228 SourceLocation Loc) { 10229 return ::checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(*this, Function, Complain, 10230 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 10231 Loc); 10232 } 10233 10234 // Don't print candidates other than the one that matches the calling 10235 // convention of the call operator, since that is guaranteed to exist. 10236 static bool shouldSkipNotingLambdaConversionDecl(FunctionDecl *Fn) { 10237 const auto *ConvD = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Fn); 10238 10239 if (!ConvD) 10240 return false; 10241 const auto *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Fn->getParent()); 10242 if (!RD->isLambda()) 10243 return false; 10244 10245 CXXMethodDecl *CallOp = RD->getLambdaCallOperator(); 10246 CallingConv CallOpCC = 10247 CallOp->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv(); 10248 QualType ConvRTy = ConvD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(); 10249 CallingConv ConvToCC = 10250 ConvRTy->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv(); 10251 10252 return ConvToCC != CallOpCC; 10253 } 10254 10255 // Notes the location of an overload candidate. 10256 void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(NamedDecl *Found, FunctionDecl *Fn, 10257 OverloadCandidateRewriteKind RewriteKind, 10258 QualType DestType, bool TakingAddress) { 10259 if (TakingAddress && !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(*this, Fn)) 10260 return; 10261 if (Fn->isMultiVersion() && Fn->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() && 10262 !Fn->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) 10263 return; 10264 if (shouldSkipNotingLambdaConversionDecl(Fn)) 10265 return; 10266 10267 std::string FnDesc; 10268 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> KSPair = 10269 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Found, Fn, RewriteKind, FnDesc); 10270 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) 10271 << (unsigned)KSPair.first << (unsigned)KSPair.second 10272 << Fn << FnDesc; 10273 10274 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType); 10275 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD); 10276 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Found); 10277 } 10278 10279 static void 10280 MaybeDiagnoseAmbiguousConstraints(Sema &S, ArrayRef<OverloadCandidate> Cands) { 10281 // Perhaps the ambiguity was caused by two atomic constraints that are 10282 // 'identical' but not equivalent: 10283 // 10284 // void foo() requires (sizeof(T) > 4) { } // #1 10285 // void foo() requires (sizeof(T) > 4) && T::value { } // #2 10286 // 10287 // The 'sizeof(T) > 4' constraints are seemingly equivalent and should cause 10288 // #2 to subsume #1, but these constraint are not considered equivalent 10289 // according to the subsumption rules because they are not the same 10290 // source-level construct. This behavior is quite confusing and we should try 10291 // to help the user figure out what happened. 10292 10293 SmallVector<const Expr *, 3> FirstAC, SecondAC; 10294 FunctionDecl *FirstCand = nullptr, *SecondCand = nullptr; 10295 for (auto I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) { 10296 if (!I->Function) 10297 continue; 10298 SmallVector<const Expr *, 3> AC; 10299 if (auto *Template = I->Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) 10300 Template->getAssociatedConstraints(AC); 10301 else 10302 I->Function->getAssociatedConstraints(AC); 10303 if (AC.empty()) 10304 continue; 10305 if (FirstCand == nullptr) { 10306 FirstCand = I->Function; 10307 FirstAC = AC; 10308 } else if (SecondCand == nullptr) { 10309 SecondCand = I->Function; 10310 SecondAC = AC; 10311 } else { 10312 // We have more than one pair of constrained functions - this check is 10313 // expensive and we'd rather not try to diagnose it. 10314 return; 10315 } 10316 } 10317 if (!SecondCand) 10318 return; 10319 // The diagnostic can only happen if there are associated constraints on 10320 // both sides (there needs to be some identical atomic constraint). 10321 if (S.MaybeEmitAmbiguousAtomicConstraintsDiagnostic(FirstCand, FirstAC, 10322 SecondCand, SecondAC)) 10323 // Just show the user one diagnostic, they'll probably figure it out 10324 // from here. 10325 return; 10326 } 10327 10328 // Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through 10329 // OverloadedExpr 10330 void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr *OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType, 10331 bool TakingAddress) { 10332 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 10333 10334 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr); 10335 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression; 10336 10337 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 10338 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 10339 I != IEnd; ++I) { 10340 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = 10341 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) { 10342 NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), CRK_None, DestType, 10343 TakingAddress); 10344 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun 10345 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) { 10346 NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, Fun, CRK_None, DestType, TakingAddress); 10347 } 10348 } 10349 } 10350 10351 /// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the 10352 /// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and 10353 /// target types of the conversion. 10354 void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion( 10355 Sema &S, 10356 SourceLocation CaretLoc, 10357 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const { 10358 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag) 10359 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType(); 10360 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 10361 AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator I, E; 10362 for (I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) { 10363 if (CandsShown >= S.Diags.getNumOverloadCandidatesToShow()) 10364 break; 10365 ++CandsShown; 10366 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(I->first, I->second); 10367 } 10368 S.Diags.overloadCandidatesShown(CandsShown); 10369 if (I != E) 10370 S.Diag(SourceLocation(), diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I); 10371 } 10372 10373 static void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10374 unsigned I, bool TakingCandidateAddress) { 10375 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I]; 10376 assert(Conv.isBad()); 10377 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function"); 10378 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 10379 10380 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a 10381 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the 10382 // conversion-slot index. 10383 bool isObjectArgument = false; 10384 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) { 10385 if (I == 0) 10386 isObjectArgument = true; 10387 else 10388 I--; 10389 } 10390 10391 std::string FnDesc; 10392 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 10393 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind(), 10394 FnDesc); 10395 10396 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr; 10397 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType(); 10398 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType(); 10399 10400 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 10401 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?"); 10402 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens(); 10403 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E)) 10404 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens(); 10405 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName(); 10406 10407 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload) 10408 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10409 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << ToTy 10410 << Name << I + 1; 10411 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10412 return; 10413 } 10414 10415 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due 10416 // to a qualifier mismatch. 10417 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy); 10418 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy); 10419 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 10420 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType(); 10421 else { 10422 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches. 10423 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 10424 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 10425 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(); 10426 CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType(); 10427 } 10428 } 10429 10430 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() && 10431 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) { 10432 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers(); 10433 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers(); 10434 10435 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) { 10436 if (isObjectArgument) 10437 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace_this) 10438 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 10439 << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 10440 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace(); 10441 else 10442 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace) 10443 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 10444 << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 10445 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace() 10446 << ToTy->isReferenceType() << I + 1; 10447 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10448 return; 10449 } 10450 10451 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) { 10452 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership) 10453 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10454 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10455 << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime() 10456 << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1; 10457 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10458 return; 10459 } 10460 10461 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) { 10462 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc) 10463 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10464 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10465 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr() 10466 << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1; 10467 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10468 return; 10469 } 10470 10471 if (FromQs.hasUnaligned() != ToQs.hasUnaligned()) { 10472 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_unaligned) 10473 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10474 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10475 << FromQs.hasUnaligned() << I + 1; 10476 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10477 return; 10478 } 10479 10480 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers(); 10481 assert(CVR && "expected qualifiers mismatch"); 10482 10483 if (isObjectArgument) { 10484 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this) 10485 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10486 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10487 << (CVR - 1); 10488 } else { 10489 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr) 10490 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10491 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10492 << (CVR - 1) << I + 1; 10493 } 10494 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10495 return; 10496 } 10497 10498 if (Conv.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue || 10499 Conv.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue) { 10500 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_value_category) 10501 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10502 << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1 10503 << (Conv.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue) 10504 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()); 10505 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10506 return; 10507 } 10508 10509 // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since 10510 // telling the user that it has type void is not useful. 10511 if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) { 10512 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument) 10513 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10514 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10515 << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1; 10516 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10517 return; 10518 } 10519 10520 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently, 10521 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered 10522 // the failure. 10523 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType(); 10524 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 10525 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType(); 10526 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) { 10527 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it. 10528 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete) 10529 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10530 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10531 << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1 10532 << (unsigned)(Cand->Fix.Kind); 10533 10534 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10535 return; 10536 } 10537 10538 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions. 10539 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0; 10540 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 10541 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 10542 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 10543 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) && 10544 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 10545 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 10546 S.IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation(), ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(), 10547 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType())) 10548 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1; 10549 } 10550 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy 10551 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 10552 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy 10553 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) 10554 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl()) 10555 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl()) 10556 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 10557 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) && 10558 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface)) 10559 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2; 10560 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 10561 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) && 10562 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() && 10563 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 10564 S.IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation(), ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) { 10565 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3; 10566 } 10567 } 10568 10569 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) { 10570 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv) 10571 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10572 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 10573 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1) << FromTy << ToTy << I + 1; 10574 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10575 return; 10576 } 10577 10578 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) && 10579 isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) { 10580 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers(); 10581 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers(); 10582 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) { 10583 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv) 10584 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 10585 << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 10586 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1; 10587 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10588 return; 10589 } 10590 } 10591 10592 if (TakingCandidateAddress && 10593 !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, Cand->Function)) 10594 return; 10595 10596 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it. 10597 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv); 10598 FDiag << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10599 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10600 << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1 10601 << (unsigned)(Cand->Fix.Kind); 10602 10603 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts. 10604 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(), 10605 HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI) 10606 FDiag << *HI; 10607 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag); 10608 10609 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10610 } 10611 10612 /// Additional arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload 10613 /// candidates. This is not covered by the more general DiagnoseArityMismatch() 10614 /// over a candidate in any candidate set. 10615 static bool CheckArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10616 unsigned NumArgs) { 10617 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 10618 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments(); 10619 10620 // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we 10621 // have an arity mismatch when in fact it looks like we have the 10622 // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have 10623 // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions. 10624 // Just don't report anything. 10625 if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() && 10626 Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName) 10627 return true; 10628 10629 if (NumArgs < MinParams) { 10630 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) || 10631 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction && 10632 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments)); 10633 } else { 10634 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) || 10635 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction && 10636 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments)); 10637 } 10638 10639 return false; 10640 } 10641 10642 /// General arity mismatch diagnosis over a candidate in a candidate set. 10643 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, Decl *D, 10644 unsigned NumFormalArgs) { 10645 assert(isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && 10646 "The templated declaration should at least be a function" 10647 " when diagnosing bad template argument deduction due to too many" 10648 " or too few arguments"); 10649 10650 FunctionDecl *Fn = cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 10651 10652 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case 10653 const auto *FnTy = Fn->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 10654 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments(); 10655 10656 // at least / at most / exactly 10657 unsigned mode, modeCount; 10658 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) { 10659 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams() || FnTy->isVariadic() || 10660 FnTy->isTemplateVariadic()) 10661 mode = 0; // "at least" 10662 else 10663 mode = 2; // "exactly" 10664 modeCount = MinParams; 10665 } else { 10666 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams()) 10667 mode = 1; // "at most" 10668 else 10669 mode = 2; // "exactly" 10670 modeCount = FnTy->getNumParams(); 10671 } 10672 10673 std::string Description; 10674 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 10675 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Found, Fn, CRK_None, Description); 10676 10677 if (modeCount == 1 && Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName()) 10678 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity_one) 10679 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 10680 << Description << mode << Fn->getParamDecl(0) << NumFormalArgs; 10681 else 10682 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity) 10683 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 10684 << Description << mode << modeCount << NumFormalArgs; 10685 10686 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10687 } 10688 10689 /// Arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload candidate. 10690 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10691 unsigned NumFormalArgs) { 10692 if (!CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumFormalArgs)) 10693 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function, NumFormalArgs); 10694 } 10695 10696 static TemplateDecl *getDescribedTemplate(Decl *Templated) { 10697 if (TemplateDecl *TD = Templated->getDescribedTemplate()) 10698 return TD; 10699 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported: Getting the described template declaration" 10700 " for bad deduction diagnosis"); 10701 } 10702 10703 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction. 10704 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, Decl *Templated, 10705 DeductionFailureInfo &DeductionFailure, 10706 unsigned NumArgs, 10707 bool TakingCandidateAddress) { 10708 TemplateParameter Param = DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter(); 10709 NamedDecl *ParamD; 10710 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) || 10711 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) || 10712 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>()); 10713 switch (DeductionFailure.Result) { 10714 case Sema::TDK_Success: 10715 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction"); 10716 10717 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: { 10718 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result"); 10719 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10720 diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction) 10721 << ParamD->getDeclName(); 10722 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10723 return; 10724 } 10725 10726 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: { 10727 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result"); 10728 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10729 diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction_pack) 10730 << ParamD->getDeclName() 10731 << (DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->pack_size() + 1) 10732 << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg(); 10733 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10734 return; 10735 } 10736 10737 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: { 10738 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result"); 10739 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD); 10740 10741 QualType Param = DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType(); 10742 10743 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a 10744 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that. 10745 QualifierCollector Qs; 10746 Qs.strip(Param); 10747 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl()); 10748 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam)); 10749 10750 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do 10751 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't 10752 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't 10753 // done on dependent types). 10754 QualType Arg = DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType(); 10755 10756 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified) 10757 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam; 10758 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10759 return; 10760 } 10761 10762 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: { 10763 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result"); 10764 int which = 0; 10765 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD)) 10766 which = 0; 10767 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) { 10768 // Deduction might have failed because we deduced arguments of two 10769 // different types for a non-type template parameter. 10770 // FIXME: Use a different TDK value for this. 10771 QualType T1 = 10772 DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getNonTypeTemplateArgumentType(); 10773 QualType T2 = 10774 DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getNonTypeTemplateArgumentType(); 10775 if (!T1.isNull() && !T2.isNull() && !S.Context.hasSameType(T1, T2)) { 10776 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10777 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction_types) 10778 << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() << T1 10779 << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg() << T2; 10780 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10781 return; 10782 } 10783 10784 which = 1; 10785 } else { 10786 which = 2; 10787 } 10788 10789 // Tweak the diagnostic if the problem is that we deduced packs of 10790 // different arities. We'll print the actual packs anyway in case that 10791 // includes additional useful information. 10792 if (DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getKind() == TemplateArgument::Pack && 10793 DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getKind() == TemplateArgument::Pack && 10794 DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->pack_size() != 10795 DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->pack_size()) { 10796 which = 3; 10797 } 10798 10799 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10800 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction) 10801 << which << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() 10802 << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg(); 10803 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10804 return; 10805 } 10806 10807 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 10808 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments"); 10809 if (ParamD->getDeclName()) 10810 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10811 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named) 10812 << ParamD->getDeclName(); 10813 else { 10814 int index = 0; 10815 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD)) 10816 index = TTP->getIndex(); 10817 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP 10818 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) 10819 index = NTTP->getIndex(); 10820 else 10821 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex(); 10822 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10823 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed) 10824 << (index + 1); 10825 } 10826 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10827 return; 10828 10829 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: { 10830 // Format the template argument list into the argument string. 10831 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString; 10832 TemplateArgumentList *Args = DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList(); 10833 TemplateArgString = " "; 10834 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 10835 getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args); 10836 if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1) 10837 TemplateArgString.clear(); 10838 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10839 diag::note_ovl_candidate_unsatisfied_constraints) 10840 << TemplateArgString; 10841 10842 S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint( 10843 static_cast<CNSInfo*>(DeductionFailure.Data)->Satisfaction); 10844 return; 10845 } 10846 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 10847 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 10848 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Found, Templated, NumArgs); 10849 return; 10850 10851 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 10852 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10853 diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth); 10854 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10855 return; 10856 10857 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: { 10858 // Format the template argument list into the argument string. 10859 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString; 10860 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args = 10861 DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) { 10862 TemplateArgString = " "; 10863 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 10864 getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args); 10865 if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1) 10866 TemplateArgString.clear(); 10867 } 10868 10869 // If this candidate was disabled by enable_if, say so. 10870 PartialDiagnosticAt *PDiag = DeductionFailure.getSFINAEDiagnostic(); 10871 if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() == 10872 diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_enable_if) { 10873 // FIXME: Use the source range of the condition, and the fully-qualified 10874 // name of the enable_if template. These are both present in PDiag. 10875 S.Diag(PDiag->first, diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if) 10876 << "'enable_if'" << TemplateArgString; 10877 return; 10878 } 10879 10880 // We found a specific requirement that disabled the enable_if. 10881 if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() == 10882 diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_requirement) { 10883 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10884 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_requirement) 10885 << PDiag->second.getStringArg(0) << TemplateArgString; 10886 return; 10887 } 10888 10889 // Format the SFINAE diagnostic into the argument string. 10890 // FIXME: Add a general mechanism to include a PartialDiagnostic *'s 10891 // formatted message in another diagnostic. 10892 SmallString<128> SFINAEArgString; 10893 SourceRange R; 10894 if (PDiag) { 10895 SFINAEArgString = ": "; 10896 R = SourceRange(PDiag->first, PDiag->first); 10897 PDiag->second.EmitToString(S.getDiagnostics(), SFINAEArgString); 10898 } 10899 10900 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10901 diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure) 10902 << TemplateArgString << SFINAEArgString << R; 10903 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10904 return; 10905 } 10906 10907 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 10908 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: { 10909 // Format the template argument list into the argument string. 10910 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString; 10911 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args = 10912 DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) { 10913 TemplateArgString = " "; 10914 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 10915 getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args); 10916 if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1) 10917 TemplateArgString.clear(); 10918 } 10919 10920 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deduced_mismatch) 10921 << (*DeductionFailure.getCallArgIndex() + 1) 10922 << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg() 10923 << TemplateArgString 10924 << (DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested); 10925 break; 10926 } 10927 10928 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: { 10929 // FIXME: Provide a source location to indicate what we couldn't match. 10930 TemplateArgument FirstTA = *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg(); 10931 TemplateArgument SecondTA = *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg(); 10932 if (FirstTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template && 10933 SecondTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template) { 10934 TemplateName FirstTN = FirstTA.getAsTemplate(); 10935 TemplateName SecondTN = SecondTA.getAsTemplate(); 10936 if (FirstTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template && 10937 SecondTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template) { 10938 if (FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName() == 10939 SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName()) { 10940 // FIXME: This fixes a bad diagnostic where both templates are named 10941 // the same. This particular case is a bit difficult since: 10942 // 1) It is passed as a string to the diagnostic printer. 10943 // 2) The diagnostic printer only attempts to find a better 10944 // name for types, not decls. 10945 // Ideally, this should folded into the diagnostic printer. 10946 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10947 diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch_qualified) 10948 << FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl() << SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl(); 10949 return; 10950 } 10951 } 10952 } 10953 10954 if (TakingCandidateAddress && isa<FunctionDecl>(Templated) && 10955 !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, cast<FunctionDecl>(Templated))) 10956 return; 10957 10958 // FIXME: For generic lambda parameters, check if the function is a lambda 10959 // call operator, and if so, emit a prettier and more informative 10960 // diagnostic that mentions 'auto' and lambda in addition to 10961 // (or instead of?) the canonical template type parameters. 10962 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10963 diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch) 10964 << FirstTA << SecondTA; 10965 return; 10966 } 10967 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off 10968 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague. 10969 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 10970 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction); 10971 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10972 return; 10973 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 10974 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10975 diag::note_cuda_ovl_candidate_target_mismatch); 10976 return; 10977 } 10978 } 10979 10980 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction, for function calls. 10981 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10982 unsigned NumArgs, 10983 bool TakingCandidateAddress) { 10984 unsigned TDK = Cand->DeductionFailure.Result; 10985 if (TDK == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments || TDK == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments) { 10986 if (CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs)) 10987 return; 10988 } 10989 DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function, // pattern 10990 Cand->DeductionFailure, NumArgs, TakingCandidateAddress); 10991 } 10992 10993 /// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets. 10994 static void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 10995 FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext); 10996 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function; 10997 10998 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller), 10999 CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee); 11000 11001 std::string FnDesc; 11002 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 11003 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Callee, 11004 Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc); 11005 11006 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target) 11007 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)ocs_non_template 11008 << FnDesc /* Ignored */ 11009 << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget; 11010 11011 // This could be an implicit constructor for which we could not infer the 11012 // target due to a collsion. Diagnose that case. 11013 CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Callee); 11014 if (Meth != nullptr && Meth->isImplicit()) { 11015 CXXRecordDecl *ParentClass = Meth->getParent(); 11016 Sema::CXXSpecialMember CSM; 11017 11018 switch (FnKindPair.first) { 11019 default: 11020 return; 11021 case oc_implicit_default_constructor: 11022 CSM = Sema::CXXDefaultConstructor; 11023 break; 11024 case oc_implicit_copy_constructor: 11025 CSM = Sema::CXXCopyConstructor; 11026 break; 11027 case oc_implicit_move_constructor: 11028 CSM = Sema::CXXMoveConstructor; 11029 break; 11030 case oc_implicit_copy_assignment: 11031 CSM = Sema::CXXCopyAssignment; 11032 break; 11033 case oc_implicit_move_assignment: 11034 CSM = Sema::CXXMoveAssignment; 11035 break; 11036 }; 11037 11038 bool ConstRHS = false; 11039 if (Meth->getNumParams()) { 11040 if (const ReferenceType *RT = 11041 Meth->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 11042 ConstRHS = RT->getPointeeType().isConstQualified(); 11043 } 11044 } 11045 11046 S.inferCUDATargetForImplicitSpecialMember(ParentClass, CSM, Meth, 11047 /* ConstRHS */ ConstRHS, 11048 /* Diagnose */ true); 11049 } 11050 } 11051 11052 static void DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11053 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function; 11054 EnableIfAttr *Attr = static_cast<EnableIfAttr*>(Cand->DeductionFailure.Data); 11055 11056 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), 11057 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr) 11058 << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage(); 11059 } 11060 11061 static void DiagnoseFailedExplicitSpec(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11062 ExplicitSpecifier ES = ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(Cand->Function); 11063 assert(ES.isExplicit() && "not an explicit candidate"); 11064 11065 unsigned Kind; 11066 switch (Cand->Function->getDeclKind()) { 11067 case Decl::Kind::CXXConstructor: 11068 Kind = 0; 11069 break; 11070 case Decl::Kind::CXXConversion: 11071 Kind = 1; 11072 break; 11073 case Decl::Kind::CXXDeductionGuide: 11074 Kind = Cand->Function->isImplicit() ? 0 : 2; 11075 break; 11076 default: 11077 llvm_unreachable("invalid Decl"); 11078 } 11079 11080 // Note the location of the first (in-class) declaration; a redeclaration 11081 // (particularly an out-of-class definition) will typically lack the 11082 // 'explicit' specifier. 11083 // FIXME: This is probably a good thing to do for all 'candidate' notes. 11084 FunctionDecl *First = Cand->Function->getFirstDecl(); 11085 if (FunctionDecl *Pattern = First->getTemplateInstantiationPattern()) 11086 First = Pattern->getFirstDecl(); 11087 11088 S.Diag(First->getLocation(), 11089 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit) 11090 << Kind << (ES.getExpr() ? 1 : 0) 11091 << (ES.getExpr() ? ES.getExpr()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()); 11092 } 11093 11094 static void DiagnoseOpenCLExtensionDisabled(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11095 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function; 11096 11097 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), 11098 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_extension) 11099 << S.getOpenCLExtensionsFromDeclExtMap(Callee); 11100 } 11101 11102 /// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've 11103 /// already generated a primary error at the call site. 11104 /// 11105 /// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret 11106 /// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some 11107 /// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing 11108 /// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still 11109 /// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed 11110 /// overload. 11111 /// 11112 /// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems 11113 /// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd 11114 /// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics. 11115 /// \param CtorDestAS Addr space of object being constructed (for ctor 11116 /// candidates only). 11117 static void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 11118 unsigned NumArgs, 11119 bool TakingCandidateAddress, 11120 LangAS CtorDestAS = LangAS::Default) { 11121 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 11122 if (shouldSkipNotingLambdaConversionDecl(Fn)) 11123 return; 11124 11125 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable. 11126 if (Cand->Viable) { 11127 if (Fn->isDeleted()) { 11128 std::string FnDesc; 11129 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 11130 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, 11131 Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc); 11132 11133 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted) 11134 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 11135 << (Fn->isDeleted() ? (Fn->isDeletedAsWritten() ? 1 : 2) : 0); 11136 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 11137 return; 11138 } 11139 11140 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates. 11141 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind()); 11142 return; 11143 } 11144 11145 switch (Cand->FailureKind) { 11146 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments: 11147 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments: 11148 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs); 11149 11150 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction: 11151 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs, 11152 TakingCandidateAddress); 11153 11154 case ovl_fail_illegal_constructor: { 11155 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_illegal_constructor) 11156 << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0); 11157 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 11158 return; 11159 } 11160 11161 case ovl_fail_object_addrspace_mismatch: { 11162 Qualifiers QualsForPrinting; 11163 QualsForPrinting.setAddressSpace(CtorDestAS); 11164 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 11165 diag::note_ovl_candidate_illegal_constructor_adrspace_mismatch) 11166 << QualsForPrinting; 11167 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 11168 return; 11169 } 11170 11171 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion: 11172 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion: 11173 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact: 11174 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind()); 11175 11176 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: { 11177 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); 11178 for (unsigned N = Cand->Conversions.size(); I != N; ++I) 11179 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad()) 11180 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I, TakingCandidateAddress); 11181 11182 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit 11183 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle 11184 // those conditions and diagnose them well. 11185 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind()); 11186 } 11187 11188 case ovl_fail_bad_target: 11189 return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand); 11190 11191 case ovl_fail_enable_if: 11192 return DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(S, Cand); 11193 11194 case ovl_fail_explicit: 11195 return DiagnoseFailedExplicitSpec(S, Cand); 11196 11197 case ovl_fail_ext_disabled: 11198 return DiagnoseOpenCLExtensionDisabled(S, Cand); 11199 11200 case ovl_fail_inhctor_slice: 11201 // It's generally not interesting to note copy/move constructors here. 11202 if (cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)->isCopyOrMoveConstructor()) 11203 return; 11204 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 11205 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor_slice) 11206 << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0) 11207 << Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->isRValueReferenceType(); 11208 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 11209 return; 11210 11211 case ovl_fail_addr_not_available: { 11212 bool Available = checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, Cand->Function); 11213 (void)Available; 11214 assert(!Available); 11215 break; 11216 } 11217 case ovl_non_default_multiversion_function: 11218 // Do nothing, these should simply be ignored. 11219 break; 11220 11221 case ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied: { 11222 std::string FnDesc; 11223 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 11224 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, 11225 Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc); 11226 11227 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 11228 diag::note_ovl_candidate_constraints_not_satisfied) 11229 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)ocs_non_template 11230 << FnDesc /* Ignored */; 11231 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 11232 if (S.CheckFunctionConstraints(Fn, Satisfaction)) 11233 break; 11234 S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint(Satisfaction); 11235 } 11236 } 11237 } 11238 11239 static void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11240 if (shouldSkipNotingLambdaConversionDecl(Cand->Surrogate)) 11241 return; 11242 11243 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type, 11244 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing 11245 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types). 11246 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType(); 11247 bool isLValueReference = false; 11248 bool isRValueReference = false; 11249 bool isPointer = false; 11250 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef = 11251 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) { 11252 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 11253 isLValueReference = true; 11254 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef = 11255 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) { 11256 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 11257 isRValueReference = true; 11258 } 11259 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 11260 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 11261 isPointer = true; 11262 } 11263 // Desugar down to a function type. 11264 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0); 11265 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate. 11266 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType); 11267 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType); 11268 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType); 11269 11270 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand) 11271 << FnType; 11272 } 11273 11274 static void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S, StringRef Opc, 11275 SourceLocation OpLoc, 11276 OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11277 assert(Cand->Conversions.size() <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary"); 11278 std::string TypeStr("operator"); 11279 TypeStr += Opc; 11280 TypeStr += "("; 11281 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinParamTypes[0].getAsString(); 11282 if (Cand->Conversions.size() == 1) { 11283 TypeStr += ")"; 11284 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_candidate) << TypeStr; 11285 } else { 11286 TypeStr += ", "; 11287 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinParamTypes[1].getAsString(); 11288 TypeStr += ")"; 11289 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_candidate) << TypeStr; 11290 } 11291 } 11292 11293 static void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 11294 OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11295 for (const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS : Cand->Conversions) { 11296 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid 11297 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue; 11298 11299 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion( 11300 S, OpLoc, S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion)); 11301 } 11302 } 11303 11304 static SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11305 if (Cand->Function) 11306 return Cand->Function->getLocation(); 11307 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) 11308 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(); 11309 return SourceLocation(); 11310 } 11311 11312 static unsigned RankDeductionFailure(const DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) { 11313 switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) { 11314 case Sema::TDK_Success: 11315 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 11316 llvm_unreachable("non-deduction failure while diagnosing bad deduction"); 11317 11318 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 11319 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 11320 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 11321 return 1; 11322 11323 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 11324 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 11325 return 2; 11326 11327 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 11328 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 11329 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 11330 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 11331 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 11332 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 11333 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 11334 return 3; 11335 11336 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 11337 return 4; 11338 11339 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 11340 return 5; 11341 11342 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 11343 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 11344 return 6; 11345 } 11346 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result"); 11347 } 11348 11349 namespace { 11350 struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay { 11351 Sema &S; 11352 SourceLocation Loc; 11353 size_t NumArgs; 11354 OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK; 11355 11356 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay( 11357 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, size_t NArgs, 11358 OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK) 11359 : S(S), NumArgs(NArgs), CSK(CSK) {} 11360 11361 OverloadFailureKind EffectiveFailureKind(const OverloadCandidate *C) const { 11362 // If there are too many or too few arguments, that's the high-order bit we 11363 // want to sort by, even if the immediate failure kind was something else. 11364 if (C->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 11365 C->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) 11366 return static_cast<OverloadFailureKind>(C->FailureKind); 11367 11368 if (C->Function) { 11369 if (NumArgs > C->Function->getNumParams() && !C->Function->isVariadic()) 11370 return ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 11371 if (NumArgs < C->Function->getMinRequiredArguments()) 11372 return ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 11373 } 11374 11375 return static_cast<OverloadFailureKind>(C->FailureKind); 11376 } 11377 11378 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L, 11379 const OverloadCandidate *R) { 11380 // Fast-path this check. 11381 if (L == R) return false; 11382 11383 // Order first by viability. 11384 if (L->Viable) { 11385 if (!R->Viable) return true; 11386 11387 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload 11388 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort 11389 // that could exploit it. 11390 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation(), CSK)) 11391 return true; 11392 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation(), CSK)) 11393 return false; 11394 } else if (R->Viable) 11395 return false; 11396 11397 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable); 11398 11399 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates: 11400 if (!L->Viable) { 11401 OverloadFailureKind LFailureKind = EffectiveFailureKind(L); 11402 OverloadFailureKind RFailureKind = EffectiveFailureKind(R); 11403 11404 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates. 11405 if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 11406 LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) { 11407 if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 11408 RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) { 11409 int LDist = std::abs((int)L->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs); 11410 int RDist = std::abs((int)R->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs); 11411 if (LDist == RDist) { 11412 if (LFailureKind == RFailureKind) 11413 // Sort non-surrogates before surrogates. 11414 return !L->IsSurrogate && R->IsSurrogate; 11415 // Sort candidates requiring fewer parameters than there were 11416 // arguments given after candidates requiring more parameters 11417 // than there were arguments given. 11418 return LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 11419 } 11420 return LDist < RDist; 11421 } 11422 return false; 11423 } 11424 if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 11425 RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) 11426 return true; 11427 11428 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number 11429 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions. 11430 if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) { 11431 if (RFailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 11432 return true; 11433 11434 // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes, 11435 // comes first. 11436 unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed; 11437 unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed; 11438 numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes; 11439 numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes; 11440 if (numLFixes != numRFixes) { 11441 return numLFixes < numRFixes; 11442 } 11443 11444 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions... 11445 // FIXME: this might not be transitive. 11446 assert(L->Conversions.size() == R->Conversions.size()); 11447 11448 int leftBetter = 0; 11449 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument); 11450 for (unsigned E = L->Conversions.size(); I != E; ++I) { 11451 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, Loc, 11452 L->Conversions[I], 11453 R->Conversions[I])) { 11454 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 11455 leftBetter++; 11456 break; 11457 11458 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 11459 leftBetter--; 11460 break; 11461 11462 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 11463 break; 11464 } 11465 } 11466 if (leftBetter > 0) return true; 11467 if (leftBetter < 0) return false; 11468 11469 } else if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 11470 return false; 11471 11472 if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) { 11473 if (RFailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 11474 return true; 11475 11476 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result) 11477 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) 11478 < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure); 11479 } else if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 11480 return false; 11481 11482 // TODO: others? 11483 } 11484 11485 // Sort everything else by location. 11486 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L); 11487 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R); 11488 11489 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end. 11490 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false; 11491 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true; 11492 11493 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc); 11494 } 11495 }; 11496 } 11497 11498 /// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only 11499 /// computes up to the first bad conversion. Produces the FixIt set if 11500 /// possible. 11501 static void 11502 CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 11503 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11504 OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK) { 11505 assert(!Cand->Viable); 11506 11507 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion. 11508 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 11509 return; 11510 11511 // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected. 11512 bool Unfixable = false; 11513 // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes. 11514 Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization); 11515 11516 // Attempt to fix the bad conversion. 11517 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->Conversions.size(); 11518 for (unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); /**/; 11519 ++ConvIdx) { 11520 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate"); 11521 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() && 11522 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) { 11523 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S); 11524 break; 11525 } 11526 } 11527 11528 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload 11529 // operation somehow. 11530 bool SuppressUserConversions = false; 11531 11532 unsigned ConvIdx = 0; 11533 unsigned ArgIdx = 0; 11534 ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes; 11535 bool Reversed = Cand->isReversed(); 11536 11537 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) { 11538 QualType ConvType 11539 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 11540 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>()) 11541 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType(); 11542 ParamTypes = ConvType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getParamTypes(); 11543 // Conversion 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter. 11544 ConvIdx = 1; 11545 } else if (Cand->Function) { 11546 ParamTypes = 11547 Cand->Function->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getParamTypes(); 11548 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) && 11549 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function) && !Reversed) { 11550 // Conversion 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter. 11551 ConvIdx = 1; 11552 if (CSK == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator && 11553 Cand->Function->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_Call) 11554 // Argument 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter. 11555 ArgIdx = 1; 11556 } 11557 } else { 11558 // Builtin operator. 11559 assert(ConvCount <= 3); 11560 ParamTypes = Cand->BuiltinParamTypes; 11561 } 11562 11563 // Fill in the rest of the conversions. 11564 for (unsigned ParamIdx = Reversed ? ParamTypes.size() - 1 : 0; 11565 ConvIdx != ConvCount; 11566 ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx, ParamIdx += (Reversed ? -1 : 1)) { 11567 assert(ArgIdx < Args.size() && "no argument for this arg conversion"); 11568 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) { 11569 // We've already checked this conversion. 11570 } else if (ParamIdx < ParamTypes.size()) { 11571 if (ParamTypes[ParamIdx]->isDependentType()) 11572 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setAsIdentityConversion( 11573 Args[ArgIdx]->getType()); 11574 else { 11575 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx] = 11576 TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTypes[ParamIdx], 11577 SuppressUserConversions, 11578 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 11579 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 11580 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 11581 // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists. 11582 if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) 11583 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S); 11584 } 11585 } else 11586 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis(); 11587 } 11588 } 11589 11590 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate *, 32> OverloadCandidateSet::CompleteCandidates( 11591 Sema &S, OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11592 SourceLocation OpLoc, 11593 llvm::function_ref<bool(OverloadCandidate &)> Filter) { 11594 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would 11595 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those. 11596 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands; 11597 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size()); 11598 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) { 11599 if (!Filter(*Cand)) 11600 continue; 11601 switch (OCD) { 11602 case OCD_AllCandidates: 11603 if (!Cand->Viable) { 11604 if (!Cand->Function && !Cand->IsSurrogate) { 11605 // This a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general, 11606 // want to list every possible builtin candidate. 11607 continue; 11608 } 11609 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args, Kind); 11610 } 11611 break; 11612 11613 case OCD_ViableCandidates: 11614 if (!Cand->Viable) 11615 continue; 11616 break; 11617 11618 case OCD_AmbiguousCandidates: 11619 if (!Cand->Best) 11620 continue; 11621 break; 11622 } 11623 11624 Cands.push_back(Cand); 11625 } 11626 11627 llvm::stable_sort( 11628 Cands, CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S, OpLoc, Args.size(), Kind)); 11629 11630 return Cands; 11631 } 11632 11633 bool OverloadCandidateSet::shouldDeferDiags(Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11634 SourceLocation OpLoc) { 11635 bool DeferHint = false; 11636 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && S.getLangOpts().GPUDeferDiag) { 11637 // Defer diagnostic for CUDA/HIP if there are wrong-sided candidates or 11638 // host device candidates. 11639 auto WrongSidedCands = 11640 CompleteCandidates(S, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, OpLoc, [](auto &Cand) { 11641 return (Cand.Viable == false && 11642 Cand.FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_target) || 11643 (Cand.Function->template hasAttr<CUDAHostAttr>() && 11644 Cand.Function->template hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>()); 11645 }); 11646 DeferHint = !WrongSidedCands.empty(); 11647 } 11648 return DeferHint; 11649 } 11650 11651 /// When overload resolution fails, prints diagnostic messages containing the 11652 /// candidates in the candidate set. 11653 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates( 11654 PartialDiagnosticAt PD, Sema &S, OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD, 11655 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, StringRef Opc, SourceLocation OpLoc, 11656 llvm::function_ref<bool(OverloadCandidate &)> Filter) { 11657 11658 auto Cands = CompleteCandidates(S, OCD, Args, OpLoc, Filter); 11659 11660 S.Diag(PD.first, PD.second, shouldDeferDiags(S, Args, OpLoc)); 11661 11662 NoteCandidates(S, Args, Cands, Opc, OpLoc); 11663 11664 if (OCD == OCD_AmbiguousCandidates) 11665 MaybeDiagnoseAmbiguousConstraints(S, {begin(), end()}); 11666 } 11667 11668 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11669 ArrayRef<OverloadCandidate *> Cands, 11670 StringRef Opc, SourceLocation OpLoc) { 11671 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false; 11672 11673 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 11674 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 11675 auto I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); 11676 for (; I != E; ++I) { 11677 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I; 11678 11679 if (CandsShown >= S.Diags.getNumOverloadCandidatesToShow() && 11680 ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) { 11681 break; 11682 } 11683 ++CandsShown; 11684 11685 if (Cand->Function) 11686 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size(), 11687 /*TakingCandidateAddress=*/false, DestAS); 11688 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate) 11689 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand); 11690 else { 11691 assert(Cand->Viable && 11692 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands."); 11693 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin 11694 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an 11695 // ambiguous user-defined conversion. 11696 // 11697 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see 11698 // different ambiguities, though. 11699 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) { 11700 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand); 11701 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true; 11702 } 11703 11704 // If this is a viable builtin, print it. 11705 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand); 11706 } 11707 } 11708 11709 // Inform S.Diags that we've shown an overload set with N elements. This may 11710 // inform the future value of S.Diags.getNumOverloadCandidatesToShow(). 11711 S.Diags.overloadCandidatesShown(CandsShown); 11712 11713 if (I != E) 11714 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates, 11715 shouldDeferDiags(S, Args, OpLoc)) 11716 << int(E - I); 11717 } 11718 11719 static SourceLocation 11720 GetLocationForCandidate(const TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand) { 11721 return Cand->Specialization ? Cand->Specialization->getLocation() 11722 : SourceLocation(); 11723 } 11724 11725 namespace { 11726 struct CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay { 11727 Sema &S; 11728 CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {} 11729 11730 bool operator()(const TemplateSpecCandidate *L, 11731 const TemplateSpecCandidate *R) { 11732 // Fast-path this check. 11733 if (L == R) 11734 return false; 11735 11736 // Assuming that both candidates are not matches... 11737 11738 // Sort by the ranking of deduction failures. 11739 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result) 11740 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) < 11741 RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure); 11742 11743 // Sort everything else by location. 11744 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L); 11745 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R); 11746 11747 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end. 11748 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) 11749 return false; 11750 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) 11751 return true; 11752 11753 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc); 11754 } 11755 }; 11756 } 11757 11758 /// Diagnose a template argument deduction failure. 11759 /// We are treating these failures as overload failures due to bad 11760 /// deductions. 11761 void TemplateSpecCandidate::NoteDeductionFailure(Sema &S, 11762 bool ForTakingAddress) { 11763 DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, FoundDecl, Specialization, // pattern 11764 DeductionFailure, /*NumArgs=*/0, ForTakingAddress); 11765 } 11766 11767 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() { 11768 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) { 11769 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy(); 11770 } 11771 } 11772 11773 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::clear() { 11774 destroyCandidates(); 11775 Candidates.clear(); 11776 } 11777 11778 /// NoteCandidates - When no template specialization match is found, prints 11779 /// diagnostic messages containing the non-matching specializations that form 11780 /// the candidate set. 11781 /// This is analoguous to OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates() with 11782 /// OCD == OCD_AllCandidates and Cand->Viable == false. 11783 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) { 11784 // Sort the candidates by position (assuming no candidate is a match). 11785 // Sorting directly would be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers 11786 // and sort those. 11787 SmallVector<TemplateSpecCandidate *, 32> Cands; 11788 Cands.reserve(size()); 11789 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) { 11790 if (Cand->Specialization) 11791 Cands.push_back(Cand); 11792 // Otherwise, this is a non-matching builtin candidate. We do not, 11793 // in general, want to list every possible builtin candidate. 11794 } 11795 11796 llvm::sort(Cands, CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(S)); 11797 11798 // FIXME: Perhaps rename OverloadsShown and getShowOverloads() 11799 // for generalization purposes (?). 11800 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 11801 11802 SmallVectorImpl<TemplateSpecCandidate *>::iterator I, E; 11803 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 11804 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) { 11805 TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand = *I; 11806 11807 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidates we'll spam 11808 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the 11809 // candidate list. 11810 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) 11811 break; 11812 ++CandsShown; 11813 11814 assert(Cand->Specialization && 11815 "Non-matching built-in candidates are not added to Cands."); 11816 Cand->NoteDeductionFailure(S, ForTakingAddress); 11817 } 11818 11819 if (I != E) 11820 S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I); 11821 } 11822 11823 // [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return] 11824 // NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType 11825 // R (A) --> R(A) 11826 // R (*)(A) --> R (A) 11827 // R (&)(A) --> R (A) 11828 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A) 11829 QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) { 11830 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType; 11831 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr = 11832 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>()) 11833 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 11834 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef = 11835 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 11836 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 11837 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr = 11838 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 11839 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 11840 Ret = 11841 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType(); 11842 return Ret; 11843 } 11844 11845 static bool completeFunctionType(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD, SourceLocation Loc, 11846 bool Complain = true) { 11847 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() && 11848 S.DeduceReturnType(FD, Loc, Complain)) 11849 return true; 11850 11851 auto *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 11852 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && 11853 isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType()) && 11854 !S.ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT)) 11855 return true; 11856 11857 return false; 11858 } 11859 11860 namespace { 11861 // A helper class to help with address of function resolution 11862 // - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters 11863 class AddressOfFunctionResolver { 11864 Sema& S; 11865 Expr* SourceExpr; 11866 const QualType& TargetType; 11867 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type 11868 11869 bool Complain; 11870 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair; 11871 ASTContext& Context; 11872 11873 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction; 11874 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction; 11875 bool StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer; 11876 bool HasComplained; 11877 11878 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo; 11879 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr; 11880 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs; 11881 SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches; 11882 TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates; 11883 11884 public: 11885 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr *SourceExpr, 11886 const QualType &TargetType, bool Complain) 11887 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType), 11888 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()), 11889 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction( 11890 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()), 11891 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false), 11892 StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(false), 11893 HasComplained(false), 11894 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)), 11895 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression), 11896 FailedCandidates(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), /*ForTakingAddress=*/true) { 11897 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType(); 11898 11899 if (TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) { 11900 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *UME = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(OvlExpr)) 11901 if (!UME->isImplicitAccess() && 11902 !S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(UME)) 11903 StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer = true; 11904 } else if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 11905 DeclAccessPair dap; 11906 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 11907 OvlExpr, false, &dap)) { 11908 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) 11909 if (!Method->isStatic()) { 11910 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function found 11911 // is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was the 11912 // target, it's the only possible type to end up with. 11913 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true; 11914 11915 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form. 11916 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions. 11917 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer) 11918 return; 11919 } 11920 11921 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap, Fn)); 11922 } 11923 return; 11924 } 11925 11926 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) 11927 OvlExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs); 11928 11929 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) { 11930 // C++ [over.over]p4: 11931 // If more than one function is selected, [...] 11932 if (Matches.size() > 1 && !eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates()) { 11933 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction) 11934 EliminateAllTemplateMatches(); 11935 else 11936 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate(); 11937 } 11938 } 11939 11940 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Matches.size() > 1) 11941 EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches(); 11942 } 11943 11944 bool hasComplained() const { return HasComplained; } 11945 11946 private: 11947 bool candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 11948 QualType Discard; 11949 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType, FD->getType()) || 11950 S.IsFunctionConversion(FD->getType(), TargetFunctionType, Discard); 11951 } 11952 11953 /// \return true if A is considered a better overload candidate for the 11954 /// desired type than B. 11955 bool isBetterCandidate(const FunctionDecl *A, const FunctionDecl *B) { 11956 // If A doesn't have exactly the correct type, we don't want to classify it 11957 // as "better" than anything else. This way, the user is required to 11958 // disambiguate for us if there are multiple candidates and no exact match. 11959 return candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(A) && 11960 (!candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(B) || 11961 compareEnableIfAttrs(S, A, B) == Comparison::Better); 11962 } 11963 11964 /// \return true if we were able to eliminate all but one overload candidate, 11965 /// false otherwise. 11966 bool eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates() { 11967 // Same algorithm as overload resolution -- one pass to pick the "best", 11968 // another pass to be sure that nothing is better than the best. 11969 auto Best = Matches.begin(); 11970 for (auto I = Matches.begin()+1, E = Matches.end(); I != E; ++I) 11971 if (isBetterCandidate(I->second, Best->second)) 11972 Best = I; 11973 11974 const FunctionDecl *BestFn = Best->second; 11975 auto IsBestOrInferiorToBest = [this, BestFn]( 11976 const std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl *> &Pair) { 11977 return BestFn == Pair.second || isBetterCandidate(BestFn, Pair.second); 11978 }; 11979 11980 // Note: We explicitly leave Matches unmodified if there isn't a clear best 11981 // option, so we can potentially give the user a better error 11982 if (!llvm::all_of(Matches, IsBestOrInferiorToBest)) 11983 return false; 11984 Matches[0] = *Best; 11985 Matches.resize(1); 11986 return true; 11987 } 11988 11989 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const { 11990 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType(); 11991 } 11992 11993 // [ToType] [Return] 11994 11995 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false 11996 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false 11997 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true 11998 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() { 11999 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType); 12000 } 12001 12002 // return true if any matching specializations were found 12003 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate, 12004 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) { 12005 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method 12006 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) { 12007 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and 12008 // static when converting to member pointer. 12009 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 12010 return false; 12011 } 12012 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 12013 return false; 12014 12015 // C++ [over.over]p2: 12016 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is 12017 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the 12018 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single 12019 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of 12020 // overloaded functions considered. 12021 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 12022 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation()); 12023 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result 12024 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, 12025 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs, 12026 TargetFunctionType, Specialization, 12027 Info, /*IsAddressOfFunction*/true)) { 12028 // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics. 12029 FailedCandidates.addCandidate() 12030 .set(CurAccessFunPair, FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(), 12031 MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info)); 12032 return false; 12033 } 12034 12035 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match or 12036 // compatible pointer-to-function arguments that would be adjusted by ICS. 12037 // This function template specicalization works. 12038 assert(S.isSameOrCompatibleFunctionType( 12039 Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()), 12040 Context.getCanonicalType(TargetFunctionType))); 12041 12042 if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(Specialization)) 12043 return false; 12044 12045 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization)); 12046 return true; 12047 } 12048 12049 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn, 12050 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) { 12051 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 12052 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static 12053 // when converting to member pointer. 12054 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 12055 return false; 12056 } 12057 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 12058 return false; 12059 12060 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) { 12061 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA) 12062 if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext)) 12063 if (!Caller->isImplicit() && !S.IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, FunDecl)) 12064 return false; 12065 if (FunDecl->isMultiVersion()) { 12066 const auto *TA = FunDecl->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 12067 if (TA && !TA->isDefaultVersion()) 12068 return false; 12069 } 12070 12071 // If any candidate has a placeholder return type, trigger its deduction 12072 // now. 12073 if (completeFunctionType(S, FunDecl, SourceExpr->getBeginLoc(), 12074 Complain)) { 12075 HasComplained |= Complain; 12076 return false; 12077 } 12078 12079 if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FunDecl)) 12080 return false; 12081 12082 // If we're in C, we need to support types that aren't exactly identical. 12083 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || 12084 candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(FunDecl)) { 12085 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair( 12086 CurAccessFunPair, cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl()))); 12087 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true; 12088 return true; 12089 } 12090 } 12091 12092 return false; 12093 } 12094 12095 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() { 12096 bool Ret = false; 12097 12098 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to 12099 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type. 12100 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction()) 12101 return false; 12102 12103 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 12104 E = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 12105 I != E; ++I) { 12106 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function. 12107 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 12108 12109 // C++ [over.over]p3: 12110 // Non-member functions and static member functions match 12111 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function." 12112 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of 12113 // type "pointer-to-member-function." 12114 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter. 12115 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate 12116 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) { 12117 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair())) 12118 Ret = true; 12119 } 12120 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates. 12121 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() && 12122 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair())) 12123 Ret = true; 12124 } 12125 assert(Ret || Matches.empty()); 12126 return Ret; 12127 } 12128 12129 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() { 12130 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is 12131 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template 12132 // specialization whose function template is more specialized 12133 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial 12134 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2. 12135 12136 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a 12137 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the 12138 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the 12139 // best function template (if it exists). 12140 12141 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid! 12142 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I) 12143 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess()); 12144 12145 // TODO: It looks like FailedCandidates does not serve much purpose 12146 // here, since the no_viable diagnostic has index 0. 12147 UnresolvedSetIterator Result = S.getMostSpecialized( 12148 MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(), FailedCandidates, 12149 SourceExpr->getBeginLoc(), S.PDiag(), 12150 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 12151 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(), 12152 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) 12153 << (unsigned)oc_function << (unsigned)ocs_described_template, 12154 Complain, TargetFunctionType); 12155 12156 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) { 12157 // Make it the first and only element 12158 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first; 12159 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result); 12160 Matches.resize(1); 12161 } else 12162 HasComplained |= Complain; 12163 } 12164 12165 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() { 12166 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are 12167 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...] 12168 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) { 12169 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == nullptr) 12170 ++I; 12171 else { 12172 Matches[I] = Matches[--N]; 12173 Matches.resize(N); 12174 } 12175 } 12176 } 12177 12178 void EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches() { 12179 S.EraseUnwantedCUDAMatches(dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext), Matches); 12180 } 12181 12182 public: 12183 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const { 12184 assert(Matches.empty()); 12185 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable) 12186 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType 12187 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 12188 if (FailedCandidates.empty()) 12189 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType, 12190 /*TakingAddress=*/true); 12191 else { 12192 // We have some deduction failure messages. Use them to diagnose 12193 // the function templates, and diagnose the non-template candidates 12194 // normally. 12195 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 12196 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 12197 I != IEnd; ++I) 12198 if (FunctionDecl *Fun = 12199 dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl())) 12200 if (!functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Fun)) 12201 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, Fun, CRK_None, TargetFunctionType, 12202 /*TakingAddress=*/true); 12203 FailedCandidates.NoteCandidates(S, OvlExpr->getBeginLoc()); 12204 } 12205 } 12206 12207 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const { 12208 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction && 12209 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer; 12210 } 12211 12212 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const { 12213 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might 12214 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers? 12215 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt. 12216 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier) 12217 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 12218 } 12219 12220 bool IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const { 12221 return StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer; 12222 } 12223 12224 void ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const { 12225 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), 12226 diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 12227 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 12228 } 12229 12230 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const { 12231 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref) 12232 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType; 12233 } 12234 12235 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const { 12236 assert(Matches.size() > 1); 12237 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 12238 << OvlExpr->getName() << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 12239 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType, 12240 /*TakingAddress=*/true); 12241 } 12242 12243 bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); } 12244 12245 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); } 12246 12247 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const { 12248 if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr; 12249 return Matches[0].second; 12250 } 12251 12252 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const { 12253 if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr; 12254 return &Matches[0].first; 12255 } 12256 }; 12257 } 12258 12259 /// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of 12260 /// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an 12261 /// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type 12262 /// we're trying to resolve to. For example: 12263 /// 12264 /// @code 12265 /// int f(double); 12266 /// int f(int); 12267 /// 12268 /// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double) 12269 /// @endcode 12270 /// 12271 /// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be 12272 /// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this 12273 /// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error. 12274 FunctionDecl * 12275 Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr, 12276 QualType TargetType, 12277 bool Complain, 12278 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult, 12279 bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) { 12280 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 12281 12282 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType, 12283 Complain); 12284 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches(); 12285 FunctionDecl *Fn = nullptr; 12286 bool ShouldComplain = Complain && !Resolver.hasComplained(); 12287 if (NumMatches == 0 && ShouldComplain) { 12288 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction()) 12289 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction(); 12290 else 12291 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound(); 12292 } 12293 else if (NumMatches > 1 && ShouldComplain) 12294 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound(); 12295 else if (NumMatches == 1) { 12296 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl(); 12297 assert(Fn); 12298 if (auto *FPT = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 12299 ResolveExceptionSpec(AddressOfExpr->getExprLoc(), FPT); 12300 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair(); 12301 if (Complain) { 12302 if (Resolver.IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer()) 12303 Resolver.ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(); 12304 else 12305 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult); 12306 } 12307 } 12308 12309 if (pHadMultipleCandidates) 12310 *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates(); 12311 return Fn; 12312 } 12313 12314 /// Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to 12315 /// resolve that function to a single function that can have its address taken. 12316 /// This will modify `Pair` iff it returns non-null. 12317 /// 12318 /// This routine can only succeed if from all of the candidates in the overload 12319 /// set for SrcExpr that can have their addresses taken, there is one candidate 12320 /// that is more constrained than the rest. 12321 FunctionDecl * 12322 Sema::resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair &Pair) { 12323 OverloadExpr::FindResult R = OverloadExpr::find(E); 12324 OverloadExpr *Ovl = R.Expression; 12325 bool IsResultAmbiguous = false; 12326 FunctionDecl *Result = nullptr; 12327 DeclAccessPair DAP; 12328 SmallVector<FunctionDecl *, 2> AmbiguousDecls; 12329 12330 auto CheckMoreConstrained = 12331 [&] (FunctionDecl *FD1, FunctionDecl *FD2) -> Optional<bool> { 12332 SmallVector<const Expr *, 1> AC1, AC2; 12333 FD1->getAssociatedConstraints(AC1); 12334 FD2->getAssociatedConstraints(AC2); 12335 bool AtLeastAsConstrained1, AtLeastAsConstrained2; 12336 if (IsAtLeastAsConstrained(FD1, AC1, FD2, AC2, AtLeastAsConstrained1)) 12337 return None; 12338 if (IsAtLeastAsConstrained(FD2, AC2, FD1, AC1, AtLeastAsConstrained2)) 12339 return None; 12340 if (AtLeastAsConstrained1 == AtLeastAsConstrained2) 12341 return None; 12342 return AtLeastAsConstrained1; 12343 }; 12344 12345 // Don't use the AddressOfResolver because we're specifically looking for 12346 // cases where we have one overload candidate that lacks 12347 // enable_if/pass_object_size/... 12348 for (auto I = Ovl->decls_begin(), E = Ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 12349 auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(I->getUnderlyingDecl()); 12350 if (!FD) 12351 return nullptr; 12352 12353 if (!checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD)) 12354 continue; 12355 12356 // We have more than one result - see if it is more constrained than the 12357 // previous one. 12358 if (Result) { 12359 Optional<bool> MoreConstrainedThanPrevious = CheckMoreConstrained(FD, 12360 Result); 12361 if (!MoreConstrainedThanPrevious) { 12362 IsResultAmbiguous = true; 12363 AmbiguousDecls.push_back(FD); 12364 continue; 12365 } 12366 if (!*MoreConstrainedThanPrevious) 12367 continue; 12368 // FD is more constrained - replace Result with it. 12369 } 12370 IsResultAmbiguous = false; 12371 DAP = I.getPair(); 12372 Result = FD; 12373 } 12374 12375 if (IsResultAmbiguous) 12376 return nullptr; 12377 12378 if (Result) { 12379 SmallVector<const Expr *, 1> ResultAC; 12380 // We skipped over some ambiguous declarations which might be ambiguous with 12381 // the selected result. 12382 for (FunctionDecl *Skipped : AmbiguousDecls) 12383 if (!CheckMoreConstrained(Skipped, Result).hasValue()) 12384 return nullptr; 12385 Pair = DAP; 12386 } 12387 return Result; 12388 } 12389 12390 /// Given an overloaded function, tries to turn it into a non-overloaded 12391 /// function reference using resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate. This 12392 /// will perform access checks, diagnose the use of the resultant decl, and, if 12393 /// requested, potentially perform a function-to-pointer decay. 12394 /// 12395 /// Returns false if resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate fails. 12396 /// Otherwise, returns true. This may emit diagnostics and return true. 12397 bool Sema::resolveAndFixAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate( 12398 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool DoFunctionPointerConverion) { 12399 Expr *E = SrcExpr.get(); 12400 assert(E->getType() == Context.OverloadTy && "SrcExpr must be an overload"); 12401 12402 DeclAccessPair DAP; 12403 FunctionDecl *Found = resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(E, DAP); 12404 if (!Found || Found->isCPUDispatchMultiVersion() || 12405 Found->isCPUSpecificMultiVersion()) 12406 return false; 12407 12408 // Emitting multiple diagnostics for a function that is both inaccessible and 12409 // unavailable is consistent with our behavior elsewhere. So, always check 12410 // for both. 12411 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Found, E->getExprLoc()); 12412 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(E, DAP); 12413 Expr *Fixed = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, DAP, Found); 12414 if (DoFunctionPointerConverion && Fixed->getType()->isFunctionType()) 12415 SrcExpr = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Fixed, /*Diagnose=*/false); 12416 else 12417 SrcExpr = Fixed; 12418 return true; 12419 } 12420 12421 /// Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to 12422 /// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function. 12423 /// 12424 /// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function 12425 /// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template 12426 /// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults, 12427 /// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3. 12428 /// 12429 /// If no template-ids are found, no diagnostics are emitted and NULL is 12430 /// returned. 12431 FunctionDecl * 12432 Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl, 12433 bool Complain, 12434 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) { 12435 // C++ [over.over]p1: 12436 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the 12437 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ] 12438 // C++ [over.over]p1: 12439 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the & 12440 // operator. 12441 12442 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done. 12443 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) 12444 return nullptr; 12445 12446 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs; 12447 ovl->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs); 12448 TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates(ovl->getNameLoc()); 12449 12450 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one 12451 // whose type matches exactly. 12452 FunctionDecl *Matched = nullptr; 12453 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(), 12454 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 12455 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3: 12456 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts 12457 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is 12458 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments, 12459 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the 12460 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization. 12461 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate 12462 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()); 12463 12464 // C++ [over.over]p2: 12465 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is 12466 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the 12467 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single 12468 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of 12469 // overloaded functions considered. 12470 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 12471 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation()); 12472 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 12473 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs, 12474 Specialization, Info, 12475 /*IsAddressOfFunction*/true)) { 12476 // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics. 12477 // TODO: Actually use the failed-deduction info? 12478 FailedCandidates.addCandidate() 12479 .set(I.getPair(), FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(), 12480 MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info)); 12481 continue; 12482 } 12483 12484 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?"); 12485 12486 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration. 12487 if (Matched) { 12488 if (Complain) { 12489 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 12490 << ovl->getName(); 12491 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl); 12492 } 12493 return nullptr; 12494 } 12495 12496 Matched = Specialization; 12497 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair(); 12498 } 12499 12500 if (Matched && 12501 completeFunctionType(*this, Matched, ovl->getExprLoc(), Complain)) 12502 return nullptr; 12503 12504 return Matched; 12505 } 12506 12507 // Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved 12508 // because it identifies a single function template specialization. 12509 // 12510 // Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true 12511 // 12512 // Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the 12513 // expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded. Always 12514 // returns true if 'complain' is set. 12515 bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 12516 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion, 12517 bool complain, SourceRange OpRangeForComplaining, 12518 QualType DestTypeForComplaining, 12519 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) { 12520 assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 12521 12522 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get()); 12523 12524 DeclAccessPair found; 12525 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression; 12526 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 12527 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) { 12528 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getBeginLoc())) { 12529 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 12530 return true; 12531 } 12532 12533 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're 12534 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member. 12535 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which 12536 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this. 12537 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer && 12538 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) && 12539 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) { 12540 if (!complain) return false; 12541 12542 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(), 12543 diag::err_bound_member_function) 12544 << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange(); 12545 12546 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of 12547 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression 12548 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type). 12549 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why 12550 // the static candidates were rejected. 12551 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 12552 return true; 12553 } 12554 12555 // Fix the expression to refer to 'fn'. 12556 SingleFunctionExpression = 12557 FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.get(), found, fn); 12558 12559 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay. 12560 if (doFunctionPointerConverion) { 12561 SingleFunctionExpression = 12562 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.get()); 12563 if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) { 12564 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 12565 return true; 12566 } 12567 } 12568 } 12569 12570 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) { 12571 if (complain) { 12572 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining) 12573 << ovl.Expression->getName() 12574 << DestTypeForComplaining 12575 << OpRangeForComplaining 12576 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange(); 12577 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get()); 12578 12579 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 12580 return true; 12581 } 12582 12583 return false; 12584 } 12585 12586 SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression; 12587 return true; 12588 } 12589 12590 /// Add a single candidate to the overload set. 12591 static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S, 12592 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 12593 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 12594 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 12595 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 12596 bool PartialOverloading, 12597 bool KnownValid) { 12598 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 12599 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)) 12600 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl(); 12601 12602 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) { 12603 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) { 12604 assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?"); 12605 return; 12606 } 12607 // Prevent ill-formed function decls to be added as overload candidates. 12608 if (!dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Func->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>())) 12609 return; 12610 12611 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, 12612 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 12613 PartialOverloading); 12614 return; 12615 } 12616 12617 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate 12618 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) { 12619 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl, 12620 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet, 12621 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 12622 PartialOverloading); 12623 return; 12624 } 12625 12626 assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate"); 12627 } 12628 12629 /// Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument 12630 /// dependent lookup to the given overload set. 12631 void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 12632 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 12633 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 12634 bool PartialOverloading) { 12635 12636 #ifndef NDEBUG 12637 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules 12638 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 12639 // 12640 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1) 12641 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent 12642 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains 12643 // 12644 // -- a declaration of a class member, or 12645 // 12646 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a 12647 // using-declaration, or 12648 // 12649 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function 12650 // template 12651 // 12652 // then Y is empty. 12653 12654 if (ULE->requiresADL()) { 12655 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(), 12656 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 12657 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord()); 12658 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) || 12659 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()); 12660 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate()); 12661 } 12662 } 12663 #endif 12664 12665 // It would be nice to avoid this copy. 12666 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer; 12667 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr; 12668 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 12669 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer); 12670 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer; 12671 } 12672 12673 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(), 12674 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) 12675 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 12676 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading, 12677 /*KnownValid*/ true); 12678 12679 if (ULE->requiresADL()) 12680 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), ULE->getExprLoc(), 12681 Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs, 12682 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading); 12683 } 12684 12685 /// Add the call candidates from the given set of lookup results to the given 12686 /// overload set. Non-function lookup results are ignored. 12687 void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates( 12688 LookupResult &R, TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 12689 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 12690 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) 12691 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 12692 CandidateSet, false, /*KnownValid*/ false); 12693 } 12694 12695 /// Determine whether a declaration with the specified name could be moved into 12696 /// a different namespace. 12697 static bool canBeDeclaredInNamespace(const DeclarationName &Name) { 12698 switch (Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator()) { 12699 case OO_New: case OO_Array_New: 12700 case OO_Delete: case OO_Array_Delete: 12701 return false; 12702 12703 default: 12704 return true; 12705 } 12706 } 12707 12708 /// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a 12709 /// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template 12710 /// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not 12711 /// correctly implement two-stage name lookup. 12712 /// 12713 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued. 12714 static bool DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup( 12715 Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc, const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 12716 LookupResult &R, OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK, 12717 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 12718 CXXRecordDecl **FoundInClass = nullptr) { 12719 if (!SemaRef.inTemplateInstantiation() || !SS.isEmpty()) 12720 return false; 12721 12722 for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) { 12723 if (DC->isTransparentContext()) 12724 continue; 12725 12726 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC); 12727 12728 if (!R.empty()) { 12729 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 12730 12731 OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc, CSK); 12732 SemaRef.AddOverloadedCallCandidates(R, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 12733 Candidates); 12734 12735 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 12736 OverloadingResult OR = 12737 Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best); 12738 12739 if (auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) { 12740 // We either found non-function declarations or a best viable function 12741 // at class scope. A class-scope lookup result disables ADL. Don't 12742 // look past this, but let the caller know that we found something that 12743 // either is, or might be, usable in this class. 12744 if (FoundInClass) { 12745 *FoundInClass = RD; 12746 if (OR == OR_Success) { 12747 R.clear(); 12748 R.addDecl(Best->FoundDecl.getDecl(), Best->FoundDecl.getAccess()); 12749 R.resolveKind(); 12750 } 12751 } 12752 return false; 12753 } 12754 12755 if (OR != OR_Success) { 12756 // There wasn't a unique best function or function template. 12757 return false; 12758 } 12759 12760 // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest 12761 // declaring the function there instead. 12762 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces; 12763 Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses; 12764 SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(FnLoc, Args, 12765 AssociatedNamespaces, 12766 AssociatedClasses); 12767 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces; 12768 if (canBeDeclaredInNamespace(R.getLookupName())) { 12769 DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace(); 12770 for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator 12771 it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(), 12772 end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) { 12773 // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'. 12774 if (Std && Std->Encloses(*it)) 12775 continue; 12776 12777 // Never suggest declaring a function within a namespace with a 12778 // reserved name, like __gnu_cxx. 12779 NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(*it); 12780 if (NS && 12781 NS->getQualifiedNameAsString().find("__") != std::string::npos) 12782 continue; 12783 12784 SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it); 12785 } 12786 } 12787 12788 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 12789 << R.getLookupName(); 12790 if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) { 12791 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 12792 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 12793 << R.getLookupName() << 0; 12794 } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) { 12795 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 12796 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 12797 << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin(); 12798 } else { 12799 // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here, 12800 // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce 12801 // a localized representation of a list of items. 12802 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 12803 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 12804 << R.getLookupName() << 2; 12805 } 12806 12807 // Try to recover by calling this function. 12808 return true; 12809 } 12810 12811 R.clear(); 12812 } 12813 12814 return false; 12815 } 12816 12817 /// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a 12818 /// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template 12819 /// was defined. 12820 /// 12821 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued. 12822 static bool 12823 DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 12824 SourceLocation OpLoc, 12825 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 12826 DeclarationName OpName = 12827 SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 12828 LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName); 12829 return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R, 12830 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator, 12831 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/nullptr, Args); 12832 } 12833 12834 namespace { 12835 class BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII { 12836 Sema &SemaRef; 12837 public: 12838 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII(Sema &S) : SemaRef(S) { 12839 assert(SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr == false); 12840 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = true; 12841 } 12842 12843 ~BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII() { 12844 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = false; 12845 } 12846 }; 12847 12848 } 12849 12850 /// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found. 12851 /// 12852 /// This function will do one of three things: 12853 /// * Diagnose, recover, and return a recovery expression. 12854 /// * Diagnose, fail to recover, and return ExprError(). 12855 /// * Do not diagnose, do not recover, and return ExprResult(). The caller is 12856 /// expected to diagnose as appropriate. 12857 static ExprResult 12858 BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 12859 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 12860 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 12861 MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 12862 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 12863 bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) { 12864 // Do not try to recover if it is already building a recovery call. 12865 // This stops infinite loops for template instantiations like 12866 // 12867 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(t)) {} 12868 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(&t)) {} 12869 if (SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr) 12870 return ExprResult(); 12871 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII RCE(SemaRef); 12872 12873 CXXScopeSpec SS; 12874 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc()); 12875 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(); 12876 12877 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer; 12878 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr; 12879 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 12880 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer); 12881 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer; 12882 } 12883 12884 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(), 12885 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName); 12886 CXXRecordDecl *FoundInClass = nullptr; 12887 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R, 12888 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal, 12889 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, &FoundInClass)) { 12890 // OK, diagnosed a two-phase lookup issue. 12891 } else if (EmptyLookup) { 12892 // Try to recover from an empty lookup with typo correction. 12893 R.clear(); 12894 NoTypoCorrectionCCC NoTypoValidator{}; 12895 FunctionCallFilterCCC FunctionCallValidator(SemaRef, Args.size(), 12896 ExplicitTemplateArgs != nullptr, 12897 dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn)); 12898 CorrectionCandidateCallback &Validator = 12899 AllowTypoCorrection 12900 ? static_cast<CorrectionCandidateCallback &>(FunctionCallValidator) 12901 : static_cast<CorrectionCandidateCallback &>(NoTypoValidator); 12902 if (SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, Validator, ExplicitTemplateArgs, 12903 Args)) 12904 return ExprError(); 12905 } else if (FoundInClass && SemaRef.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) { 12906 // We found a usable declaration of the name in a dependent base of some 12907 // enclosing class. 12908 // FIXME: We should also explain why the candidates found by name lookup 12909 // were not viable. 12910 if (SemaRef.DiagnoseDependentMemberLookup(R)) 12911 return ExprError(); 12912 } else { 12913 // We had viable candidates and couldn't recover; let the caller diagnose 12914 // this. 12915 return ExprResult(); 12916 } 12917 12918 // If we get here, we should have issued a diagnostic and formed a recovery 12919 // lookup result. 12920 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery"); 12921 12922 // If recovery created an ambiguity, just bail out. 12923 if (R.isAmbiguous()) { 12924 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 12925 return ExprError(); 12926 } 12927 12928 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the 12929 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care. 12930 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError(); 12931 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) 12932 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, 12933 ExplicitTemplateArgs, S); 12934 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid()) 12935 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false, 12936 ExplicitTemplateArgs); 12937 else 12938 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false); 12939 12940 if (NewFn.isInvalid()) 12941 return ExprError(); 12942 12943 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it 12944 // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never 12945 // end up here. 12946 return SemaRef.BuildCallExpr(/*Scope*/ nullptr, NewFn.get(), LParenLoc, 12947 MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()), 12948 RParenLoc); 12949 } 12950 12951 /// Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from 12952 /// the given function. 12953 /// \returns true when an the ExprResult output parameter has been set. 12954 bool Sema::buildOverloadedCallSet(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 12955 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 12956 MultiExprArg Args, 12957 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 12958 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, 12959 ExprResult *Result) { 12960 #ifndef NDEBUG 12961 if (ULE->requiresADL()) { 12962 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name. 12963 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL"); 12964 12965 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins. 12966 // Verify that this was correctly set up. 12967 FunctionDecl *F; 12968 if (ULE->decls_begin() != ULE->decls_end() && 12969 ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() && 12970 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) && 12971 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit()) 12972 llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin"); 12973 12974 // We don't perform ADL in C. 12975 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C"); 12976 } 12977 #endif 12978 12979 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 12980 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) { 12981 *Result = ExprError(); 12982 return true; 12983 } 12984 12985 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate 12986 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup. 12987 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, *CandidateSet); 12988 12989 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && 12990 CurContext->isDependentContext() && !isSFINAEContext() && 12991 (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) { 12992 12993 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 12994 if (CandidateSet->empty() || 12995 CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best) == 12996 OR_No_Viable_Function) { 12997 // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function 12998 // then create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name 12999 // lookup to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent 13000 // base classes. 13001 CallExpr *CE = 13002 CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, Args, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, 13003 RParenLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 13004 CE->markDependentForPostponedNameLookup(); 13005 *Result = CE; 13006 return true; 13007 } 13008 } 13009 13010 if (CandidateSet->empty()) 13011 return false; 13012 13013 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 13014 return false; 13015 } 13016 13017 // Guess at what the return type for an unresolvable overload should be. 13018 static QualType chooseRecoveryType(OverloadCandidateSet &CS, 13019 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best) { 13020 llvm::Optional<QualType> Result; 13021 // Adjust Type after seeing a candidate. 13022 auto ConsiderCandidate = [&](const OverloadCandidate &Candidate) { 13023 if (!Candidate.Function) 13024 return; 13025 if (Candidate.Function->isInvalidDecl()) 13026 return; 13027 QualType T = Candidate.Function->getReturnType(); 13028 if (T.isNull()) 13029 return; 13030 if (!Result) 13031 Result = T; 13032 else if (Result != T) 13033 Result = QualType(); 13034 }; 13035 13036 // Look for an unambiguous type from a progressively larger subset. 13037 // e.g. if types disagree, but all *viable* overloads return int, choose int. 13038 // 13039 // First, consider only the best candidate. 13040 if (Best && *Best != CS.end()) 13041 ConsiderCandidate(**Best); 13042 // Next, consider only viable candidates. 13043 if (!Result) 13044 for (const auto &C : CS) 13045 if (C.Viable) 13046 ConsiderCandidate(C); 13047 // Finally, consider all candidates. 13048 if (!Result) 13049 for (const auto &C : CS) 13050 ConsiderCandidate(C); 13051 13052 if (!Result) 13053 return QualType(); 13054 auto Value = Result.getValue(); 13055 if (Value.isNull() || Value->isUndeducedType()) 13056 return QualType(); 13057 return Value; 13058 } 13059 13060 /// FinishOverloadedCallExpr - given an OverloadCandidateSet, builds and returns 13061 /// the completed call expression. If overload resolution fails, emits 13062 /// diagnostics and returns ExprError() 13063 static ExprResult FinishOverloadedCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 13064 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 13065 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 13066 MultiExprArg Args, 13067 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 13068 Expr *ExecConfig, 13069 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, 13070 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best, 13071 OverloadingResult OverloadResult, 13072 bool AllowTypoCorrection) { 13073 switch (OverloadResult) { 13074 case OR_Success: { 13075 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function; 13076 SemaRef.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, (*Best)->FoundDecl); 13077 if (SemaRef.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc())) 13078 return ExprError(); 13079 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl); 13080 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc, 13081 ExecConfig, /*IsExecConfig=*/false, 13082 (*Best)->IsADLCandidate); 13083 } 13084 13085 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 13086 // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might 13087 // have meant to call. 13088 ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, 13089 Args, RParenLoc, 13090 CandidateSet->empty(), 13091 AllowTypoCorrection); 13092 if (Recovery.isInvalid() || Recovery.isUsable()) 13093 return Recovery; 13094 13095 // If the user passes in a function that we can't take the address of, we 13096 // generally end up emitting really bad error messages. Here, we attempt to 13097 // emit better ones. 13098 for (const Expr *Arg : Args) { 13099 if (!Arg->getType()->isFunctionType()) 13100 continue; 13101 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Arg->IgnoreParenImpCasts())) { 13102 auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 13103 if (FD && 13104 !SemaRef.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, /*Complain=*/true, 13105 Arg->getExprLoc())) 13106 return ExprError(); 13107 } 13108 } 13109 13110 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates( 13111 PartialDiagnosticAt( 13112 Fn->getBeginLoc(), 13113 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 13114 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()), 13115 SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 13116 break; 13117 } 13118 13119 case OR_Ambiguous: 13120 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates( 13121 PartialDiagnosticAt(Fn->getBeginLoc(), 13122 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) 13123 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()), 13124 SemaRef, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args); 13125 break; 13126 13127 case OR_Deleted: { 13128 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates( 13129 PartialDiagnosticAt(Fn->getBeginLoc(), 13130 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_call) 13131 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()), 13132 SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 13133 13134 // We emitted an error for the unavailable/deleted function call but keep 13135 // the call in the AST. 13136 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function; 13137 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl); 13138 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc, 13139 ExecConfig, /*IsExecConfig=*/false, 13140 (*Best)->IsADLCandidate); 13141 } 13142 } 13143 13144 // Overload resolution failed, try to recover. 13145 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> SubExprs = {Fn}; 13146 SubExprs.append(Args.begin(), Args.end()); 13147 return SemaRef.CreateRecoveryExpr(Fn->getBeginLoc(), RParenLoc, SubExprs, 13148 chooseRecoveryType(*CandidateSet, Best)); 13149 } 13150 13151 static void markUnaddressableCandidatesUnviable(Sema &S, 13152 OverloadCandidateSet &CS) { 13153 for (auto I = CS.begin(), E = CS.end(); I != E; ++I) { 13154 if (I->Viable && 13155 !S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(I->Function, /*Complain=*/false)) { 13156 I->Viable = false; 13157 I->FailureKind = ovl_fail_addr_not_available; 13158 } 13159 } 13160 } 13161 13162 /// BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn 13163 /// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call 13164 /// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down 13165 /// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns 13166 /// the call expression produced by overload resolution. 13167 /// Otherwise, emits diagnostics and returns ExprError. 13168 ExprResult Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 13169 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 13170 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 13171 MultiExprArg Args, 13172 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 13173 Expr *ExecConfig, 13174 bool AllowTypoCorrection, 13175 bool CalleesAddressIsTaken) { 13176 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc(), 13177 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 13178 ExprResult result; 13179 13180 if (buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, ULE, Args, LParenLoc, &CandidateSet, 13181 &result)) 13182 return result; 13183 13184 // If the user handed us something like `(&Foo)(Bar)`, we need to ensure that 13185 // functions that aren't addressible are considered unviable. 13186 if (CalleesAddressIsTaken) 13187 markUnaddressableCandidatesUnviable(*this, CandidateSet); 13188 13189 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 13190 OverloadingResult OverloadResult = 13191 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best); 13192 13193 return FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc, 13194 ExecConfig, &CandidateSet, &Best, 13195 OverloadResult, AllowTypoCorrection); 13196 } 13197 13198 static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) { 13199 return Functions.size() > 1 || 13200 (Functions.size() == 1 && 13201 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*Functions.begin())->getUnderlyingDecl())); 13202 } 13203 13204 ExprResult Sema::CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass, 13205 NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNSLoc, 13206 DeclarationNameInfo DNI, 13207 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 13208 bool PerformADL) { 13209 return UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass, NNSLoc, DNI, 13210 PerformADL, IsOverloaded(Fns), 13211 Fns.begin(), Fns.end()); 13212 } 13213 13214 /// Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded 13215 /// operator. 13216 /// 13217 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*'). 13218 /// 13219 /// \param Opc The UnaryOperatorKind that describes this operator. 13220 /// 13221 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be 13222 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this 13223 /// set based on the context using, e.g., 13224 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This 13225 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added 13226 /// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(). 13227 /// 13228 /// \param Input The input argument. 13229 ExprResult 13230 Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, UnaryOperatorKind Opc, 13231 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 13232 Expr *Input, bool PerformADL) { 13233 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 13234 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator"); 13235 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 13236 // TODO: provide better source location info. 13237 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc); 13238 13239 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input)) 13240 return ExprError(); 13241 13242 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, nullptr }; 13243 unsigned NumArgs = 1; 13244 13245 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as 13246 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or 13247 // post-decrement. 13248 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) { 13249 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false); 13250 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, 13251 SourceLocation()); 13252 NumArgs = 2; 13253 } 13254 13255 ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, NumArgs); 13256 13257 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) { 13258 if (Fns.empty()) 13259 return UnaryOperator::Create(Context, Input, Opc, Context.DependentTy, 13260 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, OpLoc, false, 13261 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 13262 13263 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators 13264 ExprResult Fn = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr( 13265 NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, Fns); 13266 if (Fn.isInvalid()) 13267 return ExprError(); 13268 return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, Op, Fn.get(), ArgsArray, 13269 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OpLoc, 13270 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 13271 } 13272 13273 // Build an empty overload set. 13274 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 13275 13276 // Add the candidates from the given function set. 13277 AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(Fns, ArgsArray, CandidateSet); 13278 13279 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 13280 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet); 13281 13282 // Add candidates from ADL. 13283 if (PerformADL) { 13284 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, ArgsArray, 13285 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/nullptr, 13286 CandidateSet); 13287 } 13288 13289 // Add builtin operator candidates. 13290 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet); 13291 13292 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 13293 13294 // Perform overload resolution. 13295 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 13296 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 13297 case OR_Success: { 13298 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 13299 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 13300 13301 if (FnDecl) { 13302 Expr *Base = nullptr; 13303 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 13304 // operator. 13305 13306 // Convert the arguments. 13307 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 13308 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], nullptr, Best->FoundDecl); 13309 13310 ExprResult InputRes = 13311 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 13312 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 13313 if (InputRes.isInvalid()) 13314 return ExprError(); 13315 Base = Input = InputRes.get(); 13316 } else { 13317 // Convert the arguments. 13318 ExprResult InputInit 13319 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 13320 Context, 13321 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 13322 SourceLocation(), 13323 Input); 13324 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 13325 return ExprError(); 13326 Input = InputInit.get(); 13327 } 13328 13329 // Build the actual expression node. 13330 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, Best->FoundDecl, 13331 Base, HadMultipleCandidates, 13332 OpLoc); 13333 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 13334 return ExprError(); 13335 13336 // Determine the result type. 13337 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType(); 13338 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 13339 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 13340 13341 Args[0] = Input; 13342 CallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create( 13343 Context, Op, FnExpr.get(), ArgsArray, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, 13344 CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Best->IsADLCandidate); 13345 13346 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, FnDecl)) 13347 return ExprError(); 13348 13349 if (CheckFunctionCall(FnDecl, TheCall, 13350 FnDecl->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>())) 13351 return ExprError(); 13352 return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall), FnDecl); 13353 } else { 13354 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 13355 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 13356 // operator node. 13357 ExprResult InputRes = PerformImplicitConversion( 13358 Input, Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing, 13359 CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp); 13360 if (InputRes.isInvalid()) 13361 return ExprError(); 13362 Input = InputRes.get(); 13363 break; 13364 } 13365 } 13366 13367 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 13368 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by 13369 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were 13370 // defined too late to be candidates. 13371 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray)) 13372 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function. 13373 return ExprError(); 13374 13375 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a 13376 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us. 13377 break; 13378 13379 case OR_Ambiguous: 13380 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13381 PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, 13382 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary) 13383 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13384 << Input->getType() << Input->getSourceRange()), 13385 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, ArgsArray, 13386 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 13387 return ExprError(); 13388 13389 case OR_Deleted: 13390 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13391 PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 13392 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13393 << Input->getSourceRange()), 13394 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, ArgsArray, UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), 13395 OpLoc); 13396 return ExprError(); 13397 } 13398 13399 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a 13400 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to 13401 // build a built-in operation. 13402 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 13403 } 13404 13405 /// Perform lookup for an overloaded binary operator. 13406 void Sema::LookupOverloadedBinOp(OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 13407 OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 13408 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 13409 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, bool PerformADL) { 13410 SourceLocation OpLoc = CandidateSet.getLocation(); 13411 13412 OverloadedOperatorKind ExtraOp = 13413 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().AllowRewrittenCandidates 13414 ? getRewrittenOverloadedOperator(Op) 13415 : OO_None; 13416 13417 // Add the candidates from the given function set. This also adds the 13418 // rewritten candidates using these functions if necessary. 13419 AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet); 13420 13421 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 13422 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 13423 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Op)) 13424 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, {Args[1], Args[0]}, CandidateSet, 13425 OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 13426 13427 // In C++20, also add any rewritten member candidates. 13428 if (ExtraOp) { 13429 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(ExtraOp, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 13430 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(ExtraOp)) 13431 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(ExtraOp, OpLoc, {Args[1], Args[0]}, 13432 CandidateSet, 13433 OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 13434 } 13435 13436 // Add candidates from ADL. Per [over.match.oper]p2, this lookup is not 13437 // performed for an assignment operator (nor for operator[] nor operator->, 13438 // which don't get here). 13439 if (Op != OO_Equal && PerformADL) { 13440 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 13441 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, Args, 13442 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr, 13443 CandidateSet); 13444 if (ExtraOp) { 13445 DeclarationName ExtraOpName = 13446 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(ExtraOp); 13447 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ExtraOpName, OpLoc, Args, 13448 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr, 13449 CandidateSet); 13450 } 13451 } 13452 13453 // Add builtin operator candidates. 13454 // 13455 // FIXME: We don't add any rewritten candidates here. This is strictly 13456 // incorrect; a builtin candidate could be hidden by a non-viable candidate, 13457 // resulting in our selecting a rewritten builtin candidate. For example: 13458 // 13459 // enum class E { e }; 13460 // bool operator!=(E, E) requires false; 13461 // bool k = E::e != E::e; 13462 // 13463 // ... should select the rewritten builtin candidate 'operator==(E, E)'. But 13464 // it seems unreasonable to consider rewritten builtin candidates. A core 13465 // issue has been filed proposing to removed this requirement. 13466 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 13467 } 13468 13469 /// Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded 13470 /// operator. 13471 /// 13472 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+'). 13473 /// 13474 /// \param Opc The BinaryOperatorKind that describes this operator. 13475 /// 13476 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be 13477 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this 13478 /// set based on the context using, e.g., 13479 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This 13480 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added 13481 /// by CreateOverloadedBinOp(). 13482 /// 13483 /// \param LHS Left-hand argument. 13484 /// \param RHS Right-hand argument. 13485 /// \param PerformADL Whether to consider operator candidates found by ADL. 13486 /// \param AllowRewrittenCandidates Whether to consider candidates found by 13487 /// C++20 operator rewrites. 13488 /// \param DefaultedFn If we are synthesizing a defaulted operator function, 13489 /// the function in question. Such a function is never a candidate in 13490 /// our overload resolution. This also enables synthesizing a three-way 13491 /// comparison from < and == as described in C++20 [class.spaceship]p1. 13492 ExprResult Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, 13493 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 13494 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, Expr *LHS, 13495 Expr *RHS, bool PerformADL, 13496 bool AllowRewrittenCandidates, 13497 FunctionDecl *DefaultedFn) { 13498 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS }; 13499 LHS=RHS=nullptr; // Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple 13500 13501 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20) 13502 AllowRewrittenCandidates = false; 13503 13504 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 13505 13506 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent 13507 // expression. 13508 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) { 13509 if (Fns.empty()) { 13510 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent 13511 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment. 13512 if (BinaryOperator::isCompoundAssignmentOp(Opc)) 13513 return CompoundAssignOperator::Create( 13514 Context, Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_LValue, 13515 OK_Ordinary, OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Context.DependentTy, 13516 Context.DependentTy); 13517 return BinaryOperator::Create(Context, Args[0], Args[1], Opc, 13518 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 13519 OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 13520 } 13521 13522 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here? 13523 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators 13524 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component. 13525 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 13526 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc); 13527 ExprResult Fn = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr( 13528 NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, Fns, PerformADL); 13529 if (Fn.isInvalid()) 13530 return ExprError(); 13531 return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, Op, Fn.get(), Args, 13532 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OpLoc, 13533 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 13534 } 13535 13536 // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS. 13537 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1])) 13538 return ExprError(); 13539 13540 // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should 13541 // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS. 13542 assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty); 13543 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0])) 13544 return ExprError(); 13545 13546 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution 13547 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually 13548 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the 13549 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to 13550 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does. 13551 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms. 13552 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 13553 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 13554 13555 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just 13556 // create a built-in binary operator. 13557 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD) 13558 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 13559 13560 // Build the overload set. 13561 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet( 13562 OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator, 13563 OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo(Op, AllowRewrittenCandidates)); 13564 if (DefaultedFn) 13565 CandidateSet.exclude(DefaultedFn); 13566 LookupOverloadedBinOp(CandidateSet, Op, Fns, Args, PerformADL); 13567 13568 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 13569 13570 // Perform overload resolution. 13571 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 13572 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 13573 case OR_Success: { 13574 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 13575 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 13576 13577 bool IsReversed = Best->isReversed(); 13578 if (IsReversed) 13579 std::swap(Args[0], Args[1]); 13580 13581 if (FnDecl) { 13582 Expr *Base = nullptr; 13583 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 13584 // operator. 13585 13586 OverloadedOperatorKind ChosenOp = 13587 FnDecl->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator(); 13588 13589 // C++2a [over.match.oper]p9: 13590 // If a rewritten operator== candidate is selected by overload 13591 // resolution for an operator@, its return type shall be cv bool 13592 if (Best->RewriteKind && ChosenOp == OO_EqualEqual && 13593 !FnDecl->getReturnType()->isBooleanType()) { 13594 bool IsExtension = 13595 FnDecl->getReturnType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType(); 13596 Diag(OpLoc, IsExtension ? diag::ext_ovl_rewrite_equalequal_not_bool 13597 : diag::err_ovl_rewrite_equalequal_not_bool) 13598 << FnDecl->getReturnType() << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13599 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 13600 Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 13601 if (!IsExtension) 13602 return ExprError(); 13603 } 13604 13605 if (AllowRewrittenCandidates && !IsReversed && 13606 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().isReversible()) { 13607 // We could have reversed this operator, but didn't. Check if some 13608 // reversed form was a viable candidate, and if so, if it had a 13609 // better conversion for either parameter. If so, this call is 13610 // formally ambiguous, and allowing it is an extension. 13611 llvm::SmallVector<FunctionDecl*, 4> AmbiguousWith; 13612 for (OverloadCandidate &Cand : CandidateSet) { 13613 if (Cand.Viable && Cand.Function && Cand.isReversed() && 13614 haveSameParameterTypes(Context, Cand.Function, FnDecl, 2)) { 13615 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) { 13616 if (CompareImplicitConversionSequences( 13617 *this, OpLoc, Cand.Conversions[ArgIdx], 13618 Best->Conversions[ArgIdx]) == 13619 ImplicitConversionSequence::Better) { 13620 AmbiguousWith.push_back(Cand.Function); 13621 break; 13622 } 13623 } 13624 } 13625 } 13626 13627 if (!AmbiguousWith.empty()) { 13628 bool AmbiguousWithSelf = 13629 AmbiguousWith.size() == 1 && 13630 declaresSameEntity(AmbiguousWith.front(), FnDecl); 13631 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed) 13632 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13633 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType() << AmbiguousWithSelf 13634 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 13635 if (AmbiguousWithSelf) { 13636 Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(), 13637 diag::note_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed_self); 13638 } else { 13639 Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(), 13640 diag::note_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_selected_candidate); 13641 for (auto *F : AmbiguousWith) 13642 Diag(F->getLocation(), 13643 diag::note_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed_candidate); 13644 } 13645 } 13646 } 13647 13648 // Convert the arguments. 13649 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 13650 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members. 13651 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl); 13652 13653 ExprResult Arg1 = 13654 PerformCopyInitialization( 13655 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 13656 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 13657 SourceLocation(), Args[1]); 13658 if (Arg1.isInvalid()) 13659 return ExprError(); 13660 13661 ExprResult Arg0 = 13662 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 13663 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 13664 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 13665 return ExprError(); 13666 Base = Args[0] = Arg0.getAs<Expr>(); 13667 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>(); 13668 } else { 13669 // Convert the arguments. 13670 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization( 13671 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 13672 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 13673 SourceLocation(), Args[0]); 13674 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 13675 return ExprError(); 13676 13677 ExprResult Arg1 = 13678 PerformCopyInitialization( 13679 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 13680 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)), 13681 SourceLocation(), Args[1]); 13682 if (Arg1.isInvalid()) 13683 return ExprError(); 13684 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.getAs<Expr>(); 13685 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>(); 13686 } 13687 13688 // Build the actual expression node. 13689 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, 13690 Best->FoundDecl, Base, 13691 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc); 13692 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 13693 return ExprError(); 13694 13695 // Determine the result type. 13696 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType(); 13697 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 13698 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 13699 13700 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create( 13701 Context, ChosenOp, FnExpr.get(), Args, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, 13702 CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Best->IsADLCandidate); 13703 13704 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, 13705 FnDecl)) 13706 return ExprError(); 13707 13708 ArrayRef<const Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, 2); 13709 const Expr *ImplicitThis = nullptr; 13710 // Cut off the implicit 'this'. 13711 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 13712 ImplicitThis = ArgsArray[0]; 13713 ArgsArray = ArgsArray.slice(1); 13714 } 13715 13716 // Check for a self move. 13717 if (Op == OO_Equal) 13718 DiagnoseSelfMove(Args[0], Args[1], OpLoc); 13719 13720 if (ImplicitThis) { 13721 QualType ThisType = Context.getPointerType(ImplicitThis->getType()); 13722 QualType ThisTypeFromDecl = Context.getPointerType( 13723 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)->getThisObjectType()); 13724 13725 CheckArgAlignment(OpLoc, FnDecl, "'this'", ThisType, 13726 ThisTypeFromDecl); 13727 } 13728 13729 checkCall(FnDecl, nullptr, ImplicitThis, ArgsArray, 13730 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl), OpLoc, TheCall->getSourceRange(), 13731 VariadicDoesNotApply); 13732 13733 ExprResult R = MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 13734 if (R.isInvalid()) 13735 return ExprError(); 13736 13737 R = CheckForImmediateInvocation(R, FnDecl); 13738 if (R.isInvalid()) 13739 return ExprError(); 13740 13741 // For a rewritten candidate, we've already reversed the arguments 13742 // if needed. Perform the rest of the rewrite now. 13743 if ((Best->RewriteKind & CRK_DifferentOperator) || 13744 (Op == OO_Spaceship && IsReversed)) { 13745 if (Op == OO_ExclaimEqual) { 13746 assert(ChosenOp == OO_EqualEqual && "unexpected operator name"); 13747 R = CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, UO_LNot, R.get()); 13748 } else { 13749 assert(ChosenOp == OO_Spaceship && "unexpected operator name"); 13750 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false); 13751 Expr *ZeroLiteral = 13752 IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, OpLoc); 13753 13754 Sema::CodeSynthesisContext Ctx; 13755 Ctx.Kind = Sema::CodeSynthesisContext::RewritingOperatorAsSpaceship; 13756 Ctx.Entity = FnDecl; 13757 pushCodeSynthesisContext(Ctx); 13758 13759 R = CreateOverloadedBinOp( 13760 OpLoc, Opc, Fns, IsReversed ? ZeroLiteral : R.get(), 13761 IsReversed ? R.get() : ZeroLiteral, PerformADL, 13762 /*AllowRewrittenCandidates=*/false); 13763 13764 popCodeSynthesisContext(); 13765 } 13766 if (R.isInvalid()) 13767 return ExprError(); 13768 } else { 13769 assert(ChosenOp == Op && "unexpected operator name"); 13770 } 13771 13772 // Make a note in the AST if we did any rewriting. 13773 if (Best->RewriteKind != CRK_None) 13774 R = new (Context) CXXRewrittenBinaryOperator(R.get(), IsReversed); 13775 13776 return R; 13777 } else { 13778 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 13779 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 13780 // operator node. 13781 ExprResult ArgsRes0 = PerformImplicitConversion( 13782 Args[0], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0], 13783 AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp); 13784 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid()) 13785 return ExprError(); 13786 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get(); 13787 13788 ExprResult ArgsRes1 = PerformImplicitConversion( 13789 Args[1], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[1], Best->Conversions[1], 13790 AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp); 13791 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid()) 13792 return ExprError(); 13793 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get(); 13794 break; 13795 } 13796 } 13797 13798 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 13799 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9: 13800 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no 13801 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the 13802 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5. 13803 if (Opc == BO_Comma) 13804 break; 13805 13806 // When defaulting an 'operator<=>', we can try to synthesize a three-way 13807 // compare result using '==' and '<'. 13808 if (DefaultedFn && Opc == BO_Cmp) { 13809 ExprResult E = BuildSynthesizedThreeWayComparison(OpLoc, Fns, Args[0], 13810 Args[1], DefaultedFn); 13811 if (E.isInvalid() || E.isUsable()) 13812 return E; 13813 } 13814 13815 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assignment 13816 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that 13817 // no overloaded assignment operator found 13818 ExprResult Result = ExprError(); 13819 StringRef OpcStr = BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc); 13820 auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, 13821 Args, OpLoc); 13822 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() && 13823 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) { 13824 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper) 13825 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13826 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 13827 if (Args[0]->getType()->isIncompleteType()) { 13828 Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_assign_lhs_incomplete) 13829 << Args[0]->getType() 13830 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 13831 } 13832 } else { 13833 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by 13834 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were 13835 // defined too late to be candidates. 13836 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args)) 13837 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function. 13838 return ExprError(); 13839 13840 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will 13841 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates. 13842 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 13843 } 13844 assert(Result.isInvalid() && 13845 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!"); 13846 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, Args, Cands, OpcStr, OpLoc); 13847 return Result; 13848 } 13849 13850 case OR_Ambiguous: 13851 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13852 PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary) 13853 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13854 << Args[0]->getType() 13855 << Args[1]->getType() 13856 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() 13857 << Args[1]->getSourceRange()), 13858 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args, BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), 13859 OpLoc); 13860 return ExprError(); 13861 13862 case OR_Deleted: 13863 if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) { 13864 FunctionDecl *DeletedFD = Best->Function; 13865 DefaultedFunctionKind DFK = getDefaultedFunctionKind(DeletedFD); 13866 if (DFK.isSpecialMember()) { 13867 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper) 13868 << Args[0]->getType() << DFK.asSpecialMember(); 13869 } else { 13870 assert(DFK.isComparison()); 13871 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_comparison) 13872 << Args[0]->getType() << DeletedFD; 13873 } 13874 13875 // The user probably meant to call this special member. Just 13876 // explain why it's deleted. 13877 NoteDeletedFunction(DeletedFD); 13878 return ExprError(); 13879 } 13880 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13881 PartialDiagnosticAt( 13882 OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 13883 << getOperatorSpelling(Best->Function->getDeclName() 13884 .getCXXOverloadedOperator()) 13885 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() 13886 << Args[1]->getSourceRange()), 13887 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), 13888 OpLoc); 13889 return ExprError(); 13890 } 13891 13892 // We matched a built-in operator; build it. 13893 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 13894 } 13895 13896 ExprResult Sema::BuildSynthesizedThreeWayComparison( 13897 SourceLocation OpLoc, const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS, 13898 FunctionDecl *DefaultedFn) { 13899 const ComparisonCategoryInfo *Info = 13900 Context.CompCategories.lookupInfoForType(DefaultedFn->getReturnType()); 13901 // If we're not producing a known comparison category type, we can't 13902 // synthesize a three-way comparison. Let the caller diagnose this. 13903 if (!Info) 13904 return ExprResult((Expr*)nullptr); 13905 13906 // If we ever want to perform this synthesis more generally, we will need to 13907 // apply the temporary materialization conversion to the operands. 13908 assert(LHS->isGLValue() && RHS->isGLValue() && 13909 "cannot use prvalue expressions more than once"); 13910 Expr *OrigLHS = LHS; 13911 Expr *OrigRHS = RHS; 13912 13913 // Replace the LHS and RHS with OpaqueValueExprs; we're going to refer to 13914 // each of them multiple times below. 13915 LHS = new (Context) 13916 OpaqueValueExpr(LHS->getExprLoc(), LHS->getType(), LHS->getValueKind(), 13917 LHS->getObjectKind(), LHS); 13918 RHS = new (Context) 13919 OpaqueValueExpr(RHS->getExprLoc(), RHS->getType(), RHS->getValueKind(), 13920 RHS->getObjectKind(), RHS); 13921 13922 ExprResult Eq = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_EQ, Fns, LHS, RHS, true, true, 13923 DefaultedFn); 13924 if (Eq.isInvalid()) 13925 return ExprError(); 13926 13927 ExprResult Less = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_LT, Fns, LHS, RHS, true, 13928 true, DefaultedFn); 13929 if (Less.isInvalid()) 13930 return ExprError(); 13931 13932 ExprResult Greater; 13933 if (Info->isPartial()) { 13934 Greater = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_LT, Fns, RHS, LHS, true, true, 13935 DefaultedFn); 13936 if (Greater.isInvalid()) 13937 return ExprError(); 13938 } 13939 13940 // Form the list of comparisons we're going to perform. 13941 struct Comparison { 13942 ExprResult Cmp; 13943 ComparisonCategoryResult Result; 13944 } Comparisons[4] = 13945 { {Eq, Info->isStrong() ? ComparisonCategoryResult::Equal 13946 : ComparisonCategoryResult::Equivalent}, 13947 {Less, ComparisonCategoryResult::Less}, 13948 {Greater, ComparisonCategoryResult::Greater}, 13949 {ExprResult(), ComparisonCategoryResult::Unordered}, 13950 }; 13951 13952 int I = Info->isPartial() ? 3 : 2; 13953 13954 // Combine the comparisons with suitable conditional expressions. 13955 ExprResult Result; 13956 for (; I >= 0; --I) { 13957 // Build a reference to the comparison category constant. 13958 auto *VI = Info->lookupValueInfo(Comparisons[I].Result); 13959 // FIXME: Missing a constant for a comparison category. Diagnose this? 13960 if (!VI) 13961 return ExprResult((Expr*)nullptr); 13962 ExprResult ThisResult = 13963 BuildDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec(), DeclarationNameInfo(), VI->VD); 13964 if (ThisResult.isInvalid()) 13965 return ExprError(); 13966 13967 // Build a conditional unless this is the final case. 13968 if (Result.get()) { 13969 Result = ActOnConditionalOp(OpLoc, OpLoc, Comparisons[I].Cmp.get(), 13970 ThisResult.get(), Result.get()); 13971 if (Result.isInvalid()) 13972 return ExprError(); 13973 } else { 13974 Result = ThisResult; 13975 } 13976 } 13977 13978 // Build a PseudoObjectExpr to model the rewriting of an <=> operator, and to 13979 // bind the OpaqueValueExprs before they're (repeatedly) used. 13980 Expr *SyntacticForm = BinaryOperator::Create( 13981 Context, OrigLHS, OrigRHS, BO_Cmp, Result.get()->getType(), 13982 Result.get()->getValueKind(), Result.get()->getObjectKind(), OpLoc, 13983 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 13984 Expr *SemanticForm[] = {LHS, RHS, Result.get()}; 13985 return PseudoObjectExpr::Create(Context, SyntacticForm, SemanticForm, 2); 13986 } 13987 13988 ExprResult 13989 Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc, 13990 SourceLocation RLoc, 13991 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) { 13992 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx }; 13993 DeclarationName OpName = 13994 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript); 13995 13996 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent 13997 // expression. 13998 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) { 13999 14000 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators 14001 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword? 14002 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc); 14003 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc)); 14004 ExprResult Fn = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr( 14005 NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, UnresolvedSet<0>()); 14006 if (Fn.isInvalid()) 14007 return ExprError(); 14008 // Can't add any actual overloads yet 14009 14010 return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn.get(), Args, 14011 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RLoc, 14012 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14013 } 14014 14015 // Handle placeholders on both operands. 14016 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0])) 14017 return ExprError(); 14018 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1])) 14019 return ExprError(); 14020 14021 // Build an empty overload set. 14022 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 14023 14024 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function. 14025 14026 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 14027 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 14028 14029 // Add builtin operator candidates. 14030 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 14031 14032 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 14033 14034 // Perform overload resolution. 14035 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14036 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) { 14037 case OR_Success: { 14038 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 14039 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 14040 14041 if (FnDecl) { 14042 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 14043 // operator. 14044 14045 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl); 14046 14047 // Convert the arguments. 14048 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl); 14049 ExprResult Arg0 = 14050 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 14051 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 14052 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 14053 return ExprError(); 14054 Args[0] = Arg0.get(); 14055 14056 // Convert the arguments. 14057 ExprResult InputInit 14058 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 14059 Context, 14060 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 14061 SourceLocation(), 14062 Args[1]); 14063 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 14064 return ExprError(); 14065 14066 Args[1] = InputInit.getAs<Expr>(); 14067 14068 // Build the actual expression node. 14069 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc); 14070 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc)); 14071 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, 14072 Best->FoundDecl, 14073 Base, 14074 HadMultipleCandidates, 14075 OpLocInfo.getLoc(), 14076 OpLocInfo.getInfo()); 14077 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 14078 return ExprError(); 14079 14080 // Determine the result type 14081 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType(); 14082 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 14083 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 14084 14085 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create( 14086 Context, OO_Subscript, FnExpr.get(), Args, ResultTy, VK, RLoc, 14087 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14088 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), LLoc, TheCall, FnDecl)) 14089 return ExprError(); 14090 14091 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, 14092 Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>())) 14093 return ExprError(); 14094 14095 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 14096 } else { 14097 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 14098 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 14099 // operator node. 14100 ExprResult ArgsRes0 = PerformImplicitConversion( 14101 Args[0], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0], 14102 AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp); 14103 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid()) 14104 return ExprError(); 14105 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get(); 14106 14107 ExprResult ArgsRes1 = PerformImplicitConversion( 14108 Args[1], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[1], Best->Conversions[1], 14109 AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp); 14110 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid()) 14111 return ExprError(); 14112 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get(); 14113 14114 break; 14115 } 14116 } 14117 14118 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 14119 PartialDiagnostic PD = CandidateSet.empty() 14120 ? (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_oper) 14121 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0 14122 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange()) 14123 : (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript) 14124 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[0]->getSourceRange() 14125 << Args[1]->getSourceRange()); 14126 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PD), *this, 14127 OCD_AllCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc); 14128 return ExprError(); 14129 } 14130 14131 case OR_Ambiguous: 14132 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14133 PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary) 14134 << "[]" << Args[0]->getType() 14135 << Args[1]->getType() 14136 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() 14137 << Args[1]->getSourceRange()), 14138 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc); 14139 return ExprError(); 14140 14141 case OR_Deleted: 14142 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14143 PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 14144 << "[]" << Args[0]->getSourceRange() 14145 << Args[1]->getSourceRange()), 14146 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc); 14147 return ExprError(); 14148 } 14149 14150 // We matched a built-in operator; build it. 14151 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc); 14152 } 14153 14154 /// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member 14155 /// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member 14156 /// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the 14157 /// arguments to the function call (not including the object 14158 /// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member 14159 /// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded 14160 /// member function. 14161 ExprResult Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE, 14162 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 14163 MultiExprArg Args, 14164 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 14165 bool AllowRecovery) { 14166 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy || 14167 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 14168 14169 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object 14170 // argument and the member function we're referring to. 14171 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens(); 14172 14173 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function. 14174 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) { 14175 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy); 14176 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI); 14177 14178 QualType fnType = 14179 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 14180 14181 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 14182 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context); 14183 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getReturnType()); 14184 14185 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the 14186 // member function we're calling. 14187 Qualifiers funcQuals = proto->getMethodQuals(); 14188 14189 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType(); 14190 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) 14191 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 14192 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers(); 14193 14194 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals; 14195 difference.removeObjCGCAttr(); 14196 difference.removeAddressSpace(); 14197 if (difference) { 14198 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString(); 14199 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals) 14200 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType() 14201 << qualsString 14202 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2); 14203 } 14204 14205 CXXMemberCallExpr *call = CXXMemberCallExpr::Create( 14206 Context, MemExprE, Args, resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc, 14207 CurFPFeatureOverrides(), proto->getNumParams()); 14208 14209 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getReturnType(), op->getRHS()->getBeginLoc(), 14210 call, nullptr)) 14211 return ExprError(); 14212 14213 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, nullptr, proto, Args, RParenLoc)) 14214 return ExprError(); 14215 14216 if (CheckOtherCall(call, proto)) 14217 return ExprError(); 14218 14219 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call); 14220 } 14221 14222 // We only try to build a recovery expr at this level if we can preserve 14223 // the return type, otherwise we return ExprError() and let the caller 14224 // recover. 14225 auto BuildRecoveryExpr = [&](QualType Type) { 14226 if (!AllowRecovery) 14227 return ExprError(); 14228 std::vector<Expr *> SubExprs = {MemExprE}; 14229 llvm::for_each(Args, [&SubExprs](Expr *E) { SubExprs.push_back(E); }); 14230 return CreateRecoveryExpr(MemExprE->getBeginLoc(), RParenLoc, SubExprs, 14231 Type); 14232 }; 14233 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) 14234 return CallExpr::Create(Context, MemExprE, Args, Context.VoidTy, VK_RValue, 14235 RParenLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14236 14237 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 14238 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) 14239 return ExprError(); 14240 14241 MemberExpr *MemExpr; 14242 CXXMethodDecl *Method = nullptr; 14243 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_public); 14244 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = nullptr; 14245 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) { 14246 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr); 14247 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl()); 14248 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl(); 14249 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier(); 14250 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 14251 } else { 14252 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr); 14253 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier(); 14254 14255 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType(); 14256 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification 14257 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue() 14258 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context); 14259 14260 // Add overload candidates 14261 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 14262 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 14263 14264 // FIXME: avoid copy. 14265 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr; 14266 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 14267 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 14268 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 14269 } 14270 14271 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(), 14272 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 14273 14274 NamedDecl *Func = *I; 14275 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext()); 14276 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)) 14277 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl(); 14278 14279 14280 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls. 14281 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) { 14282 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), Args, 14283 CandidateSet, 14284 /*SuppressUserConversions*/ false); 14285 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) { 14286 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a 14287 // non-template member function. 14288 if (TemplateArgs) 14289 continue; 14290 14291 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType, 14292 ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 14293 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 14294 } else { 14295 AddMethodTemplateCandidate( 14296 cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), ActingDC, 14297 TemplateArgs, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 14298 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 14299 } 14300 } 14301 14302 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName(); 14303 14304 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 14305 14306 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14307 bool Succeeded = false; 14308 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getBeginLoc(), 14309 Best)) { 14310 case OR_Success: 14311 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 14312 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl; 14313 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl); 14314 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc())) 14315 break; 14316 // If FoundDecl is different from Method (such as if one is a template 14317 // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is 14318 // called on both. 14319 // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying 14320 // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl 14321 // being used. 14322 if (Method != FoundDecl.getDecl() && 14323 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Method, UnresExpr->getNameLoc())) 14324 break; 14325 Succeeded = true; 14326 break; 14327 14328 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 14329 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14330 PartialDiagnosticAt( 14331 UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 14332 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call) 14333 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()), 14334 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 14335 break; 14336 case OR_Ambiguous: 14337 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14338 PartialDiagnosticAt(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 14339 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call) 14340 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()), 14341 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args); 14342 break; 14343 case OR_Deleted: 14344 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14345 PartialDiagnosticAt(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 14346 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call) 14347 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()), 14348 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 14349 break; 14350 } 14351 // Overload resolution fails, try to recover. 14352 if (!Succeeded) 14353 return BuildRecoveryExpr(chooseRecoveryType(CandidateSet, &Best)); 14354 14355 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method); 14356 14357 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a 14358 // non-member call based on that function. 14359 if (Method->isStatic()) { 14360 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc, Args, 14361 RParenLoc); 14362 } 14363 14364 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens()); 14365 } 14366 14367 QualType ResultType = Method->getReturnType(); 14368 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType); 14369 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 14370 14371 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?"); 14372 const auto *Proto = Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 14373 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall = CXXMemberCallExpr::Create( 14374 Context, MemExprE, Args, ResultType, VK, RParenLoc, 14375 CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Proto->getNumParams()); 14376 14377 // Check for a valid return type. 14378 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(), 14379 TheCall, Method)) 14380 return BuildRecoveryExpr(ResultType); 14381 14382 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call). 14383 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise 14384 // it was done at lookup. 14385 if (!Method->isStatic()) { 14386 ExprResult ObjectArg = 14387 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier, 14388 FoundDecl, Method); 14389 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid()) 14390 return ExprError(); 14391 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.get()); 14392 } 14393 14394 // Convert the rest of the arguments 14395 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, 14396 RParenLoc)) 14397 return BuildRecoveryExpr(ResultType); 14398 14399 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args); 14400 14401 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto)) 14402 return ExprError(); 14403 14404 // In the case the method to call was not selected by the overloading 14405 // resolution process, we still need to handle the enable_if attribute. Do 14406 // that here, so it will not hide previous -- and more relevant -- errors. 14407 if (auto *MemE = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) { 14408 if (const EnableIfAttr *Attr = 14409 CheckEnableIf(Method, LParenLoc, Args, true)) { 14410 Diag(MemE->getMemberLoc(), 14411 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call) 14412 << Method << Method->getSourceRange(); 14413 Diag(Method->getLocation(), 14414 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr) 14415 << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage(); 14416 return ExprError(); 14417 } 14418 } 14419 14420 if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) || 14421 isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) && 14422 TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) { 14423 const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl(); 14424 14425 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts()) && 14426 MemExpr->performsVirtualDispatch(getLangOpts())) { 14427 Diag(MemExpr->getBeginLoc(), 14428 diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor) 14429 << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext) 14430 << MD->getParent(); 14431 14432 Diag(MD->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName(); 14433 if (getLangOpts().AppleKext) 14434 Diag(MemExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_pure_qualified_call_kext) 14435 << MD->getParent() << MD->getDeclName(); 14436 } 14437 } 14438 14439 if (CXXDestructorDecl *DD = 14440 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(TheCall->getMethodDecl())) { 14441 // a->A::f() doesn't go through the vtable, except in AppleKext mode. 14442 bool CallCanBeVirtual = !MemExpr->hasQualifier() || getLangOpts().AppleKext; 14443 CheckVirtualDtorCall(DD, MemExpr->getBeginLoc(), /*IsDelete=*/false, 14444 CallCanBeVirtual, /*WarnOnNonAbstractTypes=*/true, 14445 MemExpr->getMemberLoc()); 14446 } 14447 14448 return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall), 14449 TheCall->getMethodDecl()); 14450 } 14451 14452 /// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class 14453 /// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an 14454 /// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a 14455 /// user-defined conversion on the object argument. 14456 ExprResult 14457 Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj, 14458 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 14459 MultiExprArg Args, 14460 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 14461 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj)) 14462 return ExprError(); 14463 ExprResult Object = Obj; 14464 14465 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 14466 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) 14467 return ExprError(); 14468 14469 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && 14470 "Requires object type argument"); 14471 14472 // C++ [over.call.object]p1: 14473 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax 14474 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of 14475 // candidate functions includes at least the function call 14476 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by 14477 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of 14478 // (E).operator(). 14479 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc, 14480 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 14481 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call); 14482 14483 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(), 14484 diag::err_incomplete_object_call, Object.get())) 14485 return true; 14486 14487 const auto *Record = Object.get()->getType()->castAs<RecordType>(); 14488 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 14489 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl()); 14490 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 14491 14492 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end(); 14493 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) { 14494 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(), 14495 Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, CandidateSet, 14496 /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false); 14497 } 14498 14499 // C++ [over.call.object]p2: 14500 // In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function 14501 // declared in T of the form 14502 // 14503 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier; 14504 // 14505 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a 14506 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id 14507 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning 14508 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of 14509 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function 14510 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...] 14511 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly, 14512 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate 14513 // functions for each conversion function declared in an 14514 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden 14515 // within T by another intervening declaration. 14516 const auto &Conversions = 14517 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 14518 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 14519 NamedDecl *D = *I; 14520 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 14521 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 14522 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 14523 14524 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't 14525 // surrogates. 14526 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 14527 continue; 14528 14529 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 14530 if (!Conv->isExplicit()) { 14531 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if 14532 // any) to get down to what might be a function type. 14533 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 14534 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>()) 14535 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType(); 14536 14537 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 14538 { 14539 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto, 14540 Object.get(), Args, CandidateSet); 14541 } 14542 } 14543 } 14544 14545 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 14546 14547 // Perform overload resolution. 14548 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14549 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getBeginLoc(), 14550 Best)) { 14551 case OR_Success: 14552 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call 14553 // below. 14554 break; 14555 14556 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 14557 PartialDiagnostic PD = 14558 CandidateSet.empty() 14559 ? (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_oper) 14560 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1 14561 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()) 14562 : (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call) 14563 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange()); 14564 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14565 PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(), PD), *this, 14566 OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 14567 break; 14568 } 14569 case OR_Ambiguous: 14570 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14571 PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(), 14572 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call) 14573 << Object.get()->getType() 14574 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()), 14575 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args); 14576 break; 14577 14578 case OR_Deleted: 14579 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14580 PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(), 14581 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call) 14582 << Object.get()->getType() 14583 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()), 14584 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 14585 break; 14586 } 14587 14588 if (Best == CandidateSet.end()) 14589 return true; 14590 14591 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 14592 14593 if (Best->Function == nullptr) { 14594 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the 14595 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function. 14596 CXXConversionDecl *Conv 14597 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>( 14598 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction); 14599 14600 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr, 14601 Best->FoundDecl); 14602 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc)) 14603 return ExprError(); 14604 assert(Conv == Best->FoundDecl.getDecl() && 14605 "Found Decl & conversion-to-functionptr should be same, right?!"); 14606 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the 14607 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion 14608 // on the object argument, then let BuildCallExpr finish the job. 14609 14610 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator. 14611 // and then call it. 14612 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl, 14613 Conv, HadMultipleCandidates); 14614 if (Call.isInvalid()) 14615 return ExprError(); 14616 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 14617 Call = ImplicitCastExpr::Create( 14618 Context, Call.get()->getType(), CK_UserDefinedConversion, Call.get(), 14619 nullptr, VK_RValue, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14620 14621 return BuildCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc); 14622 } 14623 14624 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr, Best->FoundDecl); 14625 14626 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr 14627 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object 14628 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments. 14629 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 14630 14631 // An error diagnostic has already been printed when parsing the declaration. 14632 if (Method->isInvalidDecl()) 14633 return ExprError(); 14634 14635 const auto *Proto = Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 14636 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 14637 14638 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo( 14639 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc); 14640 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc)); 14641 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl, 14642 Obj, HadMultipleCandidates, 14643 OpLocInfo.getLoc(), 14644 OpLocInfo.getInfo()); 14645 if (NewFn.isInvalid()) 14646 return true; 14647 14648 // The number of argument slots to allocate in the call. If we have default 14649 // arguments we need to allocate space for them as well. We additionally 14650 // need one more slot for the object parameter. 14651 unsigned NumArgsSlots = 1 + std::max<unsigned>(Args.size(), NumParams); 14652 14653 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the implicit object 14654 // parameter is placed at the beginning of the list). 14655 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> MethodArgs(NumArgsSlots); 14656 14657 bool IsError = false; 14658 14659 // Initialize the implicit object parameter. 14660 ExprResult ObjRes = 14661 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 14662 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 14663 if (ObjRes.isInvalid()) 14664 IsError = true; 14665 else 14666 Object = ObjRes; 14667 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get(); 14668 14669 // Check the argument types. 14670 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumParams; i++) { 14671 Expr *Arg; 14672 if (i < Args.size()) { 14673 Arg = Args[i]; 14674 14675 // Pass the argument. 14676 14677 ExprResult InputInit 14678 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 14679 Context, 14680 Method->getParamDecl(i)), 14681 SourceLocation(), Arg); 14682 14683 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid(); 14684 Arg = InputInit.getAs<Expr>(); 14685 } else { 14686 ExprResult DefArg 14687 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i)); 14688 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) { 14689 IsError = true; 14690 break; 14691 } 14692 14693 Arg = DefArg.getAs<Expr>(); 14694 } 14695 14696 MethodArgs[i + 1] = Arg; 14697 } 14698 14699 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...". 14700 if (Proto->isVariadic()) { 14701 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7). 14702 for (unsigned i = NumParams, e = Args.size(); i < e; i++) { 14703 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 14704 nullptr); 14705 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid(); 14706 MethodArgs[i + 1] = Arg.get(); 14707 } 14708 } 14709 14710 if (IsError) 14711 return true; 14712 14713 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args); 14714 14715 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly owned. 14716 QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType(); 14717 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 14718 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 14719 14720 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create( 14721 Context, OO_Call, NewFn.get(), MethodArgs, ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc, 14722 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14723 14724 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), LParenLoc, TheCall, Method)) 14725 return true; 14726 14727 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto)) 14728 return true; 14729 14730 return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall), Method); 14731 } 14732 14733 /// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator-> 14734 /// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and 14735 /// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find. 14736 ExprResult 14737 Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc, 14738 bool *NoArrowOperatorFound) { 14739 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() && 14740 "left-hand side must have class type"); 14741 14742 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base)) 14743 return ExprError(); 14744 14745 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc(); 14746 14747 // C++ [over.ref]p1: 14748 // 14749 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m 14750 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if 14751 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the 14752 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3). 14753 DeclarationName OpName = 14754 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow); 14755 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 14756 14757 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(), 14758 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag, Base)) 14759 return ExprError(); 14760 14761 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 14762 LookupQualifiedName(R, Base->getType()->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 14763 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 14764 14765 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end(); 14766 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) { 14767 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context), 14768 None, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false); 14769 } 14770 14771 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 14772 14773 // Perform overload resolution. 14774 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14775 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 14776 case OR_Success: 14777 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below. 14778 break; 14779 14780 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 14781 auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base); 14782 if (CandidateSet.empty()) { 14783 QualType BaseType = Base->getType(); 14784 if (NoArrowOperatorFound) { 14785 // Report this specific error to the caller instead of emitting a 14786 // diagnostic, as requested. 14787 *NoArrowOperatorFound = true; 14788 return ExprError(); 14789 } 14790 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow) 14791 << BaseType << Base->getSourceRange(); 14792 if (BaseType->isRecordType() && !BaseType->isPointerType()) { 14793 Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion) 14794 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "."); 14795 } 14796 } else 14797 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper) 14798 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange(); 14799 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, Base, Cands); 14800 return ExprError(); 14801 } 14802 case OR_Ambiguous: 14803 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14804 PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary) 14805 << "->" << Base->getType() 14806 << Base->getSourceRange()), 14807 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Base); 14808 return ExprError(); 14809 14810 case OR_Deleted: 14811 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14812 PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 14813 << "->" << Base->getSourceRange()), 14814 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base); 14815 return ExprError(); 14816 } 14817 14818 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, nullptr, Best->FoundDecl); 14819 14820 // Convert the object parameter. 14821 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 14822 ExprResult BaseResult = 14823 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 14824 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 14825 if (BaseResult.isInvalid()) 14826 return ExprError(); 14827 Base = BaseResult.get(); 14828 14829 // Build the operator call. 14830 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl, 14831 Base, HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc); 14832 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 14833 return ExprError(); 14834 14835 QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType(); 14836 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 14837 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 14838 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 14839 CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.get(), Base, 14840 ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14841 14842 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, Method)) 14843 return ExprError(); 14844 14845 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, 14846 Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>())) 14847 return ExprError(); 14848 14849 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 14850 } 14851 14852 /// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to 14853 /// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results. 14854 ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R, 14855 DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo, 14856 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args, 14857 SourceLocation LitEndLoc, 14858 TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) { 14859 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(); 14860 14861 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc, 14862 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 14863 AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet, 14864 TemplateArgs); 14865 14866 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 14867 14868 // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need 14869 // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template. 14870 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14871 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) { 14872 case OR_Success: 14873 case OR_Deleted: 14874 break; 14875 14876 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 14877 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14878 PartialDiagnosticAt(UDSuffixLoc, 14879 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 14880 << R.getLookupName()), 14881 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 14882 return ExprError(); 14883 14884 case OR_Ambiguous: 14885 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14886 PartialDiagnosticAt(R.getNameLoc(), PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) 14887 << R.getLookupName()), 14888 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args); 14889 return ExprError(); 14890 } 14891 14892 FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function; 14893 ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, Best->FoundDecl, 14894 nullptr, HadMultipleCandidates, 14895 SuffixInfo.getLoc(), 14896 SuffixInfo.getInfo()); 14897 if (Fn.isInvalid()) 14898 return true; 14899 14900 // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except 14901 // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals. 14902 Expr *ConvArgs[2]; 14903 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 14904 ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization( 14905 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)), 14906 SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]); 14907 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 14908 return true; 14909 ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.get(); 14910 } 14911 14912 QualType ResultTy = FD->getReturnType(); 14913 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 14914 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 14915 14916 UserDefinedLiteral *UDL = UserDefinedLiteral::Create( 14917 Context, Fn.get(), llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvArgs, Args.size()), ResultTy, 14918 VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14919 14920 if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getReturnType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD)) 14921 return ExprError(); 14922 14923 if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL, nullptr)) 14924 return ExprError(); 14925 14926 return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL), FD); 14927 } 14928 14929 /// Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement. If the 14930 /// given LookupResult is non-empty, it is assumed to describe a member which 14931 /// will be invoked. Otherwise, the function will be found via argument 14932 /// dependent lookup. 14933 /// CallExpr is set to a valid expression and FRS_Success returned on success, 14934 /// otherwise CallExpr is set to ExprError() and some non-success value 14935 /// is returned. 14936 Sema::ForRangeStatus 14937 Sema::BuildForRangeBeginEndCall(SourceLocation Loc, 14938 SourceLocation RangeLoc, 14939 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 14940 LookupResult &MemberLookup, 14941 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, 14942 Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr) { 14943 Scope *S = nullptr; 14944 14945 CandidateSet->clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 14946 if (!MemberLookup.empty()) { 14947 ExprResult MemberRef = 14948 BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Range, Range->getType(), Loc, 14949 /*IsPtr=*/false, CXXScopeSpec(), 14950 /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 14951 /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/nullptr, 14952 MemberLookup, 14953 /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr, S); 14954 if (MemberRef.isInvalid()) { 14955 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 14956 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 14957 } 14958 *CallExpr = BuildCallExpr(S, MemberRef.get(), Loc, None, Loc, nullptr); 14959 if (CallExpr->isInvalid()) { 14960 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 14961 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 14962 } 14963 } else { 14964 ExprResult FnR = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(/*NamingClass=*/nullptr, 14965 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), 14966 NameInfo, UnresolvedSet<0>()); 14967 if (FnR.isInvalid()) 14968 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 14969 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(FnR.get()); 14970 14971 bool CandidateSetError = buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, Fn, Range, Loc, 14972 CandidateSet, CallExpr); 14973 if (CandidateSet->empty() || CandidateSetError) { 14974 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 14975 return FRS_NoViableFunction; 14976 } 14977 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14978 OverloadingResult OverloadResult = 14979 CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best); 14980 14981 if (OverloadResult == OR_No_Viable_Function) { 14982 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 14983 return FRS_NoViableFunction; 14984 } 14985 *CallExpr = FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, Fn, Loc, Range, 14986 Loc, nullptr, CandidateSet, &Best, 14987 OverloadResult, 14988 /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/false); 14989 if (CallExpr->isInvalid() || OverloadResult != OR_Success) { 14990 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 14991 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 14992 } 14993 } 14994 return FRS_Success; 14995 } 14996 14997 14998 /// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to 14999 /// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and 15000 /// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function 15001 /// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to 15002 /// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr. 15003 Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found, 15004 FunctionDecl *Fn) { 15005 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) { 15006 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(), 15007 Found, Fn); 15008 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr()) 15009 return PE; 15010 15011 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr); 15012 } 15013 15014 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) { 15015 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(), 15016 Found, Fn); 15017 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(), 15018 SubExpr->getType()) && 15019 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload"); 15020 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?"); 15021 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr()) 15022 return ICE; 15023 15024 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(), ICE->getCastKind(), 15025 SubExpr, nullptr, ICE->getValueKind(), 15026 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 15027 } 15028 15029 if (auto *GSE = dyn_cast<GenericSelectionExpr>(E)) { 15030 if (!GSE->isResultDependent()) { 15031 Expr *SubExpr = 15032 FixOverloadedFunctionReference(GSE->getResultExpr(), Found, Fn); 15033 if (SubExpr == GSE->getResultExpr()) 15034 return GSE; 15035 15036 // Replace the resulting type information before rebuilding the generic 15037 // selection expression. 15038 ArrayRef<Expr *> A = GSE->getAssocExprs(); 15039 SmallVector<Expr *, 4> AssocExprs(A.begin(), A.end()); 15040 unsigned ResultIdx = GSE->getResultIndex(); 15041 AssocExprs[ResultIdx] = SubExpr; 15042 15043 return GenericSelectionExpr::Create( 15044 Context, GSE->getGenericLoc(), GSE->getControllingExpr(), 15045 GSE->getAssocTypeSourceInfos(), AssocExprs, GSE->getDefaultLoc(), 15046 GSE->getRParenLoc(), GSE->containsUnexpandedParameterPack(), 15047 ResultIdx); 15048 } 15049 // Rather than fall through to the unreachable, return the original generic 15050 // selection expression. 15051 return GSE; 15052 } 15053 15054 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) { 15055 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && 15056 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function"); 15057 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 15058 if (Method->isStatic()) { 15059 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different 15060 // from non-member functions. 15061 } else { 15062 // Fix the subexpression, which really has to be an 15063 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function 15064 // or template. 15065 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(), 15066 Found, Fn); 15067 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr()) 15068 return UnOp; 15069 15070 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr) 15071 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref"); 15072 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier() 15073 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier"); 15074 15075 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member 15076 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the 15077 // appropriate pointer to member type. 15078 QualType ClassType 15079 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext())); 15080 QualType MemPtrType 15081 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr()); 15082 // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now. 15083 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) 15084 (void)isCompleteType(UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), MemPtrType); 15085 15086 return UnaryOperator::Create( 15087 Context, SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 15088 UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), false, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 15089 } 15090 } 15091 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(), 15092 Found, Fn); 15093 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr()) 15094 return UnOp; 15095 15096 return UnaryOperator::Create(Context, SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, 15097 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()), 15098 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), 15099 false, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 15100 } 15101 15102 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) { 15103 // FIXME: avoid copy. 15104 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr; 15105 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 15106 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 15107 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 15108 } 15109 15110 DeclRefExpr *DRE = 15111 BuildDeclRefExpr(Fn, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, ULE->getNameInfo(), 15112 ULE->getQualifierLoc(), Found.getDecl(), 15113 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), TemplateArgs); 15114 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1); 15115 return DRE; 15116 } 15117 15118 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) { 15119 // FIXME: avoid copy. 15120 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr; 15121 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 15122 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 15123 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 15124 } 15125 15126 Expr *Base; 15127 15128 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an 15129 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref. 15130 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) { 15131 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) { 15132 DeclRefExpr *DRE = BuildDeclRefExpr( 15133 Fn, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, MemExpr->getNameInfo(), 15134 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), Found.getDecl(), 15135 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), TemplateArgs); 15136 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); 15137 return DRE; 15138 } else { 15139 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc(); 15140 if (MemExpr->getQualifier()) 15141 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc(); 15142 Base = 15143 BuildCXXThisExpr(Loc, MemExpr->getBaseType(), /*IsImplicit=*/true); 15144 } 15145 } else 15146 Base = MemExpr->getBase(); 15147 15148 ExprValueKind valueKind; 15149 QualType type; 15150 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) { 15151 valueKind = VK_LValue; 15152 type = Fn->getType(); 15153 } else { 15154 valueKind = VK_RValue; 15155 type = Context.BoundMemberTy; 15156 } 15157 15158 return BuildMemberExpr( 15159 Base, MemExpr->isArrow(), MemExpr->getOperatorLoc(), 15160 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), Fn, Found, 15161 /*HadMultipleCandidates=*/true, MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(), 15162 type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary, TemplateArgs); 15163 } 15164 15165 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function"); 15166 } 15167 15168 ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E, 15169 DeclAccessPair Found, 15170 FunctionDecl *Fn) { 15171 return FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E.get(), Found, Fn); 15172 } 15173